blob: 56dc1842f3b9b847a8adf2a6b45ffccd0bc907b4 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaueaded982022-12-01 15:25:34 +01005 version 2.8
Christopher Faulet86e043a2023-09-07 11:32:42 +02006 2023/09/07
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
Daniel Eppersonffdf6a32023-05-15 12:45:27 -0700452.6. Size format
462.7. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001028.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
1048.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001058.3. Advanced logging options
1068.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1078.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1088.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1098.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1108.4. Timing events
1118.5. Session state at disconnection
1128.6. Non-printable characters
1138.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1148.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1158.9. Examples of logs
116
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001179. Supported filters
1189.1. Trace
1199.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001209.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001219.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001229.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001239.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02001249.7. Bandwidth limitation
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200125
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012610. FastCGI applications
12710.1. Setup
12810.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12910.1.2. Proxy section
13010.1.3. Example
13110.2. Default parameters
13210.3. Limitations
133
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013411. Address formats
13511.1. Address family prefixes
13611.2. Socket type prefixes
13711.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138
1391. Quick reminder about HTTP
140----------------------------
141
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100142When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
144on almost anything found in the contents.
145
146However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
147formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
148correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
149
150
1511.1. The HTTP transaction model
152-------------------------------
153
154The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100155to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100156from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
157connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158will involve a new connection :
159
160 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
161
162In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
163establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
164by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
165length.
166
167Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
168to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
169however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
170response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
171header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
172
173 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
174
175Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
176power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
177but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200178a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100180Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
182second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
183page :
184
185 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
186
187This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
188latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
189correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
190the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100191server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200193The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2 and HTTP/3.
194This time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all
195streams are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100196parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
197carry the stream identifier.
198
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200199
200HTTP/3 is implemented over QUIC, itself implemented over UDP. QUIC solves the
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +0200201head of line blocking at transport level by means of independently treated
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200202streams. Indeed, when experiencing loss, an impacted stream does not affect the
203other streams.
204
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
206connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
207leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100208start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
209processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
210waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200211
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200212HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100213 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
214 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100215 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100216 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200217 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100218
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100219
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220
2211.2. HTTP request
222-----------------
223
224First, let's consider this HTTP request :
225
226 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100227 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
229 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
230 3 User-agent: my small browser
231 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
232 5 Accept: image/png
233
234
2351.2.1. The Request line
236-----------------------
237
238Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
239
240 - a METHOD : GET
241 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
243
244All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
245which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
246followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
247is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
248desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
249the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
250
251The URI itself can have several forms :
252
253 - A "relative URI" :
254
255 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
256
257 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
258 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
259
260 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
261
262 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
263
264 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
265 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
266 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
267 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
268 must accept this form too.
269
270 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
271 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
272 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200274 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
275 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
276 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
277 other protocols too.
278
279In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
280mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
281on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
282It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
283specific to the language, framework or application in use.
284
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100286assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100287
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288
2891.2.2. The request headers
290--------------------------
291
292The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
293beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
294an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
295Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
296values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
297encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
298the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
299define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
300
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100301Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200302their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100303"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200304as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
305normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
306representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
307HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308
309The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
310that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
311is one valid form of empty line.
312
313Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
314headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
315about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
316application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
317
318Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000319 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200320 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
321 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
322 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
323
324
3251.3. HTTP response
326------------------
327
328An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
329messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
330
331 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100332 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
334 2 Content-length: 350
335 3 Content-Type: text/html
336
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200337As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
338codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
339response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100340continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
341the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
342following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
343sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
344(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
345correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
346such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
347state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400348over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100349if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
350information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200351
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200352
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003531.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354------------------------
355
356Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
357
358 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
359 - a status code : 200
360 - a reason : OK
361
362The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100363 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
364 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
365 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
366 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
367 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000369Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100370"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
372messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
373or "Authentication Required".
374
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100375HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376
377 Code When / reason
378 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
379 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
380 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
381 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100382 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
383 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 400 for an invalid or too large request
385 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
386 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200387 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100388 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100390 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
391 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400392 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200393 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400394 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100395 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200396 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200397 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200398 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
399 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
400 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
401
402The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
4034.2).
404
405
4061.3.2. The response headers
407---------------------------
408
409Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
410the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
411details.
412
413
4142. Configuring HAProxy
415----------------------
416
4172.1. Configuration file format
418------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200419
420HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
421
422 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100423 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700424 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100425 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200426
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100427The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
428a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100429
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100430 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
431
432 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
433
434 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
435 tab characters
436
437 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
438 keyword sequences listed in this document
439
440 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
441 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
442 parts of the configuration, or expressions
443
444 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
445 are supported
446
447 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
448 section
449
450This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
451generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
452figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
453
454First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
455the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
456a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
457word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
458follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
459the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
460the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
461the parts that need to be addressed.
462
463A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
464requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
465extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
466the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
467section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
468section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
469not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
470
471A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
472each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
473a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
474start a new one.
475
476Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
477that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
478applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
479"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
480processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
481ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
482which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
483In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
484of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
485identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
486such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4872, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
488
489 listen foo
490 bind :80
491
492 listen bar
493 bind :81
494
495Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
496spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
497of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
498following configurations are strictly equivalent:
499
500 global#this is the global section
501 daemon#daemonize
502 frontend foo
503 mode http # or tcp
504
505and:
506
507 global
508 daemon
509
510 # this is the public web frontend
511 frontend foo
512 mode http
513
514The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
515new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
516other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
517section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
518section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
519at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
520
521Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
522are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
523editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
524support automatic indent.
525
526In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
527positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
528modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
529anymore, and is not recommended.
530
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200531
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005322.2. Quoting and escaping
533-------------------------
534
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100535In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
536that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
537possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
538in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
539('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
542very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
543the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
544also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
545delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
546word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
547remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200548
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100549If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
550(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
551
552Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
553backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200554
555 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
556 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
557 \\ to use a backslash
558 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
559 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
560
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100561In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
562C-language representation:
563
564 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
565 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
566 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
567 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
568
569Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
570or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
571of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200572
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100573 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200574 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
575 # hash as a comment start
576
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100577Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
578evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
579dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
580backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200581
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100582Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
583character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
584is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200585
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100586As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
587entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
588name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
589represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300590hence its absence there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200591
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100592 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
593 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
594 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300595 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
596 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" |
597 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
598 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" |
599 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100600 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300601 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100602 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300603 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300605 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100606 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300607 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
608 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" |
609 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100610 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300611 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200612
613 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100614 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200615 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
616 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
617 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
618 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
619 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
620
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100621There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
622necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
623by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
624they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
625escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
626characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
627case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
628if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
629own quotes.
630
631The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600632quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500633not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100634quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
635
636Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
637arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
638
639 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
640 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
641
642Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
643"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
644cannot write:
645
646 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
647
648because we would like the string to cut like this:
649
650 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
651 |---------|----|-|
652 arg1 _/ / /
653 arg2 __________/ /
654 arg3 ______________/
655
656but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
657parenthesis then garbage:
658
659 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
660 |--------|--------|
661 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
662 trailing garbage _________/
663
664The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
665quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
666processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
667this word:
668
669 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
670 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
671 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
672
673So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
674still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
675the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
676the second level:
677
678 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
679 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
680 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
681 |---------||----|-|
682 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
683 arg2=blah ___________/ /
684 arg3=g _______________/
685
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500686Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100687double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
688
689 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
690 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
691 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
692 |---------||----|-|
693 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
694 arg2 ___________/ /
695 arg3 _______________/
696
697When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
698appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
699string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
700thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
701
702 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
703 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
704 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
705 |-------------| |-----||-|
706 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
707 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
708 arg3 ______________________/
709
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400710Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600711that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100712quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
713single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
714level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
715
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600716Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
717if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
718or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
719
720 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
721 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
722 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
723
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100724When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
725double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600726and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100727a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
728a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
729the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
730regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
731around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
732more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200733
734
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007352.3. Environment variables
736--------------------------
737
738HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
739interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
740configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
741optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
742shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200743underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
744list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
745arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100746before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
747use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
748next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
749existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200750
751 Example:
752
753 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
754
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100755 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200756
757 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
758
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200759Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
760file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200761
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200762* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
763 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
764
765* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
766 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
767 directory.
768
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +0100769* HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT: contains the value of the default HTTP log format as
770 defined in section 8.2.3 "HTTP log format". It can be used to override the
771 default log format without having to copy the whole original definition.
772
773 Example:
774 # Add the rule that gave the final verdict to the log
775 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT} lr=last_rule_file:last_rule_line"
776
777* HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for HTTPS log
778 format as defined in section 8.2.4 "HTTPS log format".
779
780* HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for TCP log format
781 as defined in section 8.2.2 "TCP log format".
782
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200783* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
784
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500785* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200786 processes, separated by semicolons.
787
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500788* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200789 CLI, separated by semicolons.
790
William Lallemandd4c0be62023-02-21 14:07:05 +0100791* HAPROXY_STARTUP_VERSION: contains the version used to start, in master-worker
792 mode this is the version which was used to start the master, even after
793 updating the binary and reloading.
794
Sébaastien Gross2a1bcf12023-02-23 12:54:25 -0500795* HAPROXY_BRANCH: contains the HAProxy branch version (such as "2.8"). It does
796 not contain the full version number. It can be useful in case of migration
797 if resources (such as maps or certificates) are in a path containing the
798 branch number.
799
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200800In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
801regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
802only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
803
804* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
805
806* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
807 starting at one.
808
809* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
810 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
811 first section.
812
813These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
814if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
815section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
816"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
817proxies.
818
819This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
820logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
821to name some config objects like servers for example.
822
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200823See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200824
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100825
8262.4. Conditional blocks
827-----------------------
828
829It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
830some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
831ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
832configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
833versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
834preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
835text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
836lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
837switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
838are defined to form conditional blocks:
839
840 - .if <condition>
841 - .elif <condition>
842 - .else
843 - .endif
844
845The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
846as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
847matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
848there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
849only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
850".elif" of a block.
851
852Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
853ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
854as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
855
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200856Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
857See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
858
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200859The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
860expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100861
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100862 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
863 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200864 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200865 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530866 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
867 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200868 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
869 from left to right until one returns false
870 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
871 from right to left until one returns true
872
873Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
874operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200875
876The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
877
878 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
879 exists, regardless of its contents
880
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200881 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
882 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
883 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
884
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200885 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
886 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
Christopher Fauleta1fdad72023-02-20 17:55:58 +0100887 - strstr(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the second string is found in the first one
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200888
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200889 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
890 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
891 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
892 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
893
894 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
895 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
896 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
897 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
898
Christopher Fauletc13f3022023-02-21 11:16:08 +0100899 - enabled(<opt>) : returns true if the option <opt> is enabled at
900 run-time. Only a subset of options are supported:
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +0100901 POLL, EPOLL, KQUEUE, EVPORTS, SPLICE,
902 GETADDRINFO, REUSEPORT, FAST-FORWARD,
903 SERVER-SSL-VERIFY-NONE
Christopher Fauletc13f3022023-02-21 11:16:08 +0100904
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200905Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100906
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200907 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
908 listen mwcli_px
909 bind :1111
910 ...
911 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100912
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200913 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
914 bind :80
915 .endif
916
917 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200918 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200919 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200920 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200921 .endif
922
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200923 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200924 bind :443 ssl crt ...
925 .endif
926
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200927 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
928 profiling.memory on
929 .endif
930
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200931 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
932 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
933 .endif
934
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200935Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100936
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200937 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100938 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
939 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
940 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
941
942Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
943"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
944fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
945provide advice to the user.
946
947Example:
948
949 .if "${A}"
950 .if "${B}"
951 .notice "A=1, B=1"
952 .elif "${C}"
953 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
954 .elif "${D}"
955 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
956 .else
957 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
958 .endif
959 .else
960 .notice "A=0"
961 .endif
962
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200963 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
964 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
965
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100966
9672.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200968----------------
969
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100970Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100971values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
972otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
973numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
974for every keyword. Supported units are :
975
976 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
977 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
978 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
979 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
980 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
981 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
982
983
Daniel Eppersonffdf6a32023-05-15 12:45:27 -07009842.6. Size format
985----------------
986
987Some parameters involve values representing size, such as bandwidth limits.
988These values are generally expressed in bytes (unless explicitly stated
989otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
990numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
991for every keyword. Supported units are case insensitive :
992
993 - k : kilobytes. 1 kilobyte = 1024 bytes
994 - m : megabytes. 1 megabyte = 1048576 bytes
995 - g : gigabytes. 1 gigabyte = 1073741824 bytes
996
997Both time and size formats require integers, decimal notation is not allowed.
998
999
10002.7. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02001001-------------
1002
1003 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
1004 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
1005 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
1006 global
1007 daemon
1008 maxconn 256
1009
1010 defaults
1011 mode http
1012 timeout connect 5000ms
1013 timeout client 50000ms
1014 timeout server 50000ms
1015
1016 frontend http-in
1017 bind *:80
1018 default_backend servers
1019
1020 backend servers
1021 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
1022
1023
1024 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
1025 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
1026 global
1027 daemon
1028 maxconn 256
1029
1030 defaults
1031 mode http
1032 timeout connect 5000ms
1033 timeout client 50000ms
1034 timeout server 50000ms
1035
1036 listen http-in
1037 bind *:80
1038 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
1039
1040
1041Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
1042
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +01001043 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02001044
1045
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001047--------------------
1048
1049Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
1050are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
1051of them have command-line equivalents.
1052
1053The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
1054
1055 * Process management and security
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001056 - 51degrees-allow-unmatched
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001057 - 51degrees-cache-size
1058 - 51degrees-data-file
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001059 - 51degrees-difference
1060 - 51degrees-drift
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001061 - 51degrees-property-name-list
1062 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001063 - 51degrees-use-performance-graph
1064 - 51degrees-use-predictive-graph
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001065 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001066 - chroot
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +02001067 - cluster-secret
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001068 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001069 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001070 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001071 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001072 - description
1073 - deviceatlas-json-file
1074 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001075 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001076 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001077 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001078 - external-check
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001079 - fd-hard-limit
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001080 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001081 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001082 - group
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001083 - h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1084 - h1-case-adjust
1085 - h1-case-adjust-file
1086 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001087 - hard-stop-after
William Lallemande279f592023-05-11 21:08:38 +02001088 - httpclient.resolvers.disabled
William Lallemandcfabb352022-05-12 10:51:15 +02001089 - httpclient.resolvers.id
1090 - httpclient.resolvers.prefer
William Lallemand4ad693e2023-09-05 15:55:04 +02001091 - httpclient.retries
William Lallemandcfabb352022-05-12 10:51:15 +02001092 - httpclient.ssl.ca-file
1093 - httpclient.ssl.verify
William Lallemandb9ed1572023-09-05 16:42:27 +02001094 - httpclient.timeout.connect
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001095 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001096 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001097 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001098 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001099 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001100 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001101 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001102 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001103 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001104 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001105 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001106 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001107 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001108 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001109 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001110 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001111 - presetenv
Patrick Hemmer425d7ad2023-05-23 13:02:08 -04001112 - prealloc-fd
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001113 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001114 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001115 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001116 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001117 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001118 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
William Lallemandb6ae2aa2023-05-05 00:05:46 +02001119 - ssl-default-bind-client-sigalgs
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001120 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001121 - ssl-default-bind-options
William Lallemand1d3c8222023-05-04 15:33:55 +02001122 - ssl-default-bind-sigalgs
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001123 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001124 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001125 - ssl-default-server-options
1126 - ssl-dh-param-file
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02001127 - ssl-propquery
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02001128 - ssl-provider
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02001129 - ssl-provider-path
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001130 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001131 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001132 - stats
1133 - strict-limits
1134 - uid
1135 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001136 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001137 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001138 - user
1139 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001140 - wurfl-data-file
1141 - wurfl-information-list
1142 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001143
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001144 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001145 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001146 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001147 - maxcompcpuusage
1148 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001149 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001150 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001151 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001152 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001153 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001154 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001155 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001156 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001157 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001158 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001159 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001160 - nokqueue
1161 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001162 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001163 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001164 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001165 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001166 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001167 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001168 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001169 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001170 - tune.buffers.limit
1171 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001172 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001173 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01001174 - tune.disable-fast-forward
Christopher Faulet760a3842023-02-20 14:33:46 +01001175 - tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001176 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Tim Duesterhus3ca274b2023-06-13 15:07:34 +02001177 - tune.h2.be.initial-window-size
1178 - tune.h2.be.max-concurrent-streams
1179 - tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size
1180 - tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001181 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001182 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001183 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Tim Duesterhusbf7493e2023-06-13 15:08:47 +02001184 - tune.h2.max-frame-size
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001185 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001186 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001187 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001188 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001189 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001190 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001191 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001192 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001193 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1194 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Tristan2632d042023-10-23 13:07:39 +01001195 - tune.lua.log.loggers
1196 - tune.lua.log.stderr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001197 - tune.maxaccept
1198 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001199 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01001200 - tune.memory.hot-size
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001201 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02001202 - tune.peers.max-updates-at-once
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001203 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001204 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1205 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02001206 - tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02001207 - tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02001208 - tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01001209 - tune.quic.max-frame-loss
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02001210 - tune.quic.retry-threshold
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01001211 - tune.quic.socket-owner
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001212 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1213 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001214 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001215 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001216 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001217 - tune.sndbuf.client
1218 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01001219 - tune.stick-counters
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001220 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001221 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1222 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
1223 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02001224 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1225 - tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001226 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001227 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1228 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001229 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +01001230 - tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay
1231 - tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001232 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001233 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001234 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1235 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1236 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001237 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1238 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001239
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001240 * Debugging
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02001241 - anonkey
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001242 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001243 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001244
1245
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012463.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001247------------------------------------
1248
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100124951degrees-data-file <file path>
1250 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1251 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1252
1253 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001254 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001255
125651degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1257 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1258 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1259 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1260
1261 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001262 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001263
126451degrees-property-separator <char>
1265 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1266 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1267
1268 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001269 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001270
127151degrees-cache-size <number>
1272 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1273 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1274 By default, this cache is disabled.
1275
1276 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001277 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001278
127951degrees-use-performance-graph { on | off }
1280 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the performance graph in
1281 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1282
1283 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001284 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001285
128651degrees-use-predictive-graph { on | off }
1287 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the predictive graph in
1288 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1289
1290 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001291 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001292
129351degrees-drift <number>
1294 Sets the drift value that a detection can allow.
1295
1296 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001297 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001298
129951degrees-difference <number>
1300 Sets the difference value that a detection can allow.
1301
1302 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001303 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001304
130551degrees-allow-unmatched { on | off }
1306 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of unmatched nodes in the
1307 detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1308
1309 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001310 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001311
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001312ca-base <dir>
1313 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001314 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1315 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1316 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001317
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001318chroot <jail dir>
1319 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1320 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1321 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1322 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1323 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001324 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001325
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001326close-spread-time <time>
1327 Define a time window during which idle connections and active connections
1328 closing is spread in case of soft-stop. After a SIGUSR1 is received and the
1329 grace period is over (if any), the idle connections will all be closed at
1330 once if this option is not set, and active HTTP or HTTP2 connections will be
1331 ended after the next request is received, either by appending a "Connection:
1332 close" line to the HTTP response, or by sending a GOAWAY frame in case of
1333 HTTP2. When this option is set, connection closing will be spread over this
1334 set <time>.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001335 If the close-spread-time is set to "infinite", active connection closing
1336 during a soft-stop will be disabled. The "Connection: close" header will not
1337 be added to HTTP responses (or GOAWAY for HTTP2) anymore and idle connections
1338 will only be closed once their timeout is reached (based on the various
1339 timeouts set in the configuration).
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001340
1341 Arguments :
1342 <time> is a time window (by default in milliseconds) during which
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001343 connection closing will be spread during a soft-stop operation, or
1344 "infinite" if active connection closing should be disabled.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001345
1346 It is recommended to set this setting to a value lower than the one used in
1347 the "hard-stop-after" option if this one is used, so that all connections
1348 have a chance to gracefully close before the process stops.
1349
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001350 See also: grace, hard-stop-after, idle-close-on-response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001351
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001352cluster-secret <secret>
1353 Define an ASCII string secret shared between several nodes belonging to the
1354 same cluster. It could be used for different usages. It is at least used to
1355 derive stateless reset tokens for all the QUIC connections instantiated by
1356 this process. This is also the case to derive secrets used to encrypt Retry
Amaury Denoyelle28ea31c2022-11-14 16:18:46 +01001357 tokens.
1358
1359 If this parameter is not set, a random value will be selected on process
1360 startup. This allows to use features which rely on it, albeit with some
1361 limitations.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001362
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001363cpu-map [auto:]<thread-group>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>[,...] [...]
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001364 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a thread group or a thread
1365 to a specific CPU set. This means that the designated threads will never run
1366 on other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for individual
1367 threads or thread groups. The first argument is a thread group range,
1368 optionally followed by a thread set. These ranges have the following format:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001369
1370 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1371
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001372 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001373 word size. Any group IDs above 'thread-groups' and any thread IDs above the
1374 machine's word size are ignored. All thread numbers are relative to the group
1375 they belong to. It is possible to specify a range with two such number
1376 delimited by a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all threads at once
1377 using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just
1378 like with the "thread" bind directive. The second and forthcoming arguments
1379 are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001380 first CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). These
1381 CPU numbers and ranges may be repeated by delimiting them with commas or by
1382 passing more ranges as new arguments on the same line. Outside of Linux and
1383 BSD operating systems, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to
1384 either 31 or 63. Multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified, but each
1385 "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001386
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001387 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1388 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1389 on the machine's word size.
1390
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001391 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the thread set to let HAProxy
1392 automatically bind a set of threads to a CPU by incrementing threads and
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001393 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1394 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001395 highest bound. Having both a group and a thread range with the "auto:"
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001396 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1397 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001398
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001399 Note that group ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a lone
1400 number designates a thread group and must be 1 if thread-groups are not used,
1401 and specifying a thread range or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of
1402 it if thread groups are not used. Finally, "1" is strictly equivalent to
1403 "1/all" and designates all threads in the group.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001404
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001405 Examples:
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001406 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first group on the
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001407 # first 4 CPUs
1408
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001409 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1410 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001411 # word size.
1412
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001413 # all these lines bind thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001414 # and so on.
1415 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1416 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1417 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001418 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3,2,1,0
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001419
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001420 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1421 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1422 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1423 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001424
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001425 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1426 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1427 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001428
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001429 # map 40 threads of those 4 groups to individual CPUs
1430 cpu-map auto:1/1-10 0-9
1431 cpu-map auto:2/1-10 10-19
1432 cpu-map auto:3/1-10 20-29
1433 cpu-map auto:4/1-10 30-39
1434
1435 # Map 80 threads to one physical socket and 80 others to another socket
1436 # without forcing assignment. These are split into 4 groups since no
1437 # group may have more than 64 threads.
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001438 cpu-map 1/1-40 0-39,80-119 # node0, siblings 0 & 1
1439 cpu-map 2/1-40 0-39,80-119
1440 cpu-map 3/1-40 40-79,120-159 # node1, siblings 0 & 1
1441 cpu-map 4/1-40 40-79,120-159
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001442
1443
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001444crt-base <dir>
1445 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001446 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1447 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001448
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001449daemon
1450 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1451 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001452 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1453 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001454
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001455default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001456 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001457 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1458 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1459 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1460 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1461 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1462 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1463 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1464 not start with a slash ('/'):
1465 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1466 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1467
1468 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1469 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1470 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1471 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1472 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1473 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1474 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1475 each of them.
1476
1477 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1478 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1479 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1480 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1481 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1482 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1483 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1484 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1485
1486 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1487 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001488 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001489 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1490 made easily relocatable.
1491
1492 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1493 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1494 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1495 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1496 consistent across all configuration files.
1497
1498 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1499 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1500 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1501 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1502 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1503 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1504 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1505 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1506
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001507description <text>
1508 Add a text that describes the instance.
1509
1510 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1511 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1512 "<" and ">" characters.
1513
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001514deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1515 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001516 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001517
1518deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001519 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001520 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1521
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001522deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001523 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1524 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1525 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001526
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001527deviceatlas-separator <char>
1528 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1529 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1530
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001531expose-experimental-directives
1532 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1533 the config file will be rejected.
1534
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001535external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001536 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1537 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001538 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1539 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1540 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1541 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1542 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001543
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001544fd-hard-limit <number>
1545 Sets an upper bound to the maximum number of file descriptors that the
1546 process will use, regardless of system limits. While "ulimit-n" and "maxconn"
1547 may be used to enforce a value, when they are not set, the process will be
1548 limited to the hard limit of the RLIMIT_NOFILE setting as reported by
1549 "ulimit -n -H". But some modern operating systems are now allowing extremely
1550 large values here (in the order of 1 billion), which will consume way too
1551 much RAM for regular usage. The fd-hard-limit setting is provided to enforce
1552 a possibly lower bound to this limit. This means that it will always respect
1553 the system-imposed limits when they are below <number> but the specified
1554 value will be used if system-imposed limits are higher. In the example below,
1555 no other setting is specified and the maxconn value will automatically adapt
1556 to the lower of "fd-hard-limit" and the system-imposed limit:
1557
1558 global
1559 # use as many FDs as possible but no more than 50000
1560 fd-hard-limit 50000
1561
1562 See also: ulimit-n, maxconn
1563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001564gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001565 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001566 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1567 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001568 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001569 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001570 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001571
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001572grace <time>
1573 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1574
1575 Arguments :
1576 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1577 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1578 soft-stop operation.
1579
1580 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1581 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1582 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1583 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1584 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1585 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1586 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1587 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1588 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1589
1590 Example:
1591
1592 global
1593 grace 10s
1594
1595 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1596 frontend ext-check
1597 bind :9999
1598 monitor-uri /ext-check
1599 monitor fail if { stopping }
1600
1601 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1602 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1603 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1604 SIGUSR1 signal.
1605
1606 Example:
1607
1608 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1609 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1610 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1611 frontend ext-check
1612 bind :9999
1613 monitor-uri /ext-check
1614 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1615
1616 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1617
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001618group <group name>
1619 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1620 See also "gid" and "user".
1621
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001622h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1623 Does not reject HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1624
1625 While It is explicitly allowed in HTTP/1.1, HTTP/1.0 is not clear on this
1626 point and some old servers don't expect any payload and never look for body
1627 length (via Content-Length or Transfer-Encoding headers). It means that some
1628 intermediaries may properly handle the payload for HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE
1629 requests, while some others may totally ignore it. That may lead to security
1630 issues because a request smuggling attack is possible. Thus, by default,
1631 HAProxy rejects HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1632
1633 However, it may be an issue with some old clients. In this case, this global
1634 option may be set.
1635
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001636h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1637 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1638 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1639 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1640 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001641 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001642 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1643 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1644 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1645 specified in a proxy.
1646
1647 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1648 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1649 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1650 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1651 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1652 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1653 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1654
1655 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1656 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1657 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1658 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1659 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1660
1661 Example:
1662 global
1663 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1664
1665 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1666 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1667
1668h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1669 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1670 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1671 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1672 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1673 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1674 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1675 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1676 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1677
1678 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1679 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1680 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1681
1682 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1683 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1684
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001685h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1686 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1687 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1688 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1689 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1690 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1691 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1692 the keyword with "no'.
1693
1694hard-stop-after <time>
1695 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1696
1697 Arguments :
1698 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1699 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1700 SIGUSR1 signal.
1701
1702 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1703 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1704 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1705
1706 Example:
1707 global
1708 hard-stop-after 30s
1709
1710 See also: grace
1711
William Lallemande279f592023-05-11 21:08:38 +02001712httpclient.resolvers.disabled <on|off>
1713 Disable the DNS resolution of the httpclient. Prevent the creation of the
1714 "default" resolvers section.
1715
1716 Default value is off.
1717
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001718httpclient.resolvers.id <resolvers id>
1719 This option defines the resolvers section with which the httpclient will try
1720 to resolve.
1721
1722 Default option is the "default" resolvers ID. By default, if this option is
1723 not used, it will simply disable the resolving if the section is not found.
1724
1725 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1726 configuration error if it fails to load.
1727
1728httpclient.resolvers.prefer <ipv4|ipv6>
1729 This option allows to chose which family of IP you want when resolving,
1730 which is convenient when IPv6 is not available on your network. Default
1731 option is "ipv6".
1732
William Lallemand4ad693e2023-09-05 15:55:04 +02001733httpclient.retries <number>
1734 This option allows to configure the number of retries attempt of the
1735 httpclient when a request failed. This does the same as the "retries" keyword
1736 in a backend.
1737
1738 Default value is 3.
1739
William Lallemandde1803f2022-05-04 18:14:25 +02001740httpclient.ssl.ca-file <cafile>
1741 This option defines the ca-file which should be used to verify the server
1742 certificate. It takes the same parameters as the "ca-file" option on the
1743 server line.
1744
1745 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1746 "@system-ca" which tries to load the CA of the system. If it fails the SSL
1747 will be disabled for the httpclient.
1748
1749 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1750 configuration error if it fails.
1751
1752httpclient.ssl.verify [none|required]
1753 Works the same way as the verify option on server lines. If specified to 'none',
1754 servers certificates are not verified. Default option is "required".
1755
1756 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1757 "required". If it fails the SSL will be disabled for the httpclient.
1758
1759 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1760 configuration error if it fails.
1761
William Lallemandb9ed1572023-09-05 16:42:27 +02001762httpclient.timeout.connect <timeout>
1763 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt by default for the
1764 httpclient.
1765
1766 Arguments :
1767 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
1768 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1769 as explained at the top of this document.
1770
1771 The default value is 5000ms.
1772
1773
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001774insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001775 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001776 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1777 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1778 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1779 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1780 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1781 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1782 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001783 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001784 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1785 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1786 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1787 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1788 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1789 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1790 disable it.
1791
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001792insecure-setuid-wanted
1793 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1794 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1795 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1796 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001797 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001798 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001799 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001800 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1801 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001802 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001803 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1804 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1805 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1806 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1807
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001808issuers-chain-path <dir>
1809 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1810 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1811 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001812 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001813 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1814 "issuers-chain-path".
1815 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1816 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1817 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1818 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1819 will share the chain in memory.
1820
Frédéric Lécailleffb67d52023-07-21 18:32:32 +02001821limited-quic
1822 This setting must be used to explicitly enable the QUIC listener bindings when
1823 haproxy is compiled against a TLS/SSL stack without QUIC support, typically
1824 OpenSSL. It has no effect when haproxy is compiled against a TLS/SSL stack
1825 with QUIC support, quictls for instance. Note that QUIC 0-RTT is not supported
1826 when this setting is set.
1827
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001828localpeer <name>
1829 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1830 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1831 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1832 the configuration parsing.
1833
1834 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1835 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1836
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001837log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001838 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001839 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001840 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001841 configured with "log global".
1842
1843 <address> can be one of:
1844
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001845 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001846 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1847 port).
1848
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001849 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1850 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1851 port).
1852
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001853 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001854 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1855 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001856 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001857
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001858 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1859 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1860 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1861 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1862 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1863 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1864 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1865 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1866 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1867 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001868 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001869 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1870 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1871 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001872 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1873 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001874
1875 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1876 "fd@2", see above.
1877
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001878 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1879 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1880 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1881 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1882 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1883
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001884 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1885 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001886
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001887 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1888 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1889 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1890 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1891 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1892 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1893 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1894 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1895 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1896 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001897 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1898 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001899
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001900 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1901 one of the following :
1902
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001903 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1904 field is stripped. This is the default.
1905 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1906 rfc3164.
1907
1908 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001909 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1910
1911 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1912 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1913
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001914 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1915 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1916 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1917 designed to be used with a local log server.
1918
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001919 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1920 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1921 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1922 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1923 logger consumes.
1924
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001925 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1926 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1927 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1928 used with a local log server.
1929
1930 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1931 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1932 designed to be used with a local log server.
1933
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001934 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1935 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1936 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1937 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1938
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001939 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1940 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1941 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1942 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1943 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1944
1945 <sample_size>
1946 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1947 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1948 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1949 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1950 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1951
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001952 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001953
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001954 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1955 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1956 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1957
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001958 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1959 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1960 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1961 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001962
1963 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001964 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1965 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1966 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1967 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1968 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1969 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001970
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001971 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001972
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001973log-send-hostname [<string>]
1974 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1975 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1976 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1977 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1978 the logs.
1979
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001980log-tag <string>
1981 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1982 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1983 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001984 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001985
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001986lua-load <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001987 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1988 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1989 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1990 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1991 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1992 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001993 used multiple times.
1994
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001995 args are available in the lua file using the code below in the body of the
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001996 file. Do not forget that Lua arrays start at index 1. A "local" variable
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001997 declared in a file is available in the entire file and not available on
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001998 other files.
1999
2000 local args = table.pack(...)
2001
2002lua-load-per-thread <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01002003 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
2004 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
2005 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
2006 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
2007 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
2008 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
2009 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
2010 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
2011 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
2012 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
2013 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
2014 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
2015 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
2016 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
2017 times.
2018
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02002019 See lua-load for usage of args.
2020
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01002021lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
2022 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
2023 variable.
2024 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
2025 to "path".
2026
2027 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
2028 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
2029 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
2030 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
2031 will be checked earlier.
2032
2033 As an example by specifying the following path:
2034
2035 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
2036 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
2037
2038 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
2039 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
2040 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
2041 paths if that does not exist either.
2042
2043 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
2044 documentation.
2045
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01002046master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02002047 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
2048 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
2049 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002050 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02002051 or daemon mode.
2052
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01002053 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
2054 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
2055 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
2056 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
2057 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02002058
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01002059 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02002060
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02002061mworker-max-reloads <number>
2062 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002063 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02002064 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
2065 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
2066 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
2067
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02002068nbthread <number>
2069 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002070 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
2071 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
2072 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
2073 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
2074 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
2075 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
2076 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02002077
Frédéric Lécaille12a03172023-01-12 15:23:54 +01002078no-quic
Frédéric Lécaille12a03172023-01-12 15:23:54 +01002079 Disable QUIC transport protocol. All the QUIC listeners will still be created.
2080 But they will not bind their addresses. Hence, no QUIC traffic will be
2081 processed by haproxy. See also "quic_enabled" sample fetch.
2082
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01002083numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01002084 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
2085 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
2086 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
2087 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
2088 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
2089 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
2090 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
2091 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
2092 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
2093 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01002094
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002095pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09002096 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
2097 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
2098 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
2099 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002100
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02002101pp2-never-send-local
2102 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
2103 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
2104 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
2105 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
2106 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
2107 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
2108 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
2109 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
2110 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
2111 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
2112 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
2113
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002114presetenv <name> <value>
2115 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2116 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
2117 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
2118 and "unsetenv".
2119
Patrick Hemmer425d7ad2023-05-23 13:02:08 -04002120prealloc-fd
2121 Performs a one-time open of the maximum file descriptor which results in a
2122 pre-allocation of the kernel's data structures. This prevents short pauses
2123 when nbthread>1 and HAProxy opens a file descriptor which requires the kernel
2124 to expand its data structures.
2125
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002126resetenv [<name> ...]
2127 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
2128 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
2129 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
2130 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
2131 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
2132 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
2133 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
2134 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
2135
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002136server-state-base <directory>
2137 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002138 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
2139 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02002140
2141server-state-file <file>
2142 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
2143 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
2144 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
2145 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
2146 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
2147 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
2148 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
2149 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002150 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
2151 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002152
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002153set-dumpable
2154 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
2155 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
2156 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
2157 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
2158 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
2159 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
2160 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
2161 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
2162 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
2163 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
2164 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
2165 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
2166 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
2167 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
2168 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
2169 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
2170 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
2171 leaves a core where expected when dying.
2172
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002173set-var <var-name> <expr>
2174 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
2175 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2176 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2177 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
2178 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
2179 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002180 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002181 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
2182 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2183
2184 Example:
2185 global
2186 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
2187 set-var proc.prio int(100)
2188 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
2189
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002190set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
2191 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
2192 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2193 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2194 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
2195 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
2196 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
2197 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
2198 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
2199 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2200 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
2201
2202 Example:
2203 global
2204 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
2205 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
2206
Willy Tarreaua547a212023-08-29 10:24:26 +02002207setcap <name>[,<name>...]
2208 Sets a list of capabilities that must be preserved when starting with uid 0
2209 and switching to a non-zero uid. By default all permissions are lost by the
2210 uid switch, but some are often needed when trying connecting to a server from
2211 a foreign address during transparent proxying, or when binding to a port
2212 below 1024, e.g. when using "tune.quic.socket-owner connection", resulting in
2213 setups running entirely under uid 0. Setting capabilities generally is a
2214 safer alternative, as only the required capabilities will be preserved. The
2215 feature is OS-specific and only enabled on Linux when USE_LINUX_CAP=1 is set
2216 at build time. The list of supported capabilities also depends on the OS and
2217 is enumerated by the error message displayed when an invalid capability name
2218 or an empty one is passed. Multiple capabilities may be passed, delimited by
2219 commas. Among those commonly used, "cap_net_raw" allows to transparently bind
2220 to a foreign address, and "cap_net_bind_service" allows to bind to a
2221 privileged port and may be used by QUIC.
2222
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002223setenv <name> <value>
2224 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2225 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
2226 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
2227 and "unsetenv".
2228
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002229ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
2230 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2231 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002232 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002233 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002234 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2235 information and recommendations see e.g.
2236 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2237 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
2238 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
2239 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002240
2241ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2242 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2243 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
2244 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
2245 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2246 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002247 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2248 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2249 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002250 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002251
William Lallemandb6ae2aa2023-05-05 00:05:46 +02002252ssl-default-bind-client-sigalgs <sigalgs>
2253 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2254 the default string describing the list of signature algorithms related to
2255 client authentication for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2256 theirs. The format of the string is a colon-delimited list of signature
2257 algorithms. Each signature algorithm can use one of two forms: TLS1.3 signature
2258 scheme names ("rsa_pss_rsae_sha256") or the public key algorithm + digest form
2259 ("ECDSA+SHA256"). A list can contain both forms. For more information on the
2260 format, see SSL_CTX_set1_client_sigalgs(3). A list of signature algorithms is
2261 also available in RFC8446 section 4.2.3 and in OpenSSL in the ssl/t1_lib.c
2262 file. This setting is not applicable to TLSv1.1 and earlier versions of the
2263 protocol as the signature algorithms aren't separately negotiated in these
2264 versions. It is not recommended to change this setting unless compatibility
2265 with a middlebox is required.
2266
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02002267ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
2268 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2269 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
2270 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
2271 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
2272 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
2273
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002274ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
2275 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2276 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
2277 keyword to see available options.
2278
2279 Example:
2280 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02002281 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002282
William Lallemand1d3c8222023-05-04 15:33:55 +02002283ssl-default-bind-sigalgs <sigalgs>
2284 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2285 sets the default string describing the list of signature algorithms that
2286 are negotiated during the TLSv1.2 and TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines
2287 which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is a
2288 colon-delimited list of signature algorithms. Each signature algorithm can
2289 use one of two forms: TLS1.3 signature scheme names ("rsa_pss_rsae_sha256")
2290 or the public key algorithm + digest form ("ECDSA+SHA256"). A list
2291 can contain both forms. For more information on the format,
2292 see SSL_CTX_set1_sigalgs(3). A list of signature algorithms is also
2293 available in RFC8446 section 4.2.3 and in OpenSSL in the ssl/t1_lib.c file.
2294 This setting is not applicable to TLSv1.1 and earlier versions of the
2295 protocol as the signature algorithms aren't separately negotiated in these
2296 versions. It is not recommended to change this setting unless compatibility
2297 with a middlebox is required.
2298
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002299ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
2300 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2301 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002302 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002303 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002304 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2305 information and recommendations see e.g.
2306 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2307 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
2308 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
2309 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
2310 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002311
2312ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2313 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2314 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
2315 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
2316 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
2317 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002318 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2319 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2320 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
2321 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002322
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002323ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
2324 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2325 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
2326 keyword to see available options.
2327
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002328ssl-dh-param-file <file>
2329 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2330 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
2331 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002332 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002333 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02002334 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02002335 directly in the certificate file, DHE ciphers will not be used, unless
2336 tune.ssl.default-dh-param is set. In this latter case, pre-defined DH
2337 parameters of the specified size will be used. Custom parameters are known to
2338 be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002339 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
2340 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
2341 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
2342
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02002343ssl-propquery <query>
2344 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2345 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to define a default property
2346 string used when fetching algorithms in providers. It behave the same way as
2347 the openssl propquery option and it follows the same syntax (described in
2348 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man3.0/man7/property.html). For instance, if you
2349 have two providers loaded, the foo one and the default one, the propquery
2350 "?provider=foo" allows to pick the algorithm implementations provided by the
2351 foo provider by default, and to fallback on the default provider's one if it
2352 was not found.
2353
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002354ssl-provider <name>
2355 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2356 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to load a provider during init.
2357 If loading is successful, any capabilities provided by the loaded provider
2358 might be used by HAProxy. Multiple 'ssl-provider' options can be specified in
2359 a configuration file. The providers will be loaded in their order of
2360 appearance.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002361
2362 Please note that loading a provider explicitly prevents OpenSSL from loading
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002363 the 'default' provider automatically. OpenSSL also allows to define the
2364 providers that should be loaded directly in its configuration file
2365 (openssl.cnf for instance) so it is not necessary to use this 'ssl-provider'
2366 option to load providers. The "show ssl providers" CLI command can be used to
2367 show all the providers that were successfully loaded.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002368
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002369 The default search path of OpenSSL provider can be found in the output of the
2370 "openssl version -a" command. If the provider is in another directory, you
2371 can set the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable, which takes the directory
2372 where your provider can be found.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002373
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02002374 See also "ssl-propquery" and "ssl-provider-path".
2375
2376ssl-provider-path <path>
2377 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2378 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to specify the search path that
2379 is to be used by OpenSSL for looking for providers. It behaves the same way
2380 as the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable. It will be used for any
2381 following 'ssl-provider' option or until a new 'ssl-provider-path' is
2382 defined.
2383 See also "ssl-provider".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002384
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002385ssl-load-extra-del-ext
2386 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
2387 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002388 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002389 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002390 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
2391
2392 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002393
2394 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
2395 and won't try to remove them.
2396
2397 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
2398
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002399ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002400 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002401 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
2402 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
2403 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002404
2405 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
2406 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
2407 optimize the startup time.
2408
2409 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
2410 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
2411 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
2412
2413 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002414 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002415
2416 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002417 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
2418 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002419
2420 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
2421 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
2422 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
2423 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
2424 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002425 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002426
2427 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002428 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002429 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
2430 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
2431 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
2432 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2433 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002434 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002435
2436 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2437
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002438 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002439 a cert bundle.
2440
2441 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2442 separately in several "crt".
2443
2444 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2445 since files are loading separately.
2446
2447 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2448 required to commit them.
2449
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002450 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002451 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002452
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002453 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2454 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2455 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002456
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002457 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2458 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2459 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002460
2461 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002462 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2463 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002464
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002465 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2466 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2467
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002468 The default behavior is "all".
2469
2470 Example:
2471 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2472 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2473 ssl-load-extra-files none
2474
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002475 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2476 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002477
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002478ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2479 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2480 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2481 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2482
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002483ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002484 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002485 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2486 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2487 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2488 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2489 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2490 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002491 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002492
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002493stats maxconn <connections>
2494 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2495 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2496
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002497stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2498 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2499 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2500 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002501 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002502 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002503
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002504 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2505 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2506 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002507
2508stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2509 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2510 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002511 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002512
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002513strict-limits
2514 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2515 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2516 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2517 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2518 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002519
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002520thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2521 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2522 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2523 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2524 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2525 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2526 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2527 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2528 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2529 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2530
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002531thread-groups <number>
2532 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2533 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
Willy Tarreau856d56d2022-07-15 21:46:55 +02002534 moment, the default value is 1. Thread groups make it possible to reduce
2535 sharing between threads to limit contention, at the expense of some extra
2536 configuration efforts. It is also the only way to use more than 64 threads
2537 since up to 64 threads per group may be configured. The maximum number of
2538 groups is configured at compile time and defaults to 16. See also "nbthread".
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002539
Willy Tarreau9fd05422022-11-16 17:29:12 +01002540trace <args...>
2541 This command configures one "trace" subsystem statement. Each of them can be
2542 found in the management manual, and follow the exact same syntax. Only one
2543 statement per line is permitted (i.e. if some long trace configurations using
2544 semi-colons are to be imported, they must be placed one per line). Any output
2545 that the "trace" command would produce will be emitted during the parsing
2546 step of the section. Most of the time these will be errors and warnings, but
2547 certain incomplete commands might list permissible choices. This command is
2548 not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by developers
2549 along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally marked as
2550 experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must appear on a
2551 line before any "trace" statement. Note that these directives are parsed on
2552 the fly, so referencing a ring buffer that is only declared further will not
2553 work. For such use cases it is suggested to place another "global" section
2554 with only the "trace" statements after the declaration of that ring. It is
2555 important to keep in mind that depending on the trace level and details,
2556 enabling traces can severely degrade the global performance. Please refer to
2557 the management manual for the statements syntax.
2558
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002559uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002560 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002561 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2562 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2563 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2564
2565ulimit-n <number>
2566 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2567 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002568 option. If the intent is only to limit the number of file descriptors, better
2569 use "fd-hard-limit" instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002570
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002571 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2572 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2573 manually specify this value.
2574
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002575 See also: fd-hard-limit, maxconn
2576
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002577unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2578 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2579
2580 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2581 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2582 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2583 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2584 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002585 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002586 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2587 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2588 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2589 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2590
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002591unsetenv [<name> ...]
2592 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2593 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2594 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2595 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2596 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2597 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2598 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2599
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002600user <user name>
2601 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2602 See also "uid" and "group".
2603
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002604node <name>
2605 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2606
2607 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2608 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2609 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2610 traffic.
2611
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002612wurfl-cache-size <size>
2613 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2614 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2615 - "0" : no cache is used.
2616 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002617
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002618 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2619 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002620
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002621wurfl-data-file <file path>
2622 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2623 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2624
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002625 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002626 with USE_WURFL=1.
2627
2628wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2629 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2630 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2631 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2632
2633 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2634
2635 Valid WURFL properties are:
2636 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2637
2638 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2639 device.
2640
2641 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2642 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2643
2644 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2645 particular web request.
2646
2647 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2648 used Libwurfl API version.
2649
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002650 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2651 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2652
2653 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2654 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2655
2656 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2657
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002658 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002659 with USE_WURFL=1.
2660
2661wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2662 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2663 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2664
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002665 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002666 with USE_WURFL=1.
2667
2668wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2669 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2670 thus before the chroot.
2671
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002672 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002673 with USE_WURFL=1.
2674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026753.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002676-----------------------
2677
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002678busy-polling
2679 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2680 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2681 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2682 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2683 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2684 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2685 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2686 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2687 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2688 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2689 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2690 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2691 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2692 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2693 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2694 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2695 "poll" pollers.
2696
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002697 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2698 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2699 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2700
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002701max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002702 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002703 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2704 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2705 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2706 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2707 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2708 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2709 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2710
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002711maxcompcpuusage <number>
2712 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2713 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2714 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2715 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2716 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2717 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2718 and from introducing high latencies.
2719
2720maxcomprate <number>
2721 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2722 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2723 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2724 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2725 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2726 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2727 default value.
2728
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002729maxconn <number>
2730 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2731 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2732 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002733 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2734 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2735 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2736 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002737 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2738 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2739 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2740 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2741 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002742 also be automatic). In any case, the fd-hard-limit applies if set.
2743
2744 See also: fd-hard-limit, ulimit-n
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002745
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002746maxconnrate <number>
2747 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2748 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2749 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2750 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2751 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2752 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2753 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2754 fairness.
2755
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002756maxpipes <number>
2757 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2758 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2759 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2760 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2761 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2762 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2763
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002764maxsessrate <number>
2765 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2766 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2767 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2768 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2769 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2770 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2771 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2772 fairness.
2773
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002774maxsslconn <number>
2775 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2776 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2777 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2778 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2779 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2780 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2781 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002782 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2783 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2784 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2785 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002786 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002787 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2788 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002789
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002790maxsslrate <number>
2791 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2792 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2793 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2794 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2795 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2796 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2797 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2798 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2799 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2800 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2801
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002802maxzlibmem <number>
2803 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2804 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2805 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002806 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2807 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2808 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2809
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002810no-memory-trimming
2811 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2812 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2813 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2814 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2815 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2816 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2817 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2818 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2819 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2820 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2821 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2822 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2823 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2824 not suffer from such a problem.
2825
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002826noepoll
2827 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2828 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002829 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002830
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002831noevports
2832 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2833 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2834 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2835 also "nopoll".
2836
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002837nogetaddrinfo
2838 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2839 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2840
2841nokqueue
2842 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2843 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2844 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2845
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002846nopoll
2847 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2848 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002849 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002850 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2851 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002852
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002853noreuseport
2854 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2855 command line argument "-dR".
2856
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002857nosplice
2858 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002859 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002860 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002861 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002862 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2863 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2864 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2865 "option splice-response".
2866
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002867profiling.memory { on | off }
2868 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2869 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2870 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2871 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2872 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2873 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2874 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2875 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2876 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2877
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002878profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2879 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2880 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2881 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2882 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002883 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002884 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2885 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2886 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2887 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2888
2889 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2890 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2891 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2892 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2893 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002894 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2895 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2896 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2897 CLI.
2898
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002899spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002900 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2901 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2902 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2903 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2904 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2905 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002906
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002907ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002908 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002909 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002910 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002911 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002912 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2913 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2914 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002915 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2916 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002917 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2918 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2919 openssl configuration file uses:
2920 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2921
Aleksandar Lazic89fb2102022-07-27 15:24:54 +02002922 HAProxy Version 2.6 disabled the support for engines in the default build.
2923 This option is only available when HAProxy has been built with support for
2924 it. In case the ssl-engine is required HAProxy can be rebuild with the
2925 USE_ENGINE=1 flag.
2926
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002927ssl-mode-async
2928 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002929 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002930 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2931 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002932 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002933 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002934 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002935
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002936tune.buffers.limit <number>
2937 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2938 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2939 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2940 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2941 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002942 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002943 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2944 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2945 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2946 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2947 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2948 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2949 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2950 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002951 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002952
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002953tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2954 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2955 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2956 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002957 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002958
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002959tune.bufsize <number>
2960 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2961 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2962 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2963 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2964 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2965 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2966 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002967 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2968 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002969 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002970 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002971 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002972 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2973 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002974
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002975tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2976 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2977 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2978 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2979 this value. The default value is 1.
2980
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01002981tune.disable-fast-forward [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2982 Disables the data fast-forwarding. It is a mechanism to optimize the data
2983 forwarding by passing data directly from a side to the other one without
2984 waking the stream up. Thanks to this directive, it is possible to disable
2985 this optimization. Note it also disable any kernel tcp splicing. This command
2986 is not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by
2987 developers along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally
2988 marked as experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must
2989 appear on a line before this directive.
2990
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002991tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreauf4b79c42022-02-23 15:20:53 +01002992 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC or started with "-dMfail", gives the
2993 percentage of chances an allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no
2994 failure) and 100 (no success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory
Willy Tarreau0c4348c2023-03-21 09:24:53 +01002995 failures are handled gracefully. When not set, the ratio is 0. However the
2996 command-line "-dMfail" option automatically sets it to 1% failure rate so that
2997 it is not necessary to change the configuration for testing.
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002998
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002999tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
3000 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
3001 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
3002 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
3003 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
3004 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
3005
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003006tune.h2.be.initial-window-size <number>
3007 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size for outgoing connections, which is the
3008 number of bytes the server can respond before waiting for an acknowledgment
3009 from HAProxy. This setting only affects payload contents, not headers. When
3010 not set, the common default value set by tune.h2.initial-window-size applies.
3011 It can make sense to slightly increase this value to allow faster downloads
3012 or to reduce CPU usage on the servers, at the expense of creating unfairness
3013 between clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
Tim Duesterhuse3ebe0e2023-06-13 15:15:47 +02003014
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003015 See also: tune.h2.initial-window-size.
3016
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003017tune.h2.be.max-concurrent-streams <number>
3018 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per outgoing connection
3019 (i.e. the number of outstanding requests on a single connection to a server).
3020 When not set, the default set by tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams applies. A
3021 smaller value than the default 100 may improve a site's responsiveness at the
3022 expense of maintaining more established connections to the servers. When the
3023 "http-reuse" setting is set to "always", it is recommended to reduce this
3024 value so as not to mix too many different clients over the same connection,
3025 because if a client is slower than others, a mechanism known as "head of
3026 line blocking" tends to cause cascade effect on download speed for all
3027 clients sharing a connection (keep tune.h2.be.initial-window-size low in this
3028 case). It is highly recommended not to increase this value; some might find
3029 it optimal to run at low values (1..5 typically).
3030
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003031tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size <number>
3032 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size for incoming connections, which is the
3033 number of bytes the client can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment
3034 from HAProxy. This setting only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of
3035 POST requests), not headers. When not set, the common default value set by
3036 tune.h2.initial-window-size applies. It can make sense to increase this value
3037 to allow faster uploads. The default value of 65536 allows up to 5 Mbps of
3038 bandwidth per client over a 100 ms ping time, and 500 Mbps for 1 ms ping
3039 time. It doesn't affect resource usage. Using too large values may cause
3040 clients to experience a lack of responsiveness if pages are accessed in
Tim Duesterhuse3ebe0e2023-06-13 15:15:47 +02003041 parallel to large uploads.
3042
3043 See also: tune.h2.initial-window-size.
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003044
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003045tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams <number>
3046 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per incoming connection
3047 (i.e. the number of outstanding requests on a single connection from a
3048 client). When not set, the default set by tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
3049 applies. A larger value than the default 100 may sometimes slightly improve
3050 the page load time for complex sites with lots of small objects over high
3051 latency networks but can also result in using more memory by allowing a
3052 client to allocate more resources at once. The default value of 100 is
3053 generally good and it is recommended not to change this value.
3054
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02003055tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
3056 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
3057 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
3058 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
3059 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
3060 change it.
3061
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02003062tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003063 Sets the default value for the HTTP/2 initial window size, on both incoming
3064 and outgoing connections. This value is used for incoming connections when
3065 tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size is not set, and by outgoing connections when
3066 tune.h2.be.initial-window-size is not set. The default value is 65536, which
3067 for uploads roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of bandwidth per client over a
3068 network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps over a 1-ms local network.
3069 Given that changing the default value will both increase upload speeds and
3070 cause more unfairness between clients on downloads, it is recommended to
3071 instead use the side-specific settings tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size and
3072 tune.h2.be.initial-window-size.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02003073
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02003074tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003075 Sets the default HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection
Willy Tarreau2fefab62023-05-07 07:10:55 +02003076 (i.e. the number of outstanding requests on a single connection). This value
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003077 is used for incoming connections when tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams is
3078 not set, and for outgoing connections when tune.h2.be.max-concurrent-streams
3079 is not set. The default value is 100. The impact varies depending on the side
3080 so please see the two settings above for more details. It is recommended not
3081 to use this setting and to switch to the per-side ones instead. A value of
3082 zero disables the limit so a single client may create as many streams as
3083 allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02003084
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01003085tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003086 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01003087 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003088 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01003089 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
3090 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
3091 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
3092 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
3093
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003094tune.http.cookielen <number>
3095 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
3096 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
3097 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
3098 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
3099 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
3100 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
3101 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
3102 to change this value.
3103
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02003104tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003105 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
3106 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02003107 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003108 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02003109 configuration directives too.
3110 The default value is 1024.
3111
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02003112tune.http.maxhdr <number>
3113 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
3114 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
3115 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
3116 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
3117 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
3118 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02003119 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
3120 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
3121 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02003122
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02003123tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
3124 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
3125 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
3126 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
3127 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
3128 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
3129 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01003130 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
3131 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
3132 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
3133 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
3134 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02003135
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01003136tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003137 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01003138 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
3139 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
3140 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
3141 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003142 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003143 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003144 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01003145 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
3146
Willy Tarreau73101642023-04-22 22:06:23 +02003147tune.listener.default-shards { by-process | by-thread | by-group }
3148 Normally, all "bind" lines will create a single shard, that is, a single
3149 socket that all threads of the process will listen to. With many threads,
3150 this is not very efficient, and may even induce some important overhead in
3151 the kernel for updating the polling state or even distributing events to the
3152 various threads. Modern operating systems support balancing of incoming
3153 connections, a mechanism that will consist in permitting multiple sockets to
3154 be bound to the same address and port, and to evenly distribute all incoming
3155 connections to these sockets so that each thread only sees the connections
3156 that are waiting in the socket it is bound to. This significantly reduces
3157 kernel-side overhead and increases performance in the incoming connection
3158 path. This is usually enabled in HAProxy using the "shards" setting on "bind"
3159 lines, which defaults to 1, meaning that each listener will be unique in the
3160 process. On systems with many processors, it may be more convenient to change
3161 the default setting to "by-thread" in order to always create one listening
3162 socket per thread, or "by-group" in order to always create one listening
3163 socket per thread group. Be careful about the file descriptor usage with
3164 "by-thread" as each listener will need as many sockets as there are threads.
3165 Also some operating systems (e.g. FreeBSD) are limited to no more than 256
3166 sockets on a same address. Note that "by-group" will remain equivalent to
3167 "by-process" for default configurations involving a single thread group, and
3168 will fall back to sharing the same socket on systems that do not support this
Willy Tarreau0e875cf2023-04-23 00:51:59 +02003169 mechanism. The default is "by-group" with a fallback to "by-process" for
3170 systems or socket families that do not support multiple bindings.
Willy Tarreau73101642023-04-22 22:06:23 +02003171
Willy Tarreau84fe1f42023-04-20 15:40:38 +02003172tune.listener.multi-queue { on | fair | off }
3173 Enables ('on' / 'fair') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept
3174 which spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to
3175 run on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01003176 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
3177 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
Willy Tarreau84fe1f42023-04-20 15:40:38 +02003178 with one thread for example). The default mode, "on", optimizes the choice of
3179 a thread by picking in a sample the one with the less connections. It is
3180 often the best choice when connections are long-lived as it manages to keep
3181 all threads busy. A second mode, "fair", instead cycles through all threads
3182 regardless of their instant load level. It can be better suited for short-
3183 lived connections, or on machines with very large numbers of threads where
3184 the probability to find the least loaded thread with the first mode is low.
3185 Finally it is possible to forcefully disable the redistribution mechanism
3186 using "off" for troubleshooting, or for situations where connections are
Willy Tarreau2fefab62023-05-07 07:10:55 +02003187 short-lived and it is estimated that the operating system already provides a
Willy Tarreau84fe1f42023-04-20 15:40:38 +02003188 good enough distribution. The default is "on".
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01003189
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003190tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
3191 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003192 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003193 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
3194 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003195 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003196 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
3197 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
3198
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01003199tune.lua.maxmem
3200 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
3201 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
3202 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
3203 memory.
3204
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003205tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
3206 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003207 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
3208 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003209 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003210
Aurelien DARRAGON58e36e52023-04-06 22:51:56 +02003211tune.lua.burst-timeout <timeout>
3212 The "burst" execution timeout applies to any Lua handler. If the handler
3213 fails to finish or yield before timeout is reached, it will be aborted to
3214 prevent thread contention, to prevent traffic from not being served for too
3215 long, and ultimately to prevent the process from crashing because of the
3216 watchdog kicking in. Unlike other lua timeouts which are yield-cumulative,
3217 burst-timeout will ensure that the time spent in a single lua execution
3218 window does not exceed the configured timeout.
3219
3220 Yielding here means that the lua execution is effectively interrupted
3221 either through an explicit call to lua-yielding function such as
3222 core.(m)sleep() or core.yield(), or following an automatic forced-yield
3223 (see tune.lua.forced-yield) and that it will be resumed later when the
3224 related task is set for rescheduling. Not all lua handlers may yield: we have
3225 to make a distinction between yieldable handlers and unyieldable handlers.
3226
3227 For yieldable handlers (tasks, actions..), reaching the timeout means
3228 "tune.lua.forced-yield" might be too high for the system, reducing it
3229 could improve the situation, but it could also be a good idea to check if
3230 adding manual yields at some key points within the lua function helps or not.
3231 It may also indicate that the handler is spending too much time in a specific
3232 lua library function that cannot be interrupted.
3233
3234 For unyieldable handlers (lua converters, sample fetches), it could simply
3235 indicate that the handler is doing too much computation, which could result
3236 from an improper design given that such handlers, which often block the
3237 request execution flow, are expected to terminate quickly to allow the
3238 request processing to go through. A common resolution approach here would be
3239 to try to better optimize the lua function for speed since decreasing
3240 "tune.lua.forced-yield" won't help.
3241
3242 This timeout only counts the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a core.sleep,
3243 the sleeping time is not taken in account. The default timeout is 1000ms.
3244
3245 Note: if a lua GC cycle is initiated from the handler (either explicitly
3246 requested or automatically triggered by lua after some time), the GC cycle
3247 time will also be accounted for.
3248
3249 Indeed, there is no way to deduce the GC cycle time, so this could lead to
3250 some false positives on saturated systems (where GC is having hard time to
3251 catch up and consumes most of the available execution runtime). If it were
3252 to be the case, here are some resolution leads:
3253
3254 - checking if the script could be optimized to reduce lua memory footprint
3255 - fine-tuning lua GC parameters and / or requesting manual GC cycles
3256 (see: https://www.lua.org/manual/5.4/manual.html#pdf-collectgarbage)
3257 - increasing tune.lua.burst-timeout
3258
3259 Setting value to 0 completely disables this protection.
3260
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003261tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
3262 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
3263 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
3264 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003265 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003266
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003267tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
3268 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
3269 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
3270 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
3271 check servers.
3272
Tristan2632d042023-10-23 13:07:39 +01003273tune.lua.log.loggers { on | off }
3274 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') logging the output of LUA scripts via the
3275 loggers applicable to the current proxy, if any.
3276
3277 Defaults to 'on'.
3278
3279tune.lua.log.stderr { on | auto | off }
3280 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') logging the output of LUA scripts via
3281 stderr.
3282 When set to 'auto', logging via stderr is conditionally 'on' if any of:
3283
3284 - tune.lua.log.loggers is set to 'off'
3285 - the script is executed in a non-proxy context with no global logger
3286 - the script is executed in a proxy context with no logger attached
3287
3288 Please note that, when enabled, this logging is in addition to the logging
3289 configured via tune.lua.log.loggers.
3290
3291 Defaults to 'on'.
3292
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01003293tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01003294 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
3295 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01003296 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
3297 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
3298 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
3299 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
3300 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
3301 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
3302 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
3303 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
3304 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01003305
3306tune.maxpollevents <number>
3307 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
3308 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
3309 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
3310 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
3311 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
3312
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02003313tune.maxrewrite <number>
3314 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
3315 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
3316 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
3317 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
3318 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
3319 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
3320 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
3321 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
3322 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
3323 bufsize.
3324
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01003325tune.memory.hot-size <number>
3326 Sets the per-thread amount of memory that will be kept hot in the local cache
3327 and will never be recoverable by other threads. Access to this memory is very
3328 fast (lockless), and having enough is critical to maintain a good performance
3329 level under extreme thread contention. The value is expressed in bytes, and
3330 the default value is configured at build time via CONFIG_HAP_POOL_CACHE_SIZE
3331 which defaults to 524288 (512 kB). A larger value may increase performance in
3332 some usage scenarios, especially when performance profiles show that memory
3333 allocation is stressed a lot. Experience shows that a good value sits between
3334 once to twice the per CPU core L2 cache size. Too large values will have a
3335 negative impact on performance by making inefficient use of the L3 caches in
3336 the CPUs, and will consume larger amounts of memory. It is recommended not to
3337 change this value, or to proceed in small increments. In order to completely
3338 disable the per-thread CPU caches, using a very small value could work, but
3339 it is better to use "-dMno-cache" on the command-line.
3340
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003341tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
3342 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
3343 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
3344 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
3345 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
3346 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
3347 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
3348 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
3349 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
3350 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02003351 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
3352 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003353 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
3354 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
3355 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
3356 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
3357 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
3358 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
3359 setting this parameter to 0.
3360
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02003361tune.peers.max-updates-at-once <number>
3362 Sets the maximum number of stick-table updates that haproxy will try to
3363 process at once when sending messages. Retrieving the data for these updates
3364 requires some locking operations which can be CPU intensive on highly
3365 threaded machines if unbound, and may also increase the traffic latency
3366 during the initial batched transfer between an older and a newer process.
3367 Conversely low values may also incur higher CPU overhead, and take longer
3368 to complete. The default value is 200 and it is suggested not to change it.
3369
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02003370tune.pipesize <number>
3371 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
3372 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
3373 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
3374 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
3375 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
3376 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
3377
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003378tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
3379 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003380 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003381 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
3382 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
3383 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
3384 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003385 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003386
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003387tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
3388 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003389 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003390 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
3391 default is 20.
3392
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003393tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit <number>
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003394 This settings defines the maximum number of buffers allocated for a QUIC
3395 connection on data emission. By default, it is set to 30. QUIC buffers are
3396 drained on ACK reception. This setting has a direct impact on the throughput
3397 and memory consumption and can be adjusted according to an estimated round
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003398 time-trip. Each buffer is tune.bufsize.
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003399
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02003400tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout <timeout>
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02003401 Sets the QUIC max_idle_timeout transport parameters in milliseconds for
3402 frontends which determines the period of time after which a connection silently
3403 closes if it has remained inactive during an effective period of time deduced
3404 from the two max_idle_timeout values announced by the two endpoints:
3405 - the minimum of the two values if both are not null,
3406 - the maximum if only one of them is not null,
3407 - if both values are null, this feature is disabled.
3408
3409 The default value is 30000.
3410
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02003411tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi <number>
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02003412 Sets the QUIC initial_max_streams_bidi transport parameter for frontends.
3413 This is the initial maximum number of bidirectional streams the remote peer
3414 will be authorized to open. This determines the number of concurrent client
3415 requests.
3416
3417 The default value is 100.
3418
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01003419tune.quic.max-frame-loss <number>
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01003420 Sets the limit for which a single QUIC frame can be marked as lost. If
3421 exceeded, the connection is considered as failing and is closed immediately.
3422
3423 The default value is 10.
3424
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003425tune.quic.retry-threshold <number>
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003426 Dynamically enables the Retry feature for all the configured QUIC listeners
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02003427 as soon as this number of half open connections is reached. A half open
3428 connection is a connection whose handshake has not already successfully
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003429 completed or failed. To be functional this setting needs a cluster secret to
3430 be set, if not it will be silently ignored (see "cluster-secret" setting).
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02003431 This setting will be also silently ignored if the use of QUIC Retry was
3432 forced (see "quic-force-retry").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003433
3434 The default value is 100.
3435
3436 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
3437 information about QUIC retry.
3438
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003439tune.quic.socket-owner { listener | connection }
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003440 Specifies how QUIC connections will use socket for receive/send operations.
3441 Connections can share listener socket or each connection can allocate its
3442 own socket.
3443
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003444 When default "connection" value is set, a dedicated socket will be allocated
3445 by every QUIC connections. This option is the preferred one to achieve the
Amaury Denoyellefb375572023-02-01 09:28:32 +01003446 best performance with a large QUIC traffic. This is also the only way to
Amaury Denoyellee1a0ee32023-02-28 15:11:09 +01003447 ensure soft-stop is conducted properly without data loss for QUIC connections
3448 and cases of transient errors during sendto() operation are handled
3449 efficiently. However, this relies on some advanced features from the UDP
Amaury Denoyellefb375572023-02-01 09:28:32 +01003450 network stack. If your platform is deemed not compatible, haproxy will
Willy Tarreau2a3d9282023-08-29 10:22:46 +02003451 automatically switch to "listener" mode on startup. Please note that QUIC
3452 listeners running on privileged ports may require to run as uid 0, or some
Willy Tarreaua547a212023-08-29 10:24:26 +02003453 OS-specific tuning to permit the target uid to bind such ports, such as
3454 system capabilities. See also the "setcap" global directive.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003455
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003456 The "listener" value indicates that QUIC transfers will occur on the shared
3457 listener socket. This option can be a good compromise for small traffic as it
3458 allows to reduce FD consumption. However, performance won't be optimal due to
Ilya Shipitsin5fa29b82022-12-07 09:46:19 +05003459 a higher CPU usage if listeners are shared across a lot of threads or a
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003460 large number of QUIC connections can be used simultaneously.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003461
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003462tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
3463tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
3464 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
3465 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3466 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003467 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003468 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003469 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3470 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3471
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003472tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003473 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003474 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
3475 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
3476 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
3477 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
3478
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003479tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003480 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01003481 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
3482 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
3483 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
3484 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
3485 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
3486 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
3487 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003488
3489tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
3490 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003491 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003492 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
3493 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
3494 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
3495 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
3496 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
3497 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
3498 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003499
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003500tune.sndbuf.client <number>
3501tune.sndbuf.server <number>
3502 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
3503 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3504 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003505 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003506 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003507 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3508 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3509 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
3510 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003511 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003512
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003513tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01003514 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01003515 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
3516 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
3517 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
3518 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
3519 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
3520 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
3521 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
3522 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
3523 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02003524 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
3525 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003526
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003527tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
3528tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
3529 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
3530 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
3531 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
3532 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
3533
3534tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
3535 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
3536 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
3537 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
3538 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
3539 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
3540 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
3541 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
3542 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
3543 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
3544 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
3545 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
3546 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
3547
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003548tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02003549 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003550 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
3551 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
3552 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
3553 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
3554 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
3555
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003556tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord <number>
3557 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at any time. Default
3558 value 0 means there is no limit. In contrast to tune.ssl.maxrecord this
3559 settings will not be adjusted dynamically. Smaller records may decrease
3560 throughput, but may be required when dealing with low-footprint clients.
3561
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003562tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
3563 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
3564 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
3565 performances. This is disabled by default.
3566
3567 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
3568 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
3569
3570 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
3571
3572 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
3573
3574 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
3575
3576 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
3577 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
3578 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
3579
3580 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
3581 converted.
3582
3583 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
3584 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
3585 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
3586 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
3587 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
3588 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
3589 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02003590 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
3591 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003592
3593 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
3594
3595 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
3596 only need this line:
3597
3598 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
3599
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003600tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
3601 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003602 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003603 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
3604 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
3605 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
3606 being used for too long.
3607
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003608tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003609 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at the beginning of
3610 the data transfer. Default value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS,
3611 the client can decipher the data only once it has received a full record.
3612 With large records, it means that clients might have to download up to 16kB
3613 of data before starting to process them. Limiting the value can improve page
3614 load times on browsers located over high latency or low bandwidth networks.
3615 It is suggested to find optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments
3616 (generally 1448 bytes over Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when
3617 timestamps are disabled), keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead.
3618 Typical values of 1419 and 2859 gave good results during tests. Use
3619 "strace -e trace=write" to find the best value. HAProxy will automatically
3620 switch to this setting after an idle stream has been detected (see
3621 tune.idletimer above). See also tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord.
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003622
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02003623tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
3624 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3625 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3626 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3627 1000 entries.
3628
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +01003629tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay <number>
3630 Sets the maximum interval between two automatic updates of the same OCSP
3631 response. This time is expressed in seconds and defaults to 3600 (1 hour). It
3632 must be set to a higher value than "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay". See
3633 option "ocsp-update" for more information about the auto update mechanism.
3634
3635tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay <number>
3636 Sets the minimum interval between two automatic updates of the same OCSP
3637 response. This time is expressed in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 minutes).
3638 It is particularly useful for OCSP response that do not have explicit
3639 expiration times. It must be set to a lower value than
3640 "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay". See option "ocsp-update" for more
3641 information about the auto update mechanism.
3642
3643 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3644 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3645 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3646 1000 entries.
3647
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01003648tune.stick-counters <number>
3649 Sets the number of stick-counters that may be tracked at the same time by a
3650 connection or a request via "track-sc*" actions in "tcp-request" or
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02003651 "http-request" rules. The default value is set at build time by the macro
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01003652 MAX_SESS_STK_CTR, and defaults to 3. With this setting it is possible to
3653 change the value and ignore the one passed at build time. Increasing this
3654 value may be needed when porting complex configurations to haproxy, but users
3655 are warned against the costs: each entry takes 16 bytes per connection and
3656 16 bytes per request, all of which need to be allocated and zeroed for all
3657 requests even when not used. As such a value of 10 will inflate the memory
3658 consumption per request by 320 bytes and will cause this memory to be erased
3659 for each request, which does have measurable CPU impacts. Conversely, when
3660 no "track-sc" rules are used, the value may be lowered (0 being valid to
3661 entirely disable stick-counters).
3662
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003663tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003664tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003665tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
3666tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
3667tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003668 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
3669 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
3670 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
3671 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
3672 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
3673 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
3674 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
3675 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003676
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003677 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
3678 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
3679 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
3680 all available space is consumed.
3681 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
3682 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
3683 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003684
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003685tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
3686 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003687 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003688 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003689 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003690 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
3691
3692tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
3693 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
3694 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003695 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
3696 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020036983.3. Debugging
3699--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003700
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003701anonkey <key>
3702 This sets the global anonymizing key to <key>, which must be a 32-bit number
3703 between 0 and 4294967295. This is the key that will be used by default by CLI
3704 commands when anonymized mode is enabled. This key may also be set at runtime
Amaury Denoyelledd3a33f2023-03-03 17:11:10 +01003705 from the CLI command "set anon global-key". See also command line argument
3706 "-dC" in the management manual.
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003707
Willy Tarreaue98d3852022-11-15 09:34:07 +01003708quick-exit
3709 This speeds up the old process exit upon reload by skipping the releasing of
3710 memory objects and listeners, since all of these are reclaimed by the
3711 operating system at the process' death. The gains are only marginal (in the
3712 order of a few hundred milliseconds for huge configurations at most). The
3713 main target usage in fact is when a bug is spotted in the deinit() code, as
3714 this allows to bypass it. It is better not to use this unless instructed to
3715 do so by developers.
3716
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003717quiet
3718 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
3719 line argument "-q".
3720
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003721zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003722 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003723 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
3724 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
3725 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
3726 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
3727 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
3728
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003729
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010037303.4. Userlists
3731--------------
3732It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
3733http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
3734it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
3735
3736userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003737 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003738 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
3739
3740group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003741 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003742 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
3743 proceeded by "users" keyword.
3744
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003745user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
3746 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003747 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
3748 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003749 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
3750 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
3751 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
3752 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003753
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003754 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
3755 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
3756 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
3757 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
3758 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
3759 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
3760 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003761 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003762 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003763
3764 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003765 userlist L1
3766 group G1 users tiger,scott
3767 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003768
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003769 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3770 user scott insecure-password elgato
3771 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003772
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003773 userlist L2
3774 group G1
3775 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003776
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003777 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3778 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3779 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003780
3781 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003782
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003783
37843.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003785----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003786It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003787several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003788instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003789values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3790type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3791values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3792active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3793switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3794present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3795watch it.
3796
3797Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3798known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3799the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3800process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3801during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3802tables.
3803
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003804Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3805that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3806each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003807
3808peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003809 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003810 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3811
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003812bind [<address>]:port [param*]
3813bind /<path> [param*]
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003814 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3815 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3816
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003817disabled
3818 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3819 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3820 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3821
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003822default-bind [param*]
3823 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3824
3825default-server [param*]
3826 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3827
3828 Arguments:
3829 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3830 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003831 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3832 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3833 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3834 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003835
3836 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3837
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003838enabled
3839 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3840 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003841
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003842log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003843 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3844 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3845 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3846 more details.
3847
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003848peer <peername> [<address>]:port [param*]
3849peer <peername> /<path> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003850 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3851 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003852 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003853 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on the provided
3854 address. Otherwise, the address defines where to connect to in order to join
3855 the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003856 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003857
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003858 During a soft restart, local peer address is used by the old instance to
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003859 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3860
3861 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003862 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3863 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3864 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003865
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003866 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3867 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003868
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003869 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3870 "server" keyword explanation below).
3871
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003872server <peername> [<address>:<port>] [param*]
3873server <peername> [/<path>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003874 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003875 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003876 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, the address
3877 parameter must not be present; it must be provided on a "bind" line (see
3878 "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003879
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003880 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3881 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3882 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3883 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3884 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003885
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003886 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003887 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003888 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003889 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3890 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3891 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003892
3893 backend mybackend
3894 mode tcp
3895 balance roundrobin
3896 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3897 stick on src
3898
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003899 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3900 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003901
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003902 Example:
3903 peers mypeers
Emeric Brune77984f2022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003904 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3905 default-server ssl verify none
3906 server haproxy1 #local peer
3907 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3908 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003909
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +02003910shards <shards>
3911
3912 In some configurations, one would like to distribute the stick-table contents
3913 to some peers in place of sending all the stick-table contents to each peer
3914 declared in the "peers" section. In such cases, "shards" specifies the
3915 number of peer involved in this stick-table contents distribution.
3916 See also "shard" server parameter.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003917
3918table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3919 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3920
3921 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3922 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003923 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003924 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3925 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3926 "stick-table" keyword).
3927
3928 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3929 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3930 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3931 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3932 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3933 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3934 of the stick-table name as follows:
3935
3936 peers mypeers
3937 peer A ...
3938 peer B ...
3939 table t1 ...
3940
3941 frontend fe1
3942 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3943
3944 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3945 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3946
3947 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3948 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3949 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3950 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3951 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3952 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3953 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3954
3955 peers mypeers
3956 peer A ...
3957 peer B ...
3958 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3959
3960 backend t1
3961 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3962
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003963 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003964 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3965 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3966
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090039673.6. Mailers
3968------------
3969It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3970If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3971in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3972
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003973mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003974 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3975 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3976
3977mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3978 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3979
3980 Example:
3981 mailers mymailers
3982 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3983 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3984
3985 backend mybackend
3986 mode tcp
3987 balance roundrobin
3988
3989 email-alert mailers mymailers
3990 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3991 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3992
3993 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3994 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3995
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003996timeout mail <time>
3997 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3998 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3999 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
4000 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
4001
4002 Example:
4003 mailers mymailers
4004 timeout mail 20s
4005 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004006
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020040073.7. Programs
4008-------------
4009In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
4010master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
4011managed the same way as the workers.
4012
4013During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
4014sequence as a worker:
4015
4016 - the master is re-executed
4017 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
4018 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
4019 instance of the program
4020
4021During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
4022
4023program <name>
4024 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
4025 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
4026 the management guide).
4027
4028command <command> [arguments*]
4029 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
4030 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
4031 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
4032 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
4033
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08004034user <user name>
4035 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
4036 See also "group".
4037
4038group <group name>
4039 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
4040 See also "user".
4041
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02004042option start-on-reload
4043no option start-on-reload
4044 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
4045 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
4046 program section.
4047
4048
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010040493.8. HTTP-errors
4050----------------
4051
4052It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
4053imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
4054several places and can be fully or partially imported.
4055
4056http-errors <name>
4057 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
4058 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
4059
4060errorfile <code> <file>
4061 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
4062
4063 Arguments :
4064 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004065 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004066 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004067
4068 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
4069 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
4070 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
4071 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4072 before any chroot is performed.
4073
4074 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
4075
4076 Example:
4077 http-errors website-1
4078 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
4079 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
4080 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
4081
4082 http-errors website-2
4083 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
4084 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
4085 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
4086
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020040873.9. Rings
4088----------
4089
4090It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
4091servers or traces.
4092
4093ring <ringname>
4094 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
4095
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02004096backing-file <path>
4097 This replaces the regular memory allocation by a RAM-mapped file to store the
4098 ring. This can be useful for collecting traces or logs for post-mortem
4099 analysis, without having to attach a slow client to the CLI. Newer contents
4100 will automatically replace older ones so that the latest contents are always
4101 available. The contents written to the ring will be visible in that file once
4102 the process stops (most often they will even be seen very soon after but
4103 there is no such guarantee since writes are not synchronous).
4104
4105 When this option is used, the total storage area is reduced by the size of
4106 the "struct ring" that starts at the beginning of the area, and that is
4107 required to recover the area's contents. The file will be created with the
4108 starting user's ownership, with mode 0600 and will be of the size configured
Willy Tarreau32872db2022-08-31 18:52:17 +02004109 by the "size" directive. When the directive is parsed (thus even during
4110 config checks), any existing non-empty file will first be renamed with the
4111 extra suffix ".bak", and any previously existing file with suffix ".bak" will
4112 be removed. This ensures that instant reload or restart of the process will
4113 not wipe precious debugging information, and will leave time for an admin to
4114 spot this new ".bak" file and to archive it if needed. As such, after a crash
4115 the file designated by <path> will contain the freshest information, and if
4116 the service is restarted, the "<path>.bak" file will have it instead. This
4117 means that the total storage capacity required will be double of the ring
4118 size. Failures to rotate the file are silently ignored, so placing the file
4119 into a directory without write permissions will be sufficient to avoid the
4120 backup file if not desired.
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02004121
4122 WARNING: there are stability and security implications in using this feature.
4123 First, backing the ring to a slow device (e.g. physical hard drive) may cause
4124 perceptible slowdowns during accesses, and possibly even panics if too many
4125 threads compete for accesses. Second, an external process modifying the area
4126 could cause the haproxy process to crash or to overwrite some of its own
4127 memory with traces. Third, if the file system fills up before the ring,
4128 writes to the ring may cause the process to crash.
4129
4130 The information present in this ring are structured and are NOT directly
4131 readable using a text editor (even though most of it looks barely readable).
4132 The output of this file is only intended for developers.
4133
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004134description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004135 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004136 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
4137
4138format <format>
4139 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
4140
4141 Arguments:
4142 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
4143 one of the following :
4144
4145 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
4146 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
4147 designed to be used with a local log server.
4148
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01004149 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
4150 field is stripped. This is the default.
4151 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
4152 rfc3164.
4153
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004154 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
4155 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
4156 used in containers or during development, where the severity
4157 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
4158 is the default.
4159
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01004160 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004161 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
4162
4163 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
4164 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
4165
4166 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
4167 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
4168 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
4169 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
4170 logger consumes.
4171
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02004172 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
4173 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
4174 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
4175 with a local log server.
4176
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004177 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
4178 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
4179 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
4180 used with a local log server.
4181
4182maxlen <length>
4183 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
4184 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
4185 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
4186
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004187server <name> <address> [param*]
4188 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
4189 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
4190 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
4191 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
4192 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
4193 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
4194 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
4195 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
4196 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02004197 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
4198 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004199
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004200size <size>
4201 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
4202 set to BUFSIZE.
4203
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004204timeout connect <timeout>
4205 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
4206
4207 Arguments :
4208 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4209 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4210 as explained at the top of this document.
4211
4212timeout server <timeout>
4213 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
4214
4215 Arguments :
4216 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4217 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4218 as explained at the top of this document.
4219
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004220 Example:
4221 global
4222 log ring@myring local7
4223
4224 ring myring
4225 description "My local buffer"
4226 format rfc3164
4227 maxlen 1200
4228 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004229 timeout connect 5s
4230 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02004231 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004232
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020042333.10. Log forwarding
4234-------------------
4235
4236It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004237HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004238
4239log-forward <name>
4240 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
4241
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004242backlog <conns>
4243 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4244 on connections accept.
4245
4246bind <addr> [param*]
4247 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02004248 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
4249 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
4250 syslog protocol over TCP.
4251 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004252 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
4253
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02004254dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004255 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
4256 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
4257 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
4258 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02004259 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004260
4261log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01004262log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004263 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
4264 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
4265 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004266 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004267 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
4268 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
4269 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004270 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004271
4272 Example:
4273 global
4274 log stderr format iso local7
4275
4276 ring myring
4277 description "My local buffer"
4278 format rfc5424
4279 maxlen 1200
4280 size 32764
4281 timeout connect 5s
4282 timeout server 10s
4283 # syslog tcp server
4284 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
4285
4286 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004287 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
4288 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004289 # all messages on stderr
4290 log global
4291 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
4292 log ring@myring local0
4293 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
4294 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
4295 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
4296 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
4297 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004298
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004299maxconn <conns>
4300 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
4301 10 is the default.
4302
4303timeout client <timeout>
4304 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
4305
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020043064. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004307----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004308
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004309Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004310 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
4311 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4312 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4313 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004314
4315A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
4316connections.
4317
4318A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
4319to forward incoming connections.
4320
4321A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
4322parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
4323
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004324A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
4325ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
4326sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
4327the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
4328explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
4329from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
4330"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
4331for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
4332to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
4333optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
4334are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
4335any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
4336names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
4337that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
4338duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02004339names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
4340is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
4341implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
4342encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
4343adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004344
4345Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
4346settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
4347of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
4348profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
4349timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
4350
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004351All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
4352'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
4353case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
4354
4355Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
4356logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
4357proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
4358However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
4359name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
4360
4361Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
4362and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004363bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004364protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
4365modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
4366arbitrary criteria.
4367
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004368In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
4369a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01004370the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004371
4372 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
4373 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
4374 between responses and new requests.
4375
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004376 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
4377 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
4378 client-facing connection remains open.
4379
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004380 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
4381 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004382
4383The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
4384frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
4385following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004386weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004387
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004388 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004389
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004390 | KAL | SCL | CLO
4391 ----+-----+-----+----
4392 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
4393 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004394 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
4395 ----+-----+-----+----
4396 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004397
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004398It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004399only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
4400within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004401as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004402content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004403and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
4404possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004405
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004406There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004407first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004408processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004409second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004410protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
4411is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
4412new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004413to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004414process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
4415already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
4416HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
4417evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
4418one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
4419
4420There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
4421performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
4422tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
4423preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
4424analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
4425HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
4426header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
4427mitigate this drawback.
4428
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004429There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004430method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
4431set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
4432in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
4433is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
4434to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
4435above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
4436to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
4437"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
4438frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
4439frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
4440as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
4441upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
4442on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
4443the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
4444upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
4445frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
4446remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004447
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044484.1. Proxy keywords matrix
4449--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004450
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004451The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
4452limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
4453they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
4454limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004455marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004456option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02004457and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
4458with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004459specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
4460sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
4461anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004462
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004463
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004464 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
4465------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004466acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004467backlog X X X -
4468balance X - X X
4469bind - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004470capture cookie - X X -
4471capture request header - X X -
4472capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004473clitcpka-cnt X X X -
4474clitcpka-idle X X X -
4475clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004476compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004477cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004478declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004479default-server X - X X
4480default_backend X X X -
4481description - X X X
4482disabled X X X X
4483dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004484email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004485email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004486email-alert mailers X X X X
4487email-alert myhostname X X X X
4488email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004489enabled X X X X
4490errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004491errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004492errorloc X X X X
4493errorloc302 X X X X
4494-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4495errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02004496error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004497force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004498filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004499fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004500hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004501http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004502http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004503http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004504http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004505http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02004506http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02004507http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004508http-check set-var X - X X
4509http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004510http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004511http-request X (!) X X X
4512http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004513http-reuse X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGONdf238c32023-01-12 15:59:27 +01004514http-send-name-header X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004515id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004516ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004517load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004518log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004519log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004520log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004521log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004522max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004523maxconn X X X -
4524mode X X X X
4525monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004526monitor-uri X X X -
4527option abortonclose (*) X - X X
4528option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
4529option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
4530option allbackups (*) X - X X
4531option checkcache (*) X - X X
4532option clitcpka (*) X X X -
4533option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02004534option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004535option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
4536option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004537-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4538option forwardfor X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01004539option forwarded (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02004540option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
4541option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004542option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02004543option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004544option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004545option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02004546option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02004547option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004548option http-server-close (*) X X X X
4549option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
4550option httpchk X - X X
4551option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01004552option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02004553option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004554option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004555option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004556option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004557option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
4558option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
4559option logasap (*) X X X -
4560option mysql-check X - X X
4561option nolinger (*) X X X X
4562option originalto X X X X
4563option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02004564option pgsql-check X - X X
4565option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004566option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004567option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004568option smtpchk X - X X
4569option socket-stats (*) X X X -
4570option splice-auto (*) X X X X
4571option splice-request (*) X X X X
4572option splice-response (*) X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +01004573option spop-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004574option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
4575option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
4576-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004577option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004578option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
4579option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
4580option tcpka X X X X
4581option tcplog X X X X
4582option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01004583option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004584external-check command X - X X
4585external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004586persist rdp-cookie X - X X
4587rate-limit sessions X X X -
4588redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004589-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004590retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02004591retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004592server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004593server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02004594server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004595source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004596srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
4597srvtcpka-idle X - X X
4598srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02004599stats admin - X X X
4600stats auth X X X X
4601stats enable X X X X
4602stats hide-version X X X X
4603stats http-request - X X X
4604stats realm X X X X
4605stats refresh X X X X
4606stats scope X X X X
4607stats show-desc X X X X
4608stats show-legends X X X X
4609stats show-node X X X X
4610stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004611-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4612stick match - - X X
4613stick on - - X X
4614stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02004615stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01004616stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004617tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004618tcp-check connect X - X X
4619tcp-check expect X - X X
4620tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004621tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004622tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004623tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004624tcp-check set-var X - X X
4625tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004626tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
4627tcp-request content X (!) X X X
4628tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
4629tcp-request session X (!) X X -
4630tcp-response content X (!) - X X
4631tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004632timeout check X - X X
4633timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004634timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004635timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004636timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
4637timeout http-request X X X X
4638timeout queue X - X X
4639timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004640timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004641timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004642timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004643transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01004644unique-id-format X X X -
4645unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004646use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02004647use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02004648use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004649------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
4650 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004651
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004652
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
4654---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004655
4656This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
4657
4658
4659acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
4660 Declare or complete an access list.
4661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004662 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
4663
4664 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
4665 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
4666 using it.
4667
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004668 Example:
4669 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
4670 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
4671 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
4672
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004673 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004674
4675
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004676backlog <conns>
4677 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4679 yes | yes | yes | no
4680 Arguments :
4681 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
4682 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004683 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004684
4685 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
4686 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
4687 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
4688 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
4689 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
4690 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
4691 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
4692 backlog parameter.
4693
4694 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
4695 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
4696 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
4697
4698 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
4699
4700
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004701balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004702balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004703 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
4704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4705 yes | no | yes | yes
4706 Arguments :
4707 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
4708 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
4709 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
4710 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
4711
4712 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4713 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
4714 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
4715 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004716 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08004717 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004718 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
4719 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
4720 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
4721 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
4722 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
4723 it, so that you don't worry.
4724
4725 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4726 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
4727 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
4728 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
4729 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
4730 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
4731 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
4732 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004733
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004734 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
4735 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
4736 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
4737 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
4738 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
4739 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
4740 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02004741 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
4742 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
4743 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004744
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004745 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004746 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004747 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
4748 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004749 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004750 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
4751 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
4752 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
4753 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
4754 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004755 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
4756 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
4757 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
4758 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
4759 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
4760 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004761
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004762 hash Takes a regular sample expression in argument. The expression
4763 is evaluated for each request and hashed according to the
4764 configured hash-type. The result of the hash is divided by
4765 the total weight of the running servers to designate which
4766 server will receive the request. This can be used in place of
4767 "source", "uri", "hdr()", "url_param()", "rdp-cookie" to make
4768 use of a converter, refine the evaluation, or be used to
4769 extract data from local variables for example. When the data
4770 is not available, round robin will apply. This algorithm is
4771 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4772 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
4773 changed using "hash-type".
4774
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004775 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
4776 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
4777 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
4778 address will always reach the same server as long as no
4779 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
4780 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
4781 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
4782 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004783 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004784 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004785 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4786 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004787 changed using "hash-type". See also the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004788
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004789 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
4790 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
4791 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
4792 the running servers. The result designates which server will
4793 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
4794 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
4795 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
4796 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
4797 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
4798 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4799 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4800 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004801
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004802 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004803 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
4804 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
4805 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
4806 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
4807 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
4808 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
4809 URIs start with a leading "/".
4810
4811 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
4812 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
4813 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
4814 evaluation stops when either is reached.
4815
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004816 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
4817 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
4818 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004819 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash. See also the
4820 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004821
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004822 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004823 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
4824
4825 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004826 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
4827 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004828 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
4829 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
4830 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
4831 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004832 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004833 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
4834 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004835
4836 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
4837 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
4838 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4839 server will receive the request.
4840
4841 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4842 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4843 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4844 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4845 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004846 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4847 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004848 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also
4849 the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004850
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004851 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4852 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4853 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4854 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4855 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004856
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004857 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004858 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4859 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4860 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4861
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004862 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4863 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004864 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4865 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004866
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004867 random
4868 random(<draws>)
4869 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004870 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4871 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4872 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4873 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004874 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4875 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4876 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4877 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4878 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4879 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4880 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4881 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4882 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4883 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4884 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4885 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4886 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4887 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4888 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4889 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4890 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4891 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4892 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4893 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004894
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004895 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004896 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004897 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4898 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004899 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004900 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4901 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4902 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004903 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004904 used instead.
4905
4906 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4907 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4908 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004909 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004910
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004911 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4912 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004913 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4914 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004915
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004916 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004917 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4918 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004919
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004920 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4921 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4922 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004923
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004924 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004925 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004926 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4927 NTLM relies on.
4928
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004929 Examples :
4930 balance roundrobin
4931 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004932 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004933 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4934 balance hdr(host)
4935 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004936 balance hash req.cookie(clientid)
4937 balance hash var(req.client_id)
4938 balance hash req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1),ipmask(24)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004939
4940 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4941 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4942
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004943 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004944 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4945 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4946 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004947 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004948
4949 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4950 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4951 defaults to 16 kB.
4952
4953 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4954 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4955
4956 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4957 Round Robin.
4958
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004959 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004960 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4961 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4962 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4963
4964 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4965
4966 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004967 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004968 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4969 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4970 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004971
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004972 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004973
4974
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004975bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4976bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004977 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4979 no | yes | yes | no
4980 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004981 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4982 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4983 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4984 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004985 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'. Note
4986 that if you bind a frontend to multiple UDP addresses you have
4987 no guarantee about the address which will be used to respond.
4988 This is why "0.0.0.0" addresses and lists of comma-separated
4989 IP addresses have been forbidden to bind QUIC addresses.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004990 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4991 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4992 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4993 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4994 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4995 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004996 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004997 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4998 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004999 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02005000 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
5001 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02005002 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02005003 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
5004 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005005 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02005006 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01005007 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
5008 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
5009 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02005010 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
5011 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
5012 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
5013 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01005014 - 'quic4@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01005015 is used. Note that to achieve the best performance with a
Artur Pydoe6ca4182023-06-06 11:49:59 +02005016 large traffic you should keep "tune.quic.socket-owner" on
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01005017 connection. Else QUIC connections will be multiplexed
5018 over the listener socket. Another alternative would be to
5019 duplicate QUIC listener instances over several threads,
5020 for example using "shards" keyword to at least reduce
5021 thread contention.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01005022 - 'quic6@' -> address is resolved as IPv6 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyelle7078fb12022-11-22 11:26:16 +01005023 is used. The performance note for QUIC over IPv4 applies
5024 as well.
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005025
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005026 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5027 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
5028 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01005029
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01005030 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
5031 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005032 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
5033 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
5034 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01005035 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
5036 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
5037 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
5038 the range.
5039
5040 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
5041 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
5042 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
5043 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
5044 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
5045 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
5046 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005047 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01005048 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005049
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005050 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005051 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005052 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
5053 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
5054 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
5055 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
5056 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
5057 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
5058
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005059 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
5060 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
5061 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
5062 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02005063
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005064 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
5065 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
5066 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
5067 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
5068 in a frontend.
5069
5070 Example :
5071 listen http_proxy
5072 bind :80,:443
5073 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005074 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005075
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02005076 listen http_https_proxy
5077 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02005078 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02005079
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005080 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
5081 bind ipv6@:80
5082 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
5083 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
5084
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005085 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005086 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005087
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005088 listen h3_quic_proxy
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +02005089 bind quic4@10.0.0.1:8888 ssl crt /etc/mycrt
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005090
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02005091 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
5092 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
5093 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
5094 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
5095 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
5096
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005097 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005098 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005099
5100
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005101capture cookie <name> len <length>
5102 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
5103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5104 no | yes | yes | no
5105 Arguments :
5106 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
5107 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
5108 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
5109 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005110 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005111
5112 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
5113 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
5114 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
5115 right if it exceeds <length>.
5116
5117 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
5118 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
5119 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
5120 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
5121
5122 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
5123 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
5124 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
5125
5126 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
5127 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
5128 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01005129 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
5130 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
5131 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005132
5133 Example:
5134 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
5135
5136 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005137 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005138
5139
5140capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005141 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5143 no | yes | yes | no
5144 Arguments :
5145 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005146 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005147 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
5148 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
5149 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
5150
5151 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
5152 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
5153 it exceeds <length>.
5154
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005155 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005156 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
5157 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005158 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
5159 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
5160 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
5161 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005162 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005163 environments to find where the request came from.
5164
5165 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
5166 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
5167 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
5168 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005169
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01005170 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
5171 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
5172 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
5173 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
5174 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005175
5176 Example:
5177 capture request header Host len 15
5178 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01005179 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005180
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005181 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005182 about logging.
5183
5184
5185capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005186 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5188 no | yes | yes | no
5189 Arguments :
5190 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005191 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005192 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
5193 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
5194 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
5195
5196 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
5197 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
5198 it exceeds <length>.
5199
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005200 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005201 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
5202 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
5203 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005204 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
5205 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
5206 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
5207 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005208
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01005209 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
5210 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
5211 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
5212 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
5213 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005214
5215 Example:
5216 capture response header Content-length len 9
5217 capture response header Location len 15
5218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005219 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005220 about logging.
5221
5222
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005223clitcpka-cnt <count>
5224 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
5225 the connection on the client side.
5226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5227 yes | yes | yes | no
5228 Arguments :
5229 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
5230
5231 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
5232 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005233 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5234 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005235
5236 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
5237
5238
5239clitcpka-idle <timeout>
5240 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
5241 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
5242 client side.
5243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5244 yes | yes | yes | no
5245 Arguments :
5246 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
5247 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
5248 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
5249 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
5250
5251 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
5252 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005253 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5254 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005255
5256 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
5257
5258
5259clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
5260 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
5261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5262 yes | yes | yes | no
5263 Arguments :
5264 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
5265 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
5266 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
5267 document.
5268
5269 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
5270 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005271 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5272 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005273
5274 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
5275
5276
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005277compression algo <algorithm> ...
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005278compression algo-req <algorithm>
5279compression algo-res <algorithm>
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005280compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02005281 Enable HTTP compression.
5282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5283 yes | yes | yes | yes
5284 Arguments :
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005285 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms for
5286 responses (legacy keyword)
5287 algo-req is followed by compression algorithm for request (only one is
5288 provided).
5289 algo-res is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms for
5290 responses.
5291 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed for
5292 responses (legacy keyword).
5293 type-req is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed for
5294 requests.
5295 type-res is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed for
5296 responses.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005297
5298 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005299 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
5300 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
5301 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005302
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005303 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005304 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005305
5306 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
5307 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
5308 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
5309 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
5310 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005311 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005312
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005313 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
5314 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
5315 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
5316 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
5317 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
5318 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
5319 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005320 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005321
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04005322 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005323 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005324 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005325 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005326 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005327 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005328 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02005329
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005330 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005331 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
5332 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02005333 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005334 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005335 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
5336 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
5337 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
5338 "multipart"
5339 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
5340 header
5341 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
5342 and later
5343 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
5344 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005345 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005346
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01005347 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005348
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02005349 Examples :
5350 compression algo gzip
5351 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005352
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005353 See also : "compression offload", "compression direction"
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01005354
5355compression offload
5356 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
5357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5358 no | yes | yes | yes
5359
5360 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
5361 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
5362 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
5363 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
5364 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
5365 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
5366 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
5367 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
5368 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
5369 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
5370 then be used for such scenarios.
5371
5372 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
5373 option is ignored.
5374
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005375 See also : "compression type", "compression algo", "compression direction"
5376
5377compression direction <direction>
5378 Makes haproxy able to compress both requests and responses.
5379 Valid values are "request", to compress only requests, "response", to
5380 compress only responses, or "both", when you want to compress both.
5381 The default value is "response".
5382
5383 See also : "compression type", "compression algo", "compression offload"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005384
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005385cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005386 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
5387 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005388 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005389 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
5390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5391 yes | no | yes | yes
5392 Arguments :
5393 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
5394 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
5395 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
5396 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
5397 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
5398 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005399 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005400 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
5401 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
5402
5403 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005404 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005405 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
5406 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
5407 headers is left to the application. The application can then
5408 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005409 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
5410 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005411 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005412 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
5413 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005414
5415 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005416 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005417
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005418 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005419 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005420 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005421 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005422 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
5423 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
5424 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
5425 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
5426 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
5427 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
5428 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005429
5430 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
5431 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
5432 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
5433 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
5434 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
5435 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
5436 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
5437 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
5438 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005439 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005440 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
5441 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
5442 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005443
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005444 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
5445 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
5446 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005447 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
5448 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
5449 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
5450 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005451 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
5452 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
5453 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005454
5455 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
5456 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
5457 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
5458 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
5459 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
5460 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
5461 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
5462 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
5463 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
5464
5465 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
5466 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
5467 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
5468 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
5469 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
5470 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
5471 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
5472 persistence cookie in the cache.
5473 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
5474
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005475 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
5476 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005477 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005478 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
5479 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005480 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005481 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
5482 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
5483 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
5484 they logout.
5485
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005486 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005487 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
5488 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
5489 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
5490
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005491 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005492 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
5493 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
5494 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
5495 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
5496 this attribute.
5497
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005498 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005499 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01005500 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
5501 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
5502 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
5503 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
5504 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
5505 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005506
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005507 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
5508 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
5509 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
5510 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
5511 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
5512 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
5513 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
5514 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005515 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005516 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
5517 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
5518 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
5519 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
5520 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
5521 the site.
5522
5523 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
5524 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
5525 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
5526 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
5527 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
5528 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
5529 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
5530 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
5531 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
5532 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
5533 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
5534 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
5535 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005536 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005537 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
5538 redispatch after some absolute delay.
5539
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005540 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
5541 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
5542 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
5543 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
5544 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
5545 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
5546
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005547 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005548 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
5549 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
5550 repeated.
5551
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005552 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
5553 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
5554 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
5555 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02005556
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005557 Examples :
5558 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
5559 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5560 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005561 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005562
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02005563 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005564
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005565
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005566declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
5567 Declares a capture slot.
5568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5569 no | yes | yes | no
5570 Arguments:
5571 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
5572
5573 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
5574 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
5575 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
5576 for use in the response.
5577
5578 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02005579 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005580 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
5581
5582
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005583default-server [param*]
5584 Change default options for a server in a backend
5585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5586 yes | no | yes | yes
5587 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005588 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
5589 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
5590 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
5591 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005592
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005593 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005594 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
5595
5596 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005597
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005598
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005599default_backend <backend>
5600 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
5601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5602 yes | yes | yes | no
5603 Arguments :
5604 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
5605
5606 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
5607 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
5608 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
5609 will catch all undetermined requests.
5610
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005611 Example :
5612
5613 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
5614 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
5615 default_backend dynamic
5616
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02005617 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005618
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005619
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02005620description <string>
5621 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
5622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5623 no | yes | yes | yes
5624 Arguments : string
5625
5626 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
5627 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
5628 it describes.
5629 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
5630
5631
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005632disabled
5633 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5635 yes | yes | yes | yes
5636 Arguments : none
5637
5638 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
5639 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
5640 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
5641 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
5642 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
5643 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
5644 keyword in a "defaults" section.
5645
5646 See also : "enabled"
5647
5648
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005649dispatch <address>:<port>
5650 Set a default server address
5651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5652 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005653 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005654
5655 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
5656 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5657 during start-up.
5658
5659 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
5660 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
5661 possible with normal servers.
5662
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02005663 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005664 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
5665 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
5666 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
5667 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
5668
5669 See also : "server"
5670
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005671
5672dynamic-cookie-key <string>
5673 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
5674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5675 yes | no | yes | yes
5676 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
5677
5678 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005679 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005680 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
5681 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005682 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005683 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005684
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005685enabled
5686 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5688 yes | yes | yes | yes
5689 Arguments : none
5690
5691 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
5692 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
5693
5694 See also : "disabled"
5695
5696
5697errorfile <code> <file>
5698 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5700 yes | yes | yes | yes
5701 Arguments :
5702 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005703 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005704 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005705
5706 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005707 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005708 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005709 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
5710 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005711
5712 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5713 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5714 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5715
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005716 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5717
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02005718 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
5719 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
5720 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
5721 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
5722 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
5723 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
5724 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
5725 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
5726 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005727
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005728 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5729 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5730 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005731 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005732 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
5733
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005734 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005735
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005736 Example :
5737 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005738 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005739 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
5740 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
5741
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005742
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005743errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
5744 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
5745 section.
5746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5747 yes | yes | yes | yes
5748 Arguments :
5749 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
5750
5751 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005752 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005753 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
5754 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005755
5756 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
5757 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
5758 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
5759 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
5760 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005761 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005762 hand using "errorfile" directives.
5763
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005764 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
5765 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005766
5767 Example :
5768 errorfiles generic
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01005769 errorfiles site-1 403 404
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005770
5771
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005772errorloc <code> <url>
5773errorloc302 <code> <url>
5774 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5776 yes | yes | yes | yes
5777 Arguments :
5778 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005779 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005780 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005781
5782 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5783 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5784 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5785 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005786 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005787
5788 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5789 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5790 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5791
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005792 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5793
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005794 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
5795 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
5796 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
5797 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005798 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005799 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
5800 request.
5801
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005802 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005803
5804
5805errorloc303 <code> <url>
5806 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5808 yes | yes | yes | yes
5809 Arguments :
5810 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005811 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005812 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005813
5814 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5815 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5816 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5817 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005818 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005819
5820 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5821 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5822 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5823
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005824 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5825
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005826 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
5827 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
5828 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
5829 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005830 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005831
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005832 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005833
5834
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005835email-alert from <emailaddr>
5836 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005837 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005838 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5839 yes | yes | yes | yes
5840
5841 Arguments :
5842
5843 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
5844
5845 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5846 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5847
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005848 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02005849 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
5850 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005851
5852
5853email-alert level <level>
5854 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
5855 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
5856 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5857 yes | yes | yes | yes
5858
5859 Arguments :
5860
5861 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5862 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5863 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5864
5865 By default level is alert
5866
5867 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5868 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5869 for the proxy.
5870
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005871 Alerts are sent when :
5872
5873 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5874 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5875 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5876 is notice or lower
5877 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5878 and a health check status update occurs
5879
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005880 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5881 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005882 section 3.6 about mailers.
5883
5884
5885email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5886 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5887 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5888 yes | yes | yes | yes
5889
5890 Arguments :
5891
5892 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5893
5894 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5895 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5896
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005897 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5898 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005899
5900
5901email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5902 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5903 mailers.
5904 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5905 yes | yes | yes | yes
5906
5907 Arguments :
5908
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005909 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005910
5911 By default the systems hostname is used.
5912
5913 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5914 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5915 for the proxy.
5916
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005917 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5918 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005919
5920
5921email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005922 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005923 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5924 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5925 yes | yes | yes | yes
5926
5927 Arguments :
5928
5929 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5930
5931 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5932 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5933
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005934 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005935 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5936
5937
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005938error-log-format <string>
5939 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
5940 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5941 yes | yes | yes | no
5942
5943 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
5944 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
5945 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
5946 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01005947 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
5948
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005949 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
5950 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5951 string in depth.
5952
5953 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
5954 directives.
5955
5956
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005957force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5958 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5959 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005960 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005961
5962 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5963 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5964 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5965 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5966 marked down for maintenance operations.
5967
5968 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5969 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5970 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5971 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5972 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5973 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5974 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5975 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5976 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5977
5978 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5979 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5980 is used.
5981
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005982 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005983 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005984
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005985
5986filter <name> [param*]
5987 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5989 no | yes | yes | yes
5990 Arguments :
5991 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5992 referenced in section 9.
5993
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005994 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005995 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005996 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5997 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005998
5999 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
6000 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
6001
6002 Example:
6003 listen
6004 bind *:80
6005
6006 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
6007 filter compression
6008 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
6009
6010 compression algo gzip
6011 compression offload
6012
6013 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6014
6015 See also : section 9.
6016
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006017
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006018fullconn <conns>
6019 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
6020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6021 yes | no | yes | yes
6022 Arguments :
6023 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
6024 servers use the maximal number of connections.
6025
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006026 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006027 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006028 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006029 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
6030 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
6031 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
6032 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
6033 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006034 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006035
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006036 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02006037 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01006038 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
6039 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
6040 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02006041
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006042 Example :
6043 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
6044 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
6045 # connections.
6046 backend dynamic
6047 fullconn 10000
6048 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
6049 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
6050
6051 See also : "maxconn", "server"
6052
6053
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006054hash-balance-factor <factor>
6055 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
6056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6057 yes | no | no | yes
6058 Arguments :
6059 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
6060 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006061 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006062
6063 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
6064 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
6065 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
6066 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
6067 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
6068 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
6069 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
6070
6071 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
6072 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
6073 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
6074 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
6075 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
6076
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02006077 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
6078 consistent hashing mechanism.
6079
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006080 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
6081
6082
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006083hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006084 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
6085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6086 yes | no | yes | yes
6087 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006088 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
6089 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006090
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006091 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
6092 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
6093 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
6094 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
6095 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
6096 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
6097 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
6098 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
6099 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
6100 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01006101
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006102 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
6103 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
6104 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
6105 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
6106 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
6107 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
6108 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
6109 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
6110 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
6111 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
6112 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
6113 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
6114 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006115 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
6116 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006117
6118 <function> is the hash function to be used :
6119
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006120 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006121 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
6122 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
6123 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006124 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
6125 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
6126 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006127
6128 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
6129 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006130 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
6131 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
6132 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
6133 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
6134
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006135 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01006136 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
6137 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
6138 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
6139 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
6140 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
6141 parameter.
6142
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01006143 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
6144 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
6145 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
6146 used on strings.
6147
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006148 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
6149
6150 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
6151 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
6152 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
6153 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
6154 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
6155 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
6156 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
6157 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
6158 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
6159 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
6160 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
6161 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006162
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006163 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
6164 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
6165 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006166
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006167 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006168
6169
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006170http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6171 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
6172 ones).
6173
6174 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006175 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006176
6177 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
6178 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
6179 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6180 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6181 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6182 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6183
6184 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
6185 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
6186 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
6187
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006188 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6189 supported:
6190 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6191 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01006192 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006193 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006194 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006195 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006196 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6197 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01006198 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006199 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6200 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6201 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6202 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6203 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006204 - set-header <name> <fmt>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006205 - set-log-level <level>
6206 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006207 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006208 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
6209 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006210 - strict-mode { on | off }
6211 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6212
6213 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006214
6215 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
6216 instance.
6217
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006218 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6219 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6220 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6221 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6222 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6223 a defaults section defining such rules.
6224
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006225 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
6226 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
6227 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
6228
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006229 Example:
6230 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
6231 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
6232 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
6233
6234http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6235
6236 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006237 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
6238 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006239
Christopher Fauletd9d36b82023-01-05 10:25:30 +01006240http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6241
6242 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6243 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
6244
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01006245http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6246
6247 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6248 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
6249 complete description.
6250
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006251http-after-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6252
6253 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
6254 del-acl" for a complete description.
6255
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006256http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006257
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006258 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
6259 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006260
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006261http-after-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6262
6263 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
6264 del-map" for a complete description.
6265
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006266http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6267 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6268
6269 This works like "http-response replace-header".
6270
6271 Example:
6272 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
6273
6274 # applied to:
6275 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
6276
6277 # outputs:
6278 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
6279
6280 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
6281
6282http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6283 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6284
6285 This works like "http-response replace-value".
6286
6287 Example:
6288 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
6289
6290 # applied to:
6291 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
6292
6293 # outputs:
6294 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
6295
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01006296http-after-response sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6297 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6298
6299 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
6300 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
6301 a complete description.
6302
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006303http-after-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6304http-after-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6305http-after-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6306
6307 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
6308 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
6309 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
6310 description.
6311
6312http-after-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6313 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6314http-after-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6315 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6316
6317 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
6318 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +02006319 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006320
6321http-after-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6322
6323 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
6324 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
6325
6326http-after-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6327
6328 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
6329 set-map" for a complete description.
6330
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006331http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6332
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006333 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
6334 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6335 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6336 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006337
6338http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6339 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6340
6341 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05006342 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006343 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006344
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006345http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6346http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006347
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006348 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6349 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
6350 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006351
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006352http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006353
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006354 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
6355 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006356
6357http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6358
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006359 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
6360 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006361
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006362
6363http-check comment <string>
6364 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
6365 it fails.
6366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6367 yes | no | yes | yes
6368
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006369 Arguments :
6370 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
6371 rule fails.
6372
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006373 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
6374 user-friendly error reporting.
6375
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006376 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006377 "http-check expect".
6378
6379
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006380http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
6381 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01006382 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006383 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
6384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6385 yes | no | yes | yes
6386
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006387 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006388 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6389
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006390 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006391 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006392
6393 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
6394 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6395 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
6396 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
6397
6398 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
6399
6400 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6401
6402 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
6403
6404 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6405
6406 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
6407
6408 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
6409 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
6410 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
6411 is used.
6412
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02006413 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
6414 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
6415 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
6416 haproxy -vv.
6417
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006418 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
6419
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006420 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
6421 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
6422 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
6423 different ports or with different servers.
6424
6425 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6426 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
6427 the port with a "http-check connect".
6428
6429 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6430 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6431 do.
6432
6433 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
6434 unset-var or comment rules.
6435
6436 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006437 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6438 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6439 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6440 option httpchk
6441
6442 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006443 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006444 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006445 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006446 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006447 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006448
6449 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
6450
6451 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006452
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006453
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006454http-check disable-on-404
6455 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
6456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006457 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006458 Arguments : none
6459
6460 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
6461 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
6462 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
6463 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
6464 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
6465 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
6466 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
6467 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006468 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
6469 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01006470 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
6471 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
6472 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006473
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006474 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006475
6476
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006477http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006478 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
6479 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
6480 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006481 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02006483 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006484
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006485 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006486 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6487
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006488 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
6489 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
6490 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
6491 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
6492 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
6493 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
6494 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
6495 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
6496 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
6497 result is always conclusive.
6498
6499 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6500 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
6501 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006502 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
6503 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006504 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6505 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006506 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
6507 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
6508 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006509
6510 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6511 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006512 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
6513 supported :
6514 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6515 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006516 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
6517 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
6518 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
6519 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
6520 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006521
6522 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6523 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006524 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
6525 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
6526 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
6527 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006528 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
6529
6530 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6531 informational message reported in logs if the expect
6532 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
6533 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
6534
6535 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6536 informational message reported in logs if an error
6537 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
6538 log-format string.
6539
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006540 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006541 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
6542 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006543 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
6544 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
6545 details on the supported keywords.
6546
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006547 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
6548 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
6549 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
6550 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006551
6552 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
6553 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
6554 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
6555 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
6556 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
6557
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006558 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
6559 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
6560 codes. A health check response will be considered as
6561 valid if the response's status code matches any status
6562 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
6563 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6564 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006565
6566 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006567 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006568 response's status code matches the expression. If the
6569 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6570 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
6571 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
6572
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006573 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6574 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006575 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
6576 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
6577 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
6578 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
6579 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
6580 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
6581 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
6582 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006583 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
6584 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
6585 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
6586 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
6587 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
6588 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
6589 insensitive on the header names.
6590
6591 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6592 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
6593 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
6594 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
6595 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
6596 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006597
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006598 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006599 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006600 response's body contains this exact string. If the
6601 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6602 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
6603 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
6604 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006605 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006606 trace).
6607
6608 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006609 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006610 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
6611 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6612 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
6613 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
6614 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006615 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006616
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02006617 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
6618 A health check response will be considered valid if the
6619 response's body contains the string resulting of the
6620 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
6621 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6622 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
6623
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006624 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01006625 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006626 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
6627 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
6628 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
6629 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
6630 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
6631 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
6632
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006633 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
6634 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
6635 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
6636 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
6637 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01006638
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006639 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
6640 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
6641
6642 Examples :
6643 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006644 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006645
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006646 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
6647 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
6648
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006649 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006650 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006651
6652 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006653 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006654
6655 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006656 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006657
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006658 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006659 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006660
6661
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006662http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006663 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
6664 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006665 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
6666 health checks.
6667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6668 yes | no | yes | yes
6669 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006670 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6671
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006672 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
6673 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
6674 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
6675 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
6676 to invent non-standard ones.
6677
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006678 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6679 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
6680 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
6681 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6682
6683 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6684 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
6685 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6686 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006687
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02006688 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006689 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006690 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006691 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
6692 to add it.
6693
6694 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
6695 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
6696 to the log-format rules.
6697
6698 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
6699 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
6700 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006701
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006702 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
6703 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
6704 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
6705 request.
6706
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006707 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
6708 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
6709 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006710 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
6711 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
6712 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
6713 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006714 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006715
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006716 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006717 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
6718 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006719
6720 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
6721 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
6722 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
6723 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
6724 configured request authority.
6725
6726 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
6727 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006728
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006729 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006730
6731
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006732http-check send-state
6733 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
6734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6735 yes | no | yes | yes
6736 Arguments : none
6737
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006738 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006739 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006740 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
6741 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
6742 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006743
6744 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
6745 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
6746 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
6747 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
6748 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08006749 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
6750 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
6751 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6752
6753 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
6754 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
6755 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6756
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006757 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
6758 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
6759 checked in multiple backends.
6760
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006761 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006762 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
6763
6764 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
6765 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
6766 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
6767 one fails.
6768
6769 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
6770 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
6771 connections on all servers of the same backend.
6772
6773 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
6774 server's queue.
6775
6776 Example of a header received by the application server :
6777 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
6778 scur=13/22; qcur=0
6779
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006780 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
6781 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006782
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006783
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006784http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
6785http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006786 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006787 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6788 yes | no | yes | yes
6789
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006790 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006791 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6792 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6793 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6794 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6795 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6796 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6797 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6798 and '-'.
6799
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006800 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
6801 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05006802 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006803 conditions.
6804
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006805 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
6806
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006807 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6808 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6809
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006810 Examples :
6811 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006812 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006813
6814
6815http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006816 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006817 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6818 yes | no | yes | yes
6819
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006820 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006821 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6822 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6823 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6824 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6825 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6826 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6827 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6828 and '-'.
6829
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006830 Examples :
6831 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006832
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006833
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006834http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
6835 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6836 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6837 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6838 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
6839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6840 yes | yes | yes | yes
6841 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006842 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006843 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006844 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006845 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006846
6847 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
6848 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
6849 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
6850 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
6851
6852 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
6853 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
6854 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
6855 a frontend, the default error message is used.
6856
6857 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
6858 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
6859 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
6860 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
6861 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
6862 chroot is performed.
6863
6864 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
6865 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
6866 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
6867 considered.
6868
6869 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6870 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6871 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6872 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6873 considered as a raw string.
6874
6875 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
6876 The content-type must always be set as argument to
6877 "content-type".
6878
6879 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6880 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6881 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6882 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6883 evaluated as a log-format string.
6884
6885 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
6886 payload. The content-type must always be set as
6887 argument to "content-type".
6888
6889 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
6890 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
6891 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
6892 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
6893
6894 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
6895 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
6896 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
6897 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
6898 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
6899 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
6900 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
6901 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
6902
6903 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
6904 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
6905 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
6906
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006907 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
6908 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6909 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6910 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6911 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6912
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006913 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6914 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6915
6916
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006917http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006918 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6919
6920 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006921 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006922
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006923 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6924 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6925 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6926 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6927 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006928
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006929 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6930 supported:
6931 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6932 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6933 - allow
6934 - auth [realm <realm>]
6935 - cache-use <name>
6936 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6937 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6938 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
6939 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6940 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6941 - disable-l7-retry
6942 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6943 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
6944 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
6945 - redirect <rule>
6946 - reject
6947 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6948 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6949 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6950 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6951 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6952 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01006953 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006954 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6955 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6956 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6957 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6958 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01006959 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006960 - set-dst <expr>
6961 - set-dst-port <expr>
6962 - set-header <name> <fmt>
6963 - set-log-level <level>
6964 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6965 - set-mark <mark>
6966 - set-method <fmt>
6967 - set-nice <nice>
6968 - set-path <fmt>
6969 - set-pathq <fmt>
6970 - set-priority-class <expr>
6971 - set-priority-offset <expr>
6972 - set-query <fmt>
6973 - set-src <expr>
6974 - set-src-port <expr>
6975 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
6976 - set-tos <tos>
6977 - set-uri <fmt>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006978 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
6979 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006980 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01006981 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006982 - strict-mode { on | off }
6983 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6984 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
6985 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
6986 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
6987 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6988 - use-service <service-name>
6989 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6990 - wait-for-handshake
6991 - cache-use <name>
6992
6993 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006994
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006995 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006996
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006997 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6998 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6999 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7000 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7001 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7002 a defaults section defining such rules.
7003
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007004 Example:
7005 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
7006 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
7007 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007008
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007009 http-request allow if nagios
7010 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
7011 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
7012 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01007013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007014 Example:
7015 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
7016 acl add path /addacl
7017 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007018
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007019 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007020
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007021 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
7022 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007023
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007024 Example:
7025 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
7026 acl setmap path /setmap
7027 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007028
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007029 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007030
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007031 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
7032 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007034 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7035 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007036
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007037http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007038
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007039 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7040 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7041 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7042 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7043 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
7044 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7045 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7046 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007047
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007048http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007049
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007050 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
7051 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
7052 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
7053 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
7054 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
7055 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
7056 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
7057 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007058
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007059http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007060
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007061 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01007062 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007063
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007064http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007065
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007066 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
7067 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
7068 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
7069 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
7070 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007071
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02007072 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
7073 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
7074 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
7075 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
7076 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
7077 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
7078 instead.
7079
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007080 Example:
7081 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
7082 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007083
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007084http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007085
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007086 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007087
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007088http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
7089 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007090
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007091 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
7092 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
7093 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
7094 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
7095 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
7096 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
7097 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
7098 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
7099 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007100
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007101 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
7102 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
7103 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007104 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
7105
7106 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7107 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7108 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7109 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007110
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007111http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007112
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007113 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7114 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7115 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7116 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7117 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7118 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007119
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007120http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007121
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007122 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7123 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7124 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7125 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7126 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007127
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007128http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007129
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007130 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7131 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7132 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7133 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7134 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7135 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007136
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007137http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7138http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7139 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7140 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7141 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7142 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04007143
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007144 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
7145 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7146 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007147 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007148 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7149 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7150 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007151 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007152 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04007153
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02007154http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7155 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
7156 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
7157 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
7158
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007159http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
7160 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01007161
7162 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
7163 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
7164 pointed by <resolvers>.
7165 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
7166 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
7167 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
7168 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
7169 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
7170 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
7171 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
7172 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
7173 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
7174 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemand1ef24602022-08-26 16:38:43 +02007175 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
7176 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01007177
7178 Example:
7179 resolvers mydns
7180 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
7181 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
7182 timeout retry 1s
7183 hold valid 10s
7184 hold nx 3s
7185 hold other 3s
7186 hold obsolete 0s
7187 accepted_payload_size 8192
7188
7189 frontend fe
7190 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandb5c2cd42022-08-26 16:48:07 +02007191 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),host_only
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01007192 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
7193
7194 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
7195 # which mean DNS resolution error
7196 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
7197
7198 default_backend be
7199
7200 backend b_503
7201 # dummy backend used to return 503.
7202 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
7203 # 503 error page to end users
7204
7205 backend be
7206 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
7207 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
7208 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
7209 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
7210 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
7211
7212 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
7213 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
7214
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01007215http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7216
7217 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
7218 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
7219 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
7220 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01007221 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
7222 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01007223
7224 See RFC 8297 for more information.
7225
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007226http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02007227http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02007228http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007229http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007230http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007231http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007232http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007233http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7234http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007235
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02007236 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
7237
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02007238 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02007239 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
7240 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
7241 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
7242 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02007243
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02007244 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
7245 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
7246 the supported backend.
7247
7248 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
7249 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
7250 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
7251 number of segments in the path.
7252
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007253 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
7254 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
7255 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
7256 when improperly combined.
7257
7258 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
7259 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
7260 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
7261 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
7262 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
7263
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02007264 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007265
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02007266 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
7267
7268 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
7269 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
7270
7271 Example:
7272 - /#foo -> /%23foo
7273
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02007274 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
7275
7276 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
7277 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
7278
7279 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
7280 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
7281
7282 Example:
7283 - /#foo -> /
7284
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02007285 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
7286 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007287
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007288 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
7289 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
7290
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02007291 Example:
7292 - /. -> /
7293 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
7294 - /a/./a -> /a/a
7295 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007296
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02007297 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
7298 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
7299
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007300 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007301 their preceding segment.
7302
7303 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
7304 normalizer first if this is undesired.
7305
7306 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
7307 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007308
7309 Example:
7310 - /foo/../ -> /
7311 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
7312 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
7313 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02007314 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007315 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007316 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007317
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02007318 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
7319 removed as well:
7320
7321 Example:
7322 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
7323 - /bar/../../ -> /
7324
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007325 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
7326 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007327
7328 Example:
7329 - // -> /
7330 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
7331
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007332 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
7333 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
7334
7335 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
7336 ".", "_", and "~".
7337
7338 Example:
7339 - /%61dmin -> /admin
7340 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
7341 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
7342 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
7343
7344 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7345 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7346
7347 Example:
7348 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
7349 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
7350
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007351 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02007352 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02007353
7354 Example:
7355 - /%6f -> /%6F
7356 - /%zz -> /%zz
7357
7358 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7359 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7360
7361 Example:
7362 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
7363
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007364 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02007365 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
7366 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
7367
7368 Example:
7369 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
7370 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
7371 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
7372
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007373http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007374
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007375 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
7376 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
7377 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
7378 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
7379 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007380
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007381http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007382
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007383 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
7384 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
7385 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
7386 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007387
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007388http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7389 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02007390
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007391 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007392 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
7393 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
7394 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
7395 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
7396 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02007397
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007398 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
7399 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
7400 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
7401 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
7402 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007403
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007404 Example:
7405 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
7406
7407 # applied to:
7408 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7409
7410 # outputs:
7411 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7412
7413 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007414
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007415 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
7416
7417 # applied to:
7418 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007419
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007420 # outputs:
7421 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007422
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007423http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7424 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7425
7426 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
7427 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02007428 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
7429 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
7430 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007431
7432 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7433 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7434 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
7435
7436 Example:
7437 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7438 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
7439
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007440 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
7441 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
7442 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
7443 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
7444
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007445http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7446 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7447
7448 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
7449 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
7450 query-string are replaced.
7451
7452 Example:
7453 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
7454 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
7455
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007456http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7457 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7458
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007459 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
7460 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
7461 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
7462 against.
7463
7464 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7465 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7466 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007467
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007468 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
7469 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
7470 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
7471 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
7472 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
7473 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
7474 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
7475 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
7476 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007477 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
7478 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007479
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007480 Example:
7481 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
7482 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007483
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007484 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7485 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007486
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007487http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7488 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007489
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007490 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
7491 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
7492 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
7493 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007494
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007495 Example:
7496 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007497
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007498 # applied to:
7499 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007500
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007501 # outputs:
7502 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007503
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007504http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7505 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7506 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01007507 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007508 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7509
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007510 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007511 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7512 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007513 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007514 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007515 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007516 are followed to create the response :
7517
7518 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7519 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7520 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7521 ignored.
7522
7523 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7524 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007525 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007526 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7527 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007528
7529 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7530 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7531 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007532 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007533 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007534
7535 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7536 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7537 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007538 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007539 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007540 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007541
7542 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7543 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7544 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7545 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7546 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7547 as a raw content.
7548
7549 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7550 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7551 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7552 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7553 considered as a raw string.
7554
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007555 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007556 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7557 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7558 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7559
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007560 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7561 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007562 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007563
7564 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7565
7566 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007567 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007568 if { path /ping }
7569
7570 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
7571 if { path /favicon.ico }
7572
7573 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
7574 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
7575 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
7576
Willy Tarreau5a72d032023-01-02 18:15:20 +01007577http-request sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7578 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7579
7580 This action increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
7581 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> by the value of
7582 either integer <int> or the integer evaluation of expression <expr>. Integers
7583 and expressions are limited to unsigned 32-bit values. If an error occurs,
7584 this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues. <idx> is an
7585 integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer between 0 and 2. It also
7586 silently fails if the there is no GPC stored at this index. The entry in the
7587 table is refreshed even if the value is zero. The 'gpc_rate' is automatically
7588 adjusted to reflect the average growth rate of the gpc value.
7589
7590 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7591 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7592 There is no equivalent function for legacy data types, but if the value is
7593 always 1, please see 'sc-inc-gpc()', 'sc-inc-gpc0()' and 'sc-inc-gpc1()'.
7594 There is no way to decrement the value either, but it is possible to store
7595 exact values in a General Purpose Tag using 'sc-set-gpt()' instead.
7596
7597 The main use of this action is to count scores or total volumes (e.g.
7598 estimated danger per source IP reported by the server or a WAF, total
7599 uploaded bytes, etc).
7600
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007601http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7602
7603 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7604 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7605 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7606 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7607 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7608 at this index.
7609 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7610 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007612http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7613http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007614
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007615 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7616 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7617 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007618
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007619http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7620 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7621 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7622 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7623 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7624 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7625 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7626 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7627 at this index.
7628 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7629 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7630
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007631http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7632 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007633
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007634 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7635 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7636 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7637 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007638
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007639http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7640 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7641
7642 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7643 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7644 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7645 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7646 agent name must be used.
7647
7648 Arguments:
7649 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
7650
7651 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7652 configuration.
7653
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007654http-request set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
7655 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007656
7657 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
7658 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Custom
7659 limit and period may be defined, if and only if <name> references a
7660 per-stream bandwidth limitation filter. When a set-bandwidth-limit rule is
7661 executed, it first resets all settings of the filter to their defaults prior
7662 to enabling it. As a consequence, if several "set-bandwidth-limit" actions
7663 are executed for the same filter, only the last one is considered. Several
7664 bandwidth limitation filters can be enabled on the same stream.
7665
7666 Note that this action cannot be used in a defaults section because bandwidth
7667 limitation filters cannot be defined in defaults sections. In addition, only
7668 the HTTP payload transfer is limited. The HTTP headers are not considered.
7669
7670 Arguments:
7671 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7672 by some converters. The result is converted to an integer. It is
7673 interpreted as a size in bytes for the "limit" parameter and as a
7674 duration in milliseconds for the "period" parameter.
7675
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007676 <size> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
7677 bytes.
7678
7679 <time> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in
7680 milliseconds.
7681
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007682 Example:
7683 http-request set-bandwidth-limit global-limit
7684 http-request set-bandwidth-limit my-limit limit 1m period 10s
7685
7686 See section 9.7 about bandwidth limitation filter setup.
7687
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007688http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007689
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007690 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
7691 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
7692 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
7693 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
7694 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007695
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007696 Arguments:
7697 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7698 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007699
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007700 Example:
7701 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
7702 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007703
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007704 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
7705 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007706
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007707http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007708
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007709 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
7710 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
7711 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007712
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007713 Arguments:
7714 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7715 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007716
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007717 Example:
7718 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
7719 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007720
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007721 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
7722 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
7723 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007724
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007725http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007726
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007727 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
7728 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7729 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7730 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
7731 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007732
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007733 Example:
7734 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
7735 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
7736 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
7737 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
7738 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
7739 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
7740 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
7741 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
7742 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007743
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007744http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007745
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007746 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7747 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7748 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7749 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
7750 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007751
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007752http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7753 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007754
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007755 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7756 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7757 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7758 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7759 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
7760 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
7761 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
7762 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
7763 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007764
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007765http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007766
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007767 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7768 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7769 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7770 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
7771 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7772 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7773 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007774 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7775 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007776
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007777http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007778
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007779 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
7780 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
7781 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007782
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007783http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007784
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007785 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
7786 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
7787 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
7788 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
7789 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
7790 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7791 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7792 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007793
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007794http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007795
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007796 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
7797 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
7798 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
7799 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
7800 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
7801 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007802
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007803 Example :
7804 # prepend the host name before the path
7805 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007806
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007807http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7808
7809 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
7810 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
7811 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
7812
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007813http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02007814
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007815 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
7816 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
7817 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7818 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
7819 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007820
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007821http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007822
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007823 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
7824 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
7825 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7826 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
7827 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
7828 values have higher priority.
7829 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
7830 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
7831 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
7832 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
7833 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007834
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007835http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007836
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007837 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
7838 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
7839 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
7840 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
7841 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
7842 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
7843 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007844
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007845 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007846
7847 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007848 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
7849 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007850
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007851http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7852 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
7853 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
7854 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007855 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
7856 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007857
7858 Arguments :
7859 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7860 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007861
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007862 See also "option forwardfor".
7863
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007864 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007865 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
7866 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
7867
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007868 # After the masking this will track connections
7869 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
7870 http-request track-sc0 src
7871
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007872 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
7873 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
7874
7875http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7876
7877 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
7878 expression.
7879
7880 Arguments:
7881 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7882 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007883
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007884 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007885 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
7886 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
7887
7888 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
7889 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
7890 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
7891
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007892http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007893 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7894
7895 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
7896 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
7897 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
7898 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
7899 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
7900
7901 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
7902 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
7903 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
7904 results.
7905
7906 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007907 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
7908 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007909
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007910http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7911
7912 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7913 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
7914 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
7915 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
7916 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
7917 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
7918 information from the request.
7919
7920 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7921
7922http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7923
7924 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
7925 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulet84cdbe42022-11-22 15:41:48 +01007926 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
7927 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
7928 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
7929 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
7930 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007931 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
7932
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01007933http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7934http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007935
7936 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7937 inline.
7938
7939 Arguments:
7940 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7941 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7942 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7943 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7944 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7945 (request and response)
7946 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7947 processing
7948 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7949 processing
7950 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7951 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
7952 and '_'.
7953
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007954 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
7955 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05007956 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007957 conditions.
7958
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007959 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7960 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007961
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007962 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
7963 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
7964
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007965 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007966 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007967 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
7968
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007969http-request silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007970
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007971 This stops the evaluation of the rules and removes the client-facing
7972 connection in a configurable way: When called without the rst-ttl argument,
7973 we try to prevent sending any FIN or RST packet back to the client by
7974 using TCP_REPAIR. If this fails (mainly because of missing privileges),
7975 we fall back to sending a RST packet with a TTL of 1.
7976
7977 The effect is that the client still sees an established connection while
7978 there is none on HAProxy, saving resources. However, stateful equipment
7979 placed between the HAProxy and the client (firewalls, proxies,
7980 load balancers) will also keep the established connection in their
7981 session tables.
7982
7983 The optional rst-ttl changes this behaviour: TCP_REPAIR is not used,
7984 and a RST packet with a configurable TTL is sent. When set to a
7985 reasonable value, the RST packet travels through your own equipment,
7986 deleting the connection in your middle-boxes, but does not arrive at
7987 the client. Future packets from the client will then be dropped
7988 already by your middle-boxes. These "local RST"s protect your resources,
7989 but not the client's. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007990
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007991http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007992
7993 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7994 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7995 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7996 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7997 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007998 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007999 processing.
8000
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01008001 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008002 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
8003 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
8004 rules evaluation.
8005
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008006http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8007http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
8008 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8009 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
8010 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
8011 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008012
8013 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
8014 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
8015 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008016 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
8017 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
8018 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
8019 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
8020 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
8021 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008022 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008023 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
8024 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
8025 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05008026 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008027 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
8028 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
8029 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
8030 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
8031 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008032
8033http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8034http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8035http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8036
8037 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
8038 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01008039 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set by the
8040 global "tune.stick-counters" setting, which defaults to MAX_SESS_STKCTR if
8041 set at build time (it is reported in haproxy -vv) and which defaults to 3,
8042 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (tune.stick-counters-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008043 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
8044 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
8045 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
8046 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
8047 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
8048 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
8049 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
8050
8051 Arguments :
8052 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
8053 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
8054 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
8055 select which table entry to update the counters.
8056
8057 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
8058 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
8059 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
8060 that table until the session ends.
8061
8062 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
8063 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
8064 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
8065 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
8066 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
8067 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
8068 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
8069 useful information.
8070
8071 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
8072 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
8073 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
8074 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
8075 checks that make use of it.
8076
8077http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8078
8079 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008080
8081 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008082 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008083
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01008084http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8085
8086 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
8087 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
8088 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
8089 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
8090 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
8091 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
8092
8093 Arguments :
8094 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
8095
8096 Example:
8097 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
8098
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008099http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8100 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8101
8102 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
8103 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
8104 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
8105 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
8106 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
8107 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
8108 http-buffer-request".
8109
8110 Arguments :
8111
8112 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
8113 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
8114
8115 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05008116 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008117 bytes.
8118
8119 Example:
8120 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
8121
8122 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008124http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008125
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008126 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
8127 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
8128 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008129
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01008130
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008131http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008132 Access control for Layer 7 responses
8133
8134 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02008135 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008136
8137 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
8138 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
8139 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
8140 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
8141 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
8142 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
8143
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008144 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
8145 supported:
8146 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
8147 - add-header <name> <fmt>
8148 - allow
8149 - cache-store <name>
8150 - capture <sample> id <id>
8151 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
8152 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
8153 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
8154 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
8155 - redirect <rule>
8156 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8157 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8158 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01008159 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008160 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
8161 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
8162 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
8163 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8164 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8165 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01008166 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008167 - set-header <name> <fmt>
8168 - set-log-level <level>
8169 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
8170 - set-mark <mark>
8171 - set-nice <nice>
8172 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
8173 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01008174 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
8175 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +01008176 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008177 - strict-mode { on | off }
8178 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
8179 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
8180 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
8181 - unset-var(<var-name>)
8182 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8183
8184 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008185
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008186 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008187
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02008188 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
8189 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
8190 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
8191 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
8192 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
8193 a defaults section defining such rules.
8194
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008195 Example:
8196 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02008197
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008198 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008199
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008200 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
8201 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008202
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008203 Example:
8204 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008205
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008206 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008207
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008208 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
8209 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008210
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008211 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8212 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008213
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008214http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008215
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008216 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
8217 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008218
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008219http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008220
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008221 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008222 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
8223 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008224
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008225http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008226
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008227 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
8228 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008229
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02008230http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008231
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008232 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008233
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008234http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008235
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008236 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
8237 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
8238 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
8239 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
8240 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
8241 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
8242 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02008243
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008244 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
8245 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
8246 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
8247 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
8248 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01008249
8250 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
8251 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
8252 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
8253 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02008254
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008255http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02008256
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008257 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
8258 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02008259
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00008260http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02008261
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008262 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
8263 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02008264
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008265http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02008266
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008267 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
8268 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008269
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008270http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8271http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
8272 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8273 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
8274 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
8275 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008276
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008277 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
8278 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
8279 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05008280 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008281 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
8282 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
8283 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01008284 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008285 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008286
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008287http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008288
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008289 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
8290 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
8291 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
8292 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
8293 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
8294 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02008295
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008296http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8297 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02008298
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01008299 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
8300 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01008301
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008302 Example:
8303 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02008304
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008305 # applied to:
8306 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008307
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008308 # outputs:
8309 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008310
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008311 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008312
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008313http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8314 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008315
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01008316 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01008317 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008318
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008319 Example:
8320 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008321
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008322 # applied to:
8323 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008324
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008325 # outputs:
8326 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008327
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008328http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
8329 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8330 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01008331 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008332 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8333
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008334 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
8335 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
8336 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008337
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01008338http-response sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8339 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8340
8341 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
8342 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
8343 a complete description.
8344
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02008345http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008346http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8347http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08008348
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008349 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
8350 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
8351 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
8352 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008353
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02008354http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008355 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01008356http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8357 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008358
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008359 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
8360 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +02008361 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008362
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02008363http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
8364 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008365
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008366 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
8367 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02008368
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01008369http-response set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
8370 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02008371
8372 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
8373 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
8374 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
8375
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008376http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008377
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008378 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
8379 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
8380 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
8381 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008382
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008383http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8384
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008385 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
8386 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008387
8388http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
8389
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008390 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
8391 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008392
8393http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8394
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008395 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
8396 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
8397 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008398
8399http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8400
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008401 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
8402 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008403
8404http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
8405 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8406
8407 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
8408 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
8409 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
8410 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008411
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008412 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008413 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
8414 http-response set-status 431
8415 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
8416 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008417
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008418http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008419
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008420 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008421 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
8422 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008423
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01008424http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8425http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008426
8427 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008428 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
8429 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008430
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008431http-response silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008432
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008433 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
8434 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008435 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
8436 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008437
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008438http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008439
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008440 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
8441 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008442
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008443http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8444http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8445http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008446
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008447 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
8448 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
8449 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008450
8451http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8452
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008453 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008454 about <var-name>.
8455
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008456http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8457 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8458
8459 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008460 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
8461 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008462
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02008463
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008464http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
8465 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
8466
8467 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8468 yes | no | yes | yes
8469
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008470 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008471 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
8472 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
8473 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008474
8475 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
8476
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008477 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
8478 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
8479 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
8480 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
8481 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
8482 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
8483 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008484 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008485 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
8486 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008487
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008488 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
8489 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
8490 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
8491 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
8492 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
8493 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
8494 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02008495 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
8496 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
8497 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
8498 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
8499 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
8500 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008501
8502 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
8503 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
8504 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
8505 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
8506 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
8507 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
8508 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
8509 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02008510 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008511 downsides of rare connection failures.
8512
8513 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
8514 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
8515 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
8516 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
8517 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
8518 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008519 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008520 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
8521 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
8522 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
8523 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
8524 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
8525
8526 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008527 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
8528 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
8529 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
8530 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008531
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008532 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
8533 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008534
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01008535 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008536
8537 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
8538 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
8539 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
8540
Willy Tarreau44fce8b2022-11-25 09:17:18 +01008541 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
8542 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
8543 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
8544 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
8545 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
8546 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
8547 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
8548 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
8549 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
8550 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
8551 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
8552
8553 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
8554 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
8555 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
8556 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
8557 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
8558
8559 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
8560 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008561
8562
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008563http-send-name-header [<header>]
8564 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008565 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8566 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008567 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008568 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
8569
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02008570 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
8571 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
8572 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
8573 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
8574 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
8575 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
8576 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
8577 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
8578 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
8579 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
8580 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
8581 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
8582 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
8583 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
8584 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
8585 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008586
8587 See also : "server"
8588
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008589id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008590 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
8591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8592 no | yes | yes | yes
8593 Arguments : none
8594
8595 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
8596 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
8597 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008598
8599
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008600ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
8601 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
8602 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01008603 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008604
8605 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
8606 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
8607 and running).
8608
8609 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
8610 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
8611 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008612 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008613 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
8614
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008615 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
8616 "unless" condition is met.
8617
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008618 Example:
8619 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8620 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8621 ignore-persist if url_static
8622
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008623 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
8624
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008625load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
8626 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
8627 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8628 yes | no | yes | yes
8629
8630 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
8631 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
8632 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008633 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008634 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008635 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
8636 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
8637 over the stats socket and redirect output.
8638
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008639 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008640 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02008641 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008642
8643 Arguments:
8644 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
8645 named "server-state-file".
8646
8647 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
8648 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
8649 name is used as a file name.
8650
8651 none don't load any stat for this backend
8652
8653 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008654 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
8655 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
8656 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008657 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008658 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008659
8660 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
8661 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
8662
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008663 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008664
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008665 global
8666 stats socket /tmp/socket
8667 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008668
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008669 defaults
8670 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008671
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008672 backend bk
8673 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8674 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008675
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008676
8677 Then one can run :
8678
8679 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
8680
8681 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
8682
8683 1
8684 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8685 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8686 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8687
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008688 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008689
8690 global
8691 stats socket /tmp/socket
8692 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
8693
8694 defaults
8695 load-server-state-from-file local
8696
8697 backend bk
8698 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8699 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
8700
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008701
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008702 Then one can run :
8703
8704 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
8705
8706 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
8707
8708 1
8709 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8710 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8711 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8712
8713 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
8714 "show servers state"
8715
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008716
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008717log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01008718log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008719 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008720no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008721 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
8722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8723 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008724
8725 Prefix :
8726 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
8727 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
8728 prefix does not allow arguments.
8729
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008730 Arguments :
8731 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
8732 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
8733 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
8734 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
8735 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
8736 parameter.
8737
8738 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
8739 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
8740
8741 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
8742 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8743 standard syslog port).
8744
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01008745 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
8746 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8747 standard syslog port).
8748
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008749 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
8750 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
8751 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008752 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008753
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008754 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
8755 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
8756 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
8757 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
8758 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
8759 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
8760 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
8761 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
8762 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
8763 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
8764 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
8765 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008766 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008767 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
8768 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
8769 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008770 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
8771 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008772
8773 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
8774 and "fd@2", see above.
8775
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02008776 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
8777 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
8778 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
8779 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
8780 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
8781 having the logs instantly available.
8782
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008783 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
8784 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
8785 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
8786
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008787 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8788 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008789
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008790 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
8791 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
8792 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
8793 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
8794 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
8795 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
8796 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
8797 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
8798 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
8799 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008800 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008801
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008802 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
8803 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
8804 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
8805 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
8806 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
8807
8808 <sample_size>
8809 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
8810 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
8811 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
8812 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
8813 (see also <ranges> parameter).
8814
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008815 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
8816 one of the following :
8817
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01008818 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
8819 field is stripped. This is the default.
8820 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
8821 rfc3164.
8822
8823 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008824 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
8825
8826 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
8827 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
8828
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008829 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
8830 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
8831 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8832 designed to be used with a local log server.
8833
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008834 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8835 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
8836 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
8837 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
8838 systemd logger consumes.
8839
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008840 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8841 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
8842 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
8843 used with a local log server.
8844
8845 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
8846 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8847 designed to be used with a local log server.
8848
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008849 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
8850 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
8851 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
8852 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
8853
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008854 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
8855
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008856 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
8857 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
8858 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
8859
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008860 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
8861 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
8862 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
8863 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008864
8865 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
8866 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
8867 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008868 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
8869 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
8870 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
8871 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
8872 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008873
8874 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
8875
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008876 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
8877 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
8878 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008879
8880 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
8881 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
8882 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
8883 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
8884
8885 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
8886 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008887
8888 Example :
8889 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008890 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
8891 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
8892 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008893 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008894 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
8895 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008896 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008897
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008898
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008899log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008900 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
8901 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8902 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008903
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008904 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
8905 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
8906 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
8907 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
8908 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02008909 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
8910 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008911
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008912 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
8913 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008914
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02008915log-format-sd <string>
8916 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
8917 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8918 yes | yes | yes | no
8919
8920 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
8921 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
8922 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
8923 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
8924 which covers the log format string in depth.
8925
8926 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
8927 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
8928
8929 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
8930 log format to "rfc5424".
8931
8932 Example :
8933 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
8934
8935
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008936log-tag <string>
8937 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
8938 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8939 yes | yes | yes | yes
8940
8941 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
8942 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008943 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008944 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
8945 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
8946 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
8947 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
8948 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
8949 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008950
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008951max-keep-alive-queue <value>
8952 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
8953 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8954 yes | no | yes | yes
8955
8956 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
8957 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
8958 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
8959 servers.
8960
8961 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008962 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008963 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
8964 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
8965 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008966 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008967 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
8968 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
8969 picking a different server.
8970
8971 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
8972 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
8973 even if they have to be queued.
8974
8975 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
8976 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
8977
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01008978max-session-srv-conns <nb>
8979 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
8980 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
8981 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008982
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008983maxconn <conns>
8984 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8986 yes | yes | yes | no
8987 Arguments :
8988 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8989 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8990 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8991 closes.
8992
8993 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008994 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008995 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8996 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008997 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8998 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8999 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
9000 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009001
9002 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
9003 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
9004 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
9005
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01009006 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
9007 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02009008
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009009 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
9010
9011
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02009012mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009013 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
9014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9015 yes | yes | yes | yes
9016 Arguments :
9017 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
9018 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
9019 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
9020 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
9021
9022 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
9023 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
9024 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
9025 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
9026 brings HAProxy most of its value.
9027
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009028 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
9029 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
9030 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009031
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009032 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009033 defaults http_instances
9034 mode http
9035
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009036
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009037monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009038 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9040 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009041 Arguments :
9042 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
9043 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009044 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009045 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
9046 backend and its backup.
9047
9048 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
9049 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
9050 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
9051 servers in a list of backends.
9052
9053 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
9054 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
9055 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009056 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009057 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
9058 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009059 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02009060 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
9061 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009062
9063 Example:
9064 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009065 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009066 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9067 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9068 monitor-uri /site_alive
9069 monitor fail if site_dead
9070
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009071 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009072
9073
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009074monitor-uri <uri>
9075 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
9076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9077 yes | yes | yes | no
9078 Arguments :
9079 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
9080 health status instead of forwarding the request.
9081
9082 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
9083 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
9084 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
9085 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
9086 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
9087 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
9088 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
9089 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
9090
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01009091 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009092 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
9093 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau7fe0c622022-11-25 10:24:44 +01009094 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
9095 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
9096 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009097 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
9098 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
9099 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009100
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01009101 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
9102 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
9103 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
9104 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
9105
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009106 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009107 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009108 frontend www
9109 mode http
9110 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
9111
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009112 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009113
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009114
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009115option abortonclose
9116no option abortonclose
9117 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
9118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9119 yes | no | yes | yes
9120 Arguments : none
9121
9122 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
9123 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
9124 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
9125 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009126 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009127 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
9128 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
9129 encountered while delivering the response.
9130
9131 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
9132 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
9133 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
9134 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
9135 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
9136 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009137 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009138 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009139 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009140 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
9141 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
9142 still not served and not pollute the servers.
9143
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009144 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
9145 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009146 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
9147 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
9148 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
9149 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
9150 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
9151 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009152 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009153
9154 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9155 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9156
9157 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
9158
9159
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009160option accept-invalid-http-request
9161no option accept-invalid-http-request
9162 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
9163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9164 yes | yes | yes | no
9165 Arguments : none
9166
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009167 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009168 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009169 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009170 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
9171 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
9172 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
9173 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
9174 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01009175 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
9176 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
9177 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
9178 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009179 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009180 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02009181 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
Willy Tarreau1ba30162022-05-24 15:34:26 +02009182 to pass through (no version specified), as well as different protocol names
9183 (e.g. RTSP), and multiple digits for both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +02009184 Finally, this option also allows incoming URLs to contain fragment references
9185 ('#' after the path).
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009186
9187 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
9188 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
9189 been confirmed.
9190
9191 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
9192 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01009193 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
9194 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009195 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
9196
9197 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9198 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9199
9200 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
9201 stats socket.
9202
9203
9204option accept-invalid-http-response
9205no option accept-invalid-http-response
9206 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
9207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9208 yes | no | yes | yes
9209 Arguments : none
9210
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009211 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009212 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009213 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009214 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
9215 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
9216 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
9217 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
9218 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009219 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
9220 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
9221 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009222
9223 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
9224 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
9225 been confirmed.
9226
9227 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
9228 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
9229 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
9230 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
9231
9232 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9233 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9234
9235 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
9236 stats socket.
9237
9238
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009239option allbackups
9240no option allbackups
9241 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
9242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9243 yes | no | yes | yes
9244 Arguments : none
9245
9246 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
9247 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
9248 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
9249 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
9250 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
9251 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
9252 order between the backup servers anymore.
9253
9254 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
9255 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
9256
9257 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9258 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9259
9260
9261option checkcache
9262no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08009263 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9265 yes | no | yes | yes
9266 Arguments : none
9267
9268 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
9269 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009270 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009271 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
9272 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009273 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009274
9275 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009276 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009277 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009278 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
9279 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009280 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009281 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01009282 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
9283 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009284 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01009285 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
9286 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009287 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009288 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
9289 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
9290 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
9291 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
9292 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
9293 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
9294 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
9295 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
9296 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
9297
9298 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009299 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
9300 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
9301 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
9302 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009303
9304 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
9305 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009306 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009307 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009308
9309 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9310 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9311
9312
9313option clitcpka
9314no option clitcpka
9315 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
9316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9317 yes | yes | yes | no
9318 Arguments : none
9319
9320 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9321 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009322 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009323 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9324
9325 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9326 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9327 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9328 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9329
9330 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9331 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9332 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9333 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9334 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9335
9336 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9337
9338 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9339 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9340 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
9341
9342 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9343 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9344
9345 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
9346
9347
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009348option contstats
9349 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
9350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9351 yes | yes | yes | no
9352 Arguments : none
9353
9354 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
9355 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
9356 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009357 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01009358 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
9359 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
9360 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
9361 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
9362 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009363
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009364option disable-h2-upgrade
9365no option disable-h2-upgrade
9366 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
9367 connection.
9368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9369 yes | yes | yes | no
9370 Arguments : none
9371
9372 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
9373 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
9374 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
9375 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01009376 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
9377 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
9378 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
9379 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
9380 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
9381 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009382
9383 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9384 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009385
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009386option dontlog-normal
9387no option dontlog-normal
9388 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
9389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9390 yes | yes | yes | no
9391 Arguments : none
9392
9393 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
9394 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
9395 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
9396 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
9397 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
9398 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
9399 logged.
9400
9401 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
9402 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
9403 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
9404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009405 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009406 logging.
9407
9408
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009409option dontlognull
9410no option dontlognull
9411 Enable or disable logging of null connections
9412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9413 yes | yes | yes | no
9414 Arguments : none
9415
9416 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
9417 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
9418 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
9419 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
9420 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
9421 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009422 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
9423 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
9424 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009425
9426 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009427 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009428 would not be logged.
9429
9430 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9431 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9432
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009433 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009434 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009435
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009436option forwarded [ proto ]
9437 [ host | host-expr <host_expr> ]
9438 [ by | by-expr <by_expr> ] [ by_port | by_port-expr <by_port_expr>]
9439 [ for | for-expr <for_expr> ] [ for_port | for_port-expr <for_port_expr>]
9440no option forwarded
9441 Enable insertion of the rfc 7239 forwarded header in requests sent to servers
9442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9443 yes | no | yes | yes
9444 Arguments :
9445 <host_expr> optional argument to specify a custom sample expression
9446 those result will be used as 'host' parameter value
9447
9448 <by_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9449 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodename value
9450
9451 <for_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9452 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodename value
9453
9454 <by_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9455 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodeport value
9456
9457 <for_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9458 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodeport value
9459
9460
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02009461 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, servers are losing some request
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009462 context (request origin: client ip address, protocol used...)
9463
9464 A common way to address this limitation is to use the well known
9465 x-forward-for and x-forward-* friends to expose some of this context to the
9466 underlying servers/applications.
9467 While this use to work and is widely deployed, it is not officially supported
9468 by the IETF and can be the root of some interoperability as well as security
9469 issues.
9470
9471 To solve this, a new HTTP extension has been described by the IETF:
9472 forwarded header (RFC7239).
9473 More information here: https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html
9474
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02009475 The use of this single header allow to convey numerous details
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009476 within the same header, and most importantly, fixes the proxy chaining
9477 issue. (the rfc allows for multiple chained proxies to append their own
9478 values to an already existing header).
9479
9480 This option may be specified in defaults, listen or backend section, but it
9481 will be ignored for frontend sections.
9482
9483 Setting option forwarded without arguments results in using default implicit
9484 behavior.
9485 Default behavior enables proto parameter and injects original client ip.
9486
9487 The equivalent explicit/manual configuration would be:
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01009488 option forwarded proto for
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009489
9490 The keyword 'by' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9491 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9492 'by' value will be set to proxy ip (destination address)
9493 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'by' will be set to
9494 "unknown".
9495
9496 The keyword 'by-expr' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9497 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9498 'by' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9499 <by_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9500
9501 The keyword 'for' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9502 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9503 'for' value will be set to client ip (source address)
9504 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'for' will be set to
9505 "unknown".
9506
9507 The keyword 'for-expr' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9508 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9509 'for' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9510 <for_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9511
9512 The keyword 'by_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9513 'by' parameter. 'by_port' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9514 it will be ignored.
9515 "nodeport" will be set to proxy (destination) port if available,
9516 otherwise it will be ignored.
9517
9518 The keyword 'by_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9519 'by' parameter. 'by_port-expr' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9520 it will be ignored.
9521 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9522 <by_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9523
9524 The keyword 'for_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9525 'for' parameter. 'for_port' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9526 it will be ignored.
9527 "nodeport" will be set to client (source) port if available,
9528 otherwise it will be ignored.
9529
9530 The keyword 'for_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9531 'for' parameter. 'for_port-expr' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9532 it will be ignored.
9533 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9534 <for_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9535
9536 Examples :
9537 # Those servers want the ip address and protocol of the client request
9538 # Resulting header would look like this:
9539 # forwarded: proto=http;for=127.0.0.1
9540 backend www_default
9541 mode http
9542 option forwarded
9543 #equivalent to: option forwarded proto for
9544
9545 # Those servers want the requested host and hashed client ip address
9546 # as well as client source port (you should use seed for xxh32 if ensuring
9547 # ip privacy is a concern)
9548 # Resulting header would look like this:
9549 # forwarded: host="haproxy.org";for="_000000007F2F367E:60138"
9550 backend www_host
9551 mode http
9552 option forwarded host for-expr src,xxh32,hex for_port
9553
9554 # Those servers want custom data in host, for and by parameters
9555 # Resulting header would look like this:
9556 # forwarded: host="host.com";by=_haproxy;for="[::1]:10"
9557 backend www_custom
9558 mode http
9559 option forwarded host-expr str(host.com) by-expr str(_haproxy) for for_port-expr int(10)
9560
9561 # Those servers want random 'for' obfuscated identifiers for request
9562 # tracing purposes while protecting sensitive IP information
9563 # Resulting header would look like this:
9564 # forwarded: for=_000000002B1F4D63
9565 backend www_for_hide
9566 mode http
9567 option forwarded for-expr rand,hex
9568
9569 See also : "option forwardfor", "option originalto"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009570
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009571option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009572 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
9573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9574 yes | yes | yes | yes
9575 Arguments :
9576 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9577 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009578 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009579 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009580
9581 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
9582 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
9583 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
9584 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
9585 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
9586 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
9587 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009588 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
9589 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9590 possible that the client has already brought one.
9591
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009592 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009593 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009594 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009595 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009596 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009597 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009598
9599 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9600 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9601 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
9602 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
9603 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
9604 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01009605 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009606
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009607 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
9608 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009609 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009610 are under the control of the end-user.
9611
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009612 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009613 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9614 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009615 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
9616 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
9617 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009618
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02009619 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009620 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
9621 frontend www
9622 mode http
9623 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
9624
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009625 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
9626 backend www
9627 mode http
9628 option forwardfor header X-Client
9629
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009630 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009631 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009632
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009633
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02009634option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9635no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9636 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
9637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9638 yes | yes | yes | no
9639 Arguments : none
9640
9641 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9642 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9643 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9644 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9645 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9646 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9647 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9648
9649 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
9650 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
9651 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
9652 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9653 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
9654 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9655 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9656 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
9657 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9658 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9659
9660 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
9661
9662 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9663 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9664
9665 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
9666 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9667
9668
9669option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9670no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9671 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
9672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9673 yes | no | yes | yes
9674 Arguments : none
9675
9676 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9677 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9678 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9679 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9680 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9681 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9682 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9683
9684 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
9685 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
9686 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
9687 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9688 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
9689 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9690 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9691 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
9692 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9693 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9694
9695 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
9696
9697 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9698 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9699
9700 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
9701 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9702
9703
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009704option http-buffer-request
9705no option http-buffer-request
9706 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
9707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9708 yes | yes | yes | yes
9709 Arguments : none
9710
9711 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
9712 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
9713 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
9714 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
9715 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
9716 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01009717 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
9718 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
9719 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
9720 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009721
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02009722 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
9723 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009724
9725
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009726option http-ignore-probes
9727no option http-ignore-probes
9728 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
9729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9730 yes | yes | yes | no
9731 Arguments : none
9732
9733 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
9734 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
9735 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
9736 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
9737 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
9738 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
9739 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
9740 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
9741 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009742 was received over a connection before it was closed;
9743 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009744 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
9745
9746 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
9747 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
9748 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
9749 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
9750 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
9751 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
9752 are often the only way to detect them.
9753
9754 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9755 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9756
9757 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
9758
9759
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009760option http-keep-alive
9761no option http-keep-alive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009762 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server for HTTP/1.x
9763 connections
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9765 yes | yes | yes | yes
9766 Arguments : none
9767
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009768 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009769 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9770 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9771 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9772 httpclose". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be
9773 useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009774
9775 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
9776 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009777 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
9778 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
9779 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
9780 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
9781 situations where this option may be useful :
9782
9783 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009784 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009785
9786 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
9787 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
9788
9789 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009790
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009791 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9792 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9793 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9794 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
9795 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9796 not set.
9797
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009798 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009799 http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009800
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009801 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009802 "option prefer-last-server" and "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009803
9804
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009805option http-no-delay
9806no option http-no-delay
9807 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
9808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9809 yes | yes | yes | yes
9810 Arguments : none
9811
9812 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
9813 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
9814 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
9815 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
9816 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
9817 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
9818 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009819 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009820 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
9821 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
9822 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
9823 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
9824 affected.
9825
9826 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
9827 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
9828 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
9829 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
9830 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
9831 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
9832 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
9833 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
9834 latency environments.
9835
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009836 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
9837
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009838
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009839option http-pretend-keepalive
9840no option http-pretend-keepalive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009841 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive for HTTP/1.x connection to the
9842 server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009844 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009845 Arguments : none
9846
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009847 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009848 adds a "Connection: close" header to the HTTP/1.x request forwarded to the
9849 server. Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically
9850 refrain from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length,
9851 while this is totally unrelated. The effect is that a client or a cache could
9852 receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and consider the
9853 response complete.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009854
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009855 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009856 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009857 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009858 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009859 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009860 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
9861
9862 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
9863 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
9864 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
9865 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009866 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
9867 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009868 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
9869
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009870 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
9871 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
9872 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009873 frontend.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009874
9875 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9876 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9877
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009878 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009879 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009880
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02009881option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
9882 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
9883 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
9884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9885 yes | yes | yes | yes
9886 Arguments :
9887 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
9888 with no FastCGI application configured.
9889
9890 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
9891 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
9892 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
9893
9894 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
9895 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
9896
9897 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
9898 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
9899 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
9900 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
9901 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
9902 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
9903 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
9904 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
9905
9906 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
9907 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009908
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009909option http-server-close
9910no option http-server-close
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009911 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing on the server side
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9913 yes | yes | yes | yes
9914 Arguments : none
9915
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009916 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009917 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9918 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9919 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9920 httpclose". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close
9921 mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive
9922 and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the
9923 client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side
9924 to save server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
9925 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
9926 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
9927 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
9928 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
9929 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009930
9931 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9932 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9933 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9934 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009935 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9936 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009937
9938 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
9939 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009940 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
9941 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
9942 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009943
9944 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9945 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9946
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009947 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive" and
9948 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009949
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009950option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009951no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009952 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
9953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9954 yes | yes | yes | no
9955 Arguments : none
9956
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00009957 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009958 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
9959 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
9960 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
9961 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
9962 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009963 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009964
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009965 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009966 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01009967 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
9968 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
9969 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009970
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01009971 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
9972 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
9973 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
9974 front of an existing proxy.
9975
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009976 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
9977
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009978 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009979
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009980option httpchk
9981option httpchk <uri>
9982option httpchk <method> <uri>
9983option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009984 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9986 yes | no | yes | yes
9987 Arguments :
9988 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
9989 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
9990 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
9991 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
9992 ones.
9993
9994 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
9995 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
9996 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
9997
9998 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
9999 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
10000 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +020010001 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010002
10003 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
10004 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
10005 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
10006 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
10007 the lack of any response.
10008
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +020010009 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
10010 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
10011 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
10012 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
10013
10014 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
10015 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
10016 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010017
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +020010018 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
10019 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +020010020 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010021 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +020010022 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010023
10024 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010025 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
10026 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
10027 backend https_relay
10028 mode tcp
10029 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
10030 http-check send hdr Host www
10031 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010032
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010033 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
10034 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
10035 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010036
10037
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010038option httpclose
10039no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010040 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10042 yes | yes | yes | yes
10043 Arguments : none
10044
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010045 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010046 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
10047 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
10048 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
10049 httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010050
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010051 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close the client or the server
Christopher Fauletd17dd842023-02-20 17:30:06 +010010052 connection, depending where the option is set. The frontend is considered for
10053 client connections while the backend is considered for server ones. If the
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010054 option is set on a listener, it is applied both on client and server
10055 connections. It will check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in
10056 each direction, and will add one if missing.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010057
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010058 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010059 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" request header, but will
10060 still cause the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010061
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +020010062 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010063 http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010064
10065 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10066 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10067
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010068 See also : "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010069
10070
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010071option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010072 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
10073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010010074 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010075 Arguments :
10076 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
10077 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
10078 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010079 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010080 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010081
10082 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10083 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10084 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
10085 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
10086 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
10087 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
10088 ports.
10089
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +010010090 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
10091 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010092
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020010093 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010095 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010096
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020010097option httpslog
10098 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
10099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10100 yes | yes | yes | no
10101
10102 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10103 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10104 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
10105 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
10106 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
10107 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
10108 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
10109
10110 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10111
10112 See also : section 8 about logging.
10113
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010114
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010115option independent-streams
10116no option independent-streams
10117 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +020010118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10119 yes | yes | yes | yes
10120 Arguments : none
10121
10122 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
10123 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
10124 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
10125 receive data or not.
10126
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010127 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +020010128 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
10129 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
10130 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
10131 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
10132 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
10133 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
10134 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
10135 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
10136 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
10137 socket buffers.
10138
10139 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
10140 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
10141 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
10142 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
10143 slow lines, so use it with caution.
10144
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010145 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +020010146
10147
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +020010148option ldap-check
10149 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
10150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10151 yes | no | yes | yes
10152 Arguments : none
10153
10154 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
10155 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
10156 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
10157 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
10158
10159 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
10160 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
10161
10162 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
10163 configure it.
10164
10165 Example :
10166 option ldap-check
10167
10168 See also : "option httpchk"
10169
10170
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010171option external-check
10172 Use external processes for server health checks
10173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10174 yes | no | yes | yes
10175
10176 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
10177 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
10178 command".
10179
10180 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
10181
10182 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
10183
10184
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +010010185option idle-close-on-response
10186no option idle-close-on-response
10187 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
10188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10189 yes | yes | yes | no
10190 Arguments : none
10191
10192 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
10193 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
10194 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
10195 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
10196 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
10197 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
10198 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
10199 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
10200 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
10201
10202 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
10203 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
10204
10205 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
10206 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
10207 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
10208 needed in case of frequent reloads.
10209
10210 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
10211 "hard-stop-after"
10212
10213
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010214option log-health-checks
10215no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010216 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10218 yes | no | yes | yes
10219 Arguments : none
10220
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010221 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
10222 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
10223 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010224
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010225 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
10226 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
10227 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
10228 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
10229 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
10230
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010231 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010232 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010233
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010234 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
10235 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
10236 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010237
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010238
10239option log-separate-errors
10240no option log-separate-errors
10241 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
10242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10243 yes | yes | yes | no
10244 Arguments : none
10245
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010246 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010247 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
10248 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
10249 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
10250 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
10251 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
10252 provides very important information.
10253
10254 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
10255 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
10256 error logs.
10257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010258 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010259 logging.
10260
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010261
10262option logasap
10263no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +020010264 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10266 yes | yes | yes | no
10267 Arguments : none
10268
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +020010269 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
10270 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
10271 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
10272 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
10273
10274 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
10275 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
10276 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
10277 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
10278 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050010279 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +020010280 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
10281 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
10282 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
10283 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050010284 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010285
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010286 Examples :
10287 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
10288 mode http
10289 option httplog
10290 option logasap
10291 log 192.168.2.200 local3
10292
10293 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
10294 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
10295 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
10296 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010298 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010299 logging.
10300
10301
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +020010302option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010303 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10305 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010306 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010307 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
10308 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +020010309 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
10310 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010311
10312 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
10313 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010314 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010315 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +100010316 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
10317 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
10318 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010319
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +100010320 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
10321 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
10322 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010323
10324 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010325 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010326 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
10327 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
10328 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
10329 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
10330 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
10331 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
10332 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
10333
10334 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
10335 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010336
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +020010337 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010338
10339 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
10340 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
10341 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10342 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010343 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010344 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010345
10346 See also: "option httpchk"
10347
10348
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010349option nolinger
10350no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010351 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010352 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10353 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010354 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010355
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010356 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010357 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
10358 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
10359 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
10360 connections.
10361
10362 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
10363 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010364 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
10365 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
10366 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
10367 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
10368 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
10369 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
10370 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
10371 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
10372 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
10373 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
10374 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
10375 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
10376 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010377
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010378 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
10379 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
10380 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
10381 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
10382 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010383
10384 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
10385 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010386 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050010387 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010388 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010389
10390 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10391 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10392
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010393 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
10394 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010395
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010396option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
10397 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
10398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10399 yes | yes | yes | yes
10400 Arguments :
10401 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
10402 matching <network>
10403 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
10404 header name.
10405
10406 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
10407 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
10408 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
10409 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
10410 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
10411 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
10412 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
10413 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
10414 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
10415 possible that the client has already brought one.
10416
10417 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
10418 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
10419 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
10420 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
10421 header and requires different one.
10422
10423 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
10424 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
10425 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +010010426 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
10427 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
10428 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
10429 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
10430 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010431
10432 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
10433 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
10434 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
10435 both are defined.
10436
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010437 Examples :
10438 # Original Destination address
10439 frontend www
10440 mode http
10441 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
10442
10443 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
10444 backend www
10445 mode http
10446 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
10447
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010448 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010449
10450
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010451option persist
10452no option persist
10453 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
10454 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10455 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010456 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010457
10458 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
10459 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
10460 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
10461 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
10462 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
10463 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
10464 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
10465 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
10466 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
10467 redirected to another valid server.
10468
10469 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10470 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10471
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +010010472 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010473
10474
Christopher Faulet59307b32022-10-03 15:00:59 +020010475option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +010010476 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
10477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10478 yes | no | yes | yes
10479 Arguments :
10480 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
10481 PostgreSQL server.
10482
10483 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
10484 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
10485 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
10486 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
10487
10488 See also: "option httpchk"
10489
10490
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010491option prefer-last-server
10492no option prefer-last-server
10493 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
10494 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10495 yes | no | yes | yes
10496 Arguments : none
10497
10498 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010499 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010500 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
10501 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010502 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010503 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010504 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010505 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
10506 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010507 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010508 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +020010509 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
10510 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
10511 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010512 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
10513 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
10514 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010515
10516 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10517 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10518
10519 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
10520
10521
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010522option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010523option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010524no option redispatch
10525 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
10526 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10527 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010528 Arguments :
10529 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
10530 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
10531 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010532 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010533 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010534 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010535 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
10536 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
10537 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
10538
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010539
10540 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
10541 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
10542 be able to access the service anymore.
10543
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +010010544 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
10545 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010546
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +020010547 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
10548 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
10549 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
10550 following order:
10551
10552 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
10553
10554 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
10555 list, or
10556
10557 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
10558
10559 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
10560 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
10561
10562 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
10563 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
10564 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
10565 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
10566
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010567 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010568 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
10569 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010570
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010571 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10572 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10573
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010574 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010575
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010576
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010577option redis-check
10578 Use redis health checks for server testing
10579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10580 yes | no | yes | yes
10581 Arguments : none
10582
10583 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
10584 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10585 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
10586 find the "+PONG" response message.
10587
10588 Example :
10589 option redis-check
10590
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010591 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010592
10593
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010594option smtpchk
10595option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
10596 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
10597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10598 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010599 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010600 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +020010601 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010602 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
10603
10604 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
10605 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
10606 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
10607
10608 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
10609 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
10610 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
10611 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
10612 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
10613 dead server.
10614
10615 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
10616 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010617 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010618 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
10619
10620 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
10621 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
10622 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10623 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010624 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010625
10626 Example :
10627 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
10628
10629 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
10630
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010632option socket-stats
10633no option socket-stats
10634
10635 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
10636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10637 yes | yes | yes | no
10638
10639 Arguments : none
10640
10641
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010642option splice-auto
10643no option splice-auto
10644 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
10645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10646 yes | yes | yes | yes
10647 Arguments : none
10648
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010649 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010650 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010651 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010652 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010653 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010654 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
10655 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
10656 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
10657 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10658
10659 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
10660 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
10661 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
10662 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
10663 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
10664 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
10665 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
10666 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
10667 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
10668 keyword.
10669
10670 Example :
10671 option splice-auto
10672
10673 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10674 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10675
10676 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
10677 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10678
10679
10680option splice-request
10681no option splice-request
10682 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
10683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10684 yes | yes | yes | yes
10685 Arguments : none
10686
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010687 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010688 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010689 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10690 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10691 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10692 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10693
10694 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10695
10696 Example :
10697 option splice-request
10698
10699 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10700 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10701
10702 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
10703 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10704
10705
10706option splice-response
10707no option splice-response
10708 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
10709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10710 yes | yes | yes | yes
10711 Arguments : none
10712
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010713 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010714 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010715 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10716 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10717 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10718 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10719
10720 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10721
10722 Example :
10723 option splice-response
10724
10725 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10726 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10727
10728 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
10729 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10730
10731
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010732option spop-check
10733 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
10734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +010010735 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010736 Arguments : none
10737
10738 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
10739 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10740 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
10741 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
10742
10743 Example :
10744 option spop-check
10745
10746 See also : "option httpchk"
10747
10748
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010749option srvtcpka
10750no option srvtcpka
10751 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
10752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10753 yes | no | yes | yes
10754 Arguments : none
10755
10756 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10757 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010758 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010759 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10760
10761 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10762 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10763 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10764 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10765
10766 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10767 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10768 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10769 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10770 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10771
10772 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10773
10774 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
10775 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
10776 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
10777
10778 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10779 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10780
10781 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
10782
10783
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010784option ssl-hello-chk
10785 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
10786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10787 yes | no | yes | yes
10788 Arguments : none
10789
10790 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
10791 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
10792 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
10793 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
10794 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
10795 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
10796 hello message.
10797
10798 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
10799 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
10800 messages, which is appreciable.
10801
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010802 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010803 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
10804 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010805
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010806 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
10807
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010808
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010809option tcp-check
10810 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
10811 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10812 yes | no | yes | yes
10813
10814 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
10815 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
10816
10817 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
10818 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
10819 attempt, which remains the default mode.
10820
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010821 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010822 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
10823 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
10824 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
10825 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
10826 only.
10827
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010828 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010829 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010830 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
10831 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
10832 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
10833
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010834 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010835 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
10836 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010837 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010838 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
10839 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
10840 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
10841 the respective protocols.
10842 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010843 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010844
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010845 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010846
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010847 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
10848 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
10849 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
10850 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010851
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010852 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
10853 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
10854 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010855
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010856
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010857 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010858 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010859 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010860 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010861
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010862 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010863 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010864 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010865
10866 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
10867 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010868 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010869 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010870 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010871 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010872 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010873 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010874 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10875 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010876 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010877 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10878 tcp-check expect string +OK
10879
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010880 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010881 (send many headers before analyzing)
10882 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010883 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010884 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
10885 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
10886 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
10887 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010888 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010889
10890
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010891 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010892
10893
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010894option tcp-smart-accept
10895no option tcp-smart-accept
10896 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
10897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10898 yes | yes | yes | no
10899 Arguments : none
10900
10901 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
10902 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
10903 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
10904 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
10905 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
10906 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
10907
10908 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
10909 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
10910 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
10911 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
10912
10913 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
10914 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
10915 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010916 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010917
10918 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
10919 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
10920 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
10921
10922 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
10923 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
10924 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
10925
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +020010926 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
10927
10928
10929option tcp-smart-connect
10930no option tcp-smart-connect
10931 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
10932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10933 yes | no | yes | yes
10934 Arguments : none
10935
10936 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
10937 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
10938 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
10939 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
10940 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
10941
10942 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
10943 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
10944 complex.
10945
10946 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
10947 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
10948 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
10949
10950 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10951 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10952
10953 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
10954
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010955
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010956option tcpka
10957 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
10958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10959 yes | yes | yes | yes
10960 Arguments : none
10961
10962 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10963 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010964 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010965 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10966
10967 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10968 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10969 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10970 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10971
10972 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10973 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10974 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10975 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10976 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10977
10978 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10979
10980 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
10981 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
10982 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
10983 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
10984 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
10985 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
10986 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
10987 backends.
10988
10989 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
10990
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010991
10992option tcplog
10993 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
10994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010010995 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010996 Arguments : none
10997
10998 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10999 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
11000 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
11001 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
11002 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
11003 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
11004 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
11005 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
11006
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020011007 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
11008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011009 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011010
11011
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011012option transparent
11013no option transparent
11014 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011016 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011017 Arguments : none
11018
11019 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
11020 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11021 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11022 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11023 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11024 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11025 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11026 appropriate server.
11027
11028 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11029 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11030
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +010011031 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011032 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011033
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010011034
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011035external-check command <command>
11036 Executable to run when performing an external-check
11037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11038 yes | no | yes | yes
11039
11040 Arguments :
11041 <command> is the external command to run
11042
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011043 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
11044
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010011045 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011046
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010011047 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
11048 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
11049 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
11050 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
11051 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
11052 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011053
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010011054 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
11055
11056 Environment variables :
11057 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
11058 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
11059
11060 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
11061
11062 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
11063
11064 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
11065 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
11066 for a UNIX socket).
11067
11068 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
11069
11070 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
11071
11072 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
11073
11074 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
11075
11076 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
11077
11078 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
11079 socket).
11080
Willy Tarreau973cf902022-05-13 15:58:35 +020011081 HAPROXY_SERVER_SSL "0" when SSL is not used, "1" when it is used
11082
11083 HAPROXY_SERVER_PROTO The protocol used by this server, which can be one
11084 of "cli" (the haproxy CLI), "syslog" (syslog TCP
11085 server), "peers" (peers TCP server), "h1" (HTTP/1.x
11086 server), "h2" (HTTP/2 server), or "tcp" (any other
11087 TCP server).
11088
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010011089 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
11090 the command may be set using "external-check path".
11091
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020011092 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
11093
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011094 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
11095 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
11096 failed.
11097
11098 Example :
11099 external-check command /bin/true
11100
11101 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
11102
11103
11104external-check path <path>
11105 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
11106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11107 yes | no | yes | yes
11108
11109 Arguments :
11110 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
11111
11112 The default path is "".
11113
11114 Example :
11115 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
11116
11117 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
11118 "external-check command"
11119
11120
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011121persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020011122persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011123 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
11124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11125 yes | no | yes | yes
11126 Arguments :
11127 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020011128 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
11129 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011130
11131 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
11132 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011133 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011134 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
11135 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
11136 forwarded to this server.
11137
11138 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
11139 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
11140 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011141 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011142 a single "listen" section.
11143
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020011144 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
11145 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
11146 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
11147
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011148 Example :
11149 listen tse-farm
11150 bind :3389
11151 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11152 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11153 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11154 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11155 persist rdp-cookie
11156 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011157 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011158 balance rdp-cookie
11159 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11160 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
11161
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011162 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011163
11164
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011165rate-limit sessions <rate>
11166 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
11167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11168 yes | yes | yes | no
11169 Arguments :
11170 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
11171 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
11172
11173 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
11174 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
11175 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011176 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011177 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
11178 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
11179
11180 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
11181 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
11182 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
11183 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
11184
11185 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
11186 listen smtp
11187 mode tcp
11188 bind :25
11189 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020011190 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011191
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020011192 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
11193 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
11194 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011195
11196 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
11197
11198
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011199redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11200redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11201redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011202 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
11203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11204 no | yes | yes | yes
11205
11206 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010011207 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011208
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011209 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011210 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011211 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
11212 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
11213 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011214
11215 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
11216 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
11217 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
11218 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
11219 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011220 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
11221 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
11222 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
11223 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011224
11225 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
11226 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
11227 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
11228 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
11229 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
11230 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011231 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011232 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011233 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
11234 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
11235 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011236
11237 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010011238 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
11239 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
11240 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020011241 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010011242 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
11243 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
11244 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
11245 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011246
11247 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011248 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011249
11250 - "drop-query"
11251 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
11252 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
11253 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
11254 with a location-type redirect.
11255
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010011256 - "append-slash"
11257 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
11258 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
11259 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
11260 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
11261
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020011262 - "ignore-empty"
11263 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
11264 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
11265 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
11266 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
11267 of known paths using a simple map.
11268
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011269 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
11270 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
11271 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
11272 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
11273 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
11274 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
11275 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
11276
11277 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
11278 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
11279 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
11280 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
11281 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
11282 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
11283 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011284
11285 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
11286 acl clear dst_port 80
11287 acl secure dst_port 8080
11288 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011289 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010011290 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011291 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
11292
11293 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010011294 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
11295 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
11296 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011297 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011298
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010011299 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
11300 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
11301 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
11302
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011303 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010011304 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011305
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011306 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020011307 http-request redirect code 301 location \
11308 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
11309 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011310
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020011311 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
11312 http-request redirect code 301 location \
11313 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
11314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011315 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011316
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010011317
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011318retries <value>
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011319 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011320 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11321 yes | no | yes | yes
11322 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011323 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
11324 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011325
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011326 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
11327 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
11328 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
11329 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
11330 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011331
11332 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070011333 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011334 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011335
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011336 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
11337 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
11338 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011339
11340 See also : "option redispatch"
11341
11342
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011343retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020011344 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
11345 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
11346 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011347 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11348 yes | no | yes | yes
11349 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011350 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
11351 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
11352 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
11353 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
11354 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011355
11356 none never retry
11357
11358 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
11359 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
11360
11361 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
11362 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
11363 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
11364 request timeout on the server side, poor network
11365 condition, or a server crash or restart while
11366 processing the request.
11367
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020011368 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
11369 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
11370 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
11371 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
11372 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
11373 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
11374 overflow attack for example).
11375
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011376 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
11377 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
11378 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
11379 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
11380 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
11381 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
11382 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
11383 amplify denial of service attacks.
11384
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020011385 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
11386 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
11387 considered to be safe to retry.
11388
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010011389 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
11390 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
11391 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
11392 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
11393 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011394
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020011395 all-retryable-errors
11396 retry request for any error that are considered
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +010011397 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
11398 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
11399 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020011400
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011401 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
11402 not cumulative.
11403
11404 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
11405 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
11406 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
11407 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
11408
11409 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
11410 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
11411 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
11412 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
11413 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
11414 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
11415 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
11416 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
11417 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
11418 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
11419 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
11420 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
11421
11422 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
11423 should not use this directive.
11424
11425 The default is "conn-failure".
11426
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011427 Example:
11428 retry-on 503 504
11429
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011430 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
11431
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011432server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011433 Declare a server in a backend
11434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11435 no | no | yes | yes
11436 Arguments :
11437 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011438 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011439 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011440
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011441 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
11442 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
11443 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
11444 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011445 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
11446 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011447 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011448 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
11449 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011450 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
11451 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
11452 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
11453 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
11454 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11455 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11456 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011457 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020011458 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
11459 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
11460 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
11461 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
11462 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
11463 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011464 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11465 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011466 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
11467 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011468
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011469 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011470 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
11471 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
11472 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
11473 adding this value to the client's port.
11474
11475 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
11476 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011477 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011478
11479 Examples :
11480 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
11481 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011482 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011483 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
11484 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
11485 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011486
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020011487 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
11488 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
11489 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
11490 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
11491 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
11492
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011493 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
11494 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011495
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011496server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011497 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011498 this backend.
11499 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11500 no | no | yes | yes
11501
11502 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
11503 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
11504 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
11505 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
11506 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011507
11508 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
11509 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
11510
11511 global
11512 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
11513
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010011514 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011515 load-server-state-from-file
11516
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011517 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011518 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011519
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020011520server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
11521 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
11522 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
11523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11524 no | no | yes | yes
11525
11526 Arguments:
11527 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
11528
11529 <num | range>
11530 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
11531 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
11532 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
11533 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
11534
11535 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
11536
11537 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
11538
11539 <params*>
11540 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
11541 keyword.
11542
11543 Examples:
11544 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
11545 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
11546 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
11547
11548 # or
11549 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
11550
11551 # would be equivalent to:
11552 server srv1 google.com:80 check
11553 server srv2 google.com:80 check
11554 server srv3 google.com:80 check
11555
11556
11557
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011558source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011559source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011560source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011561 Set the source address for outgoing connections
11562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11563 yes | no | yes | yes
11564 Arguments :
11565 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
11566 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011567
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011568 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011569 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
11570 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
11571 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
11572 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
11573 supported prefixes are :
11574 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11575 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11576 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011577 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011578 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11579 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011580
11581 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
11582 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011583 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
11584 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
11585 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011586
11587 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
11588 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
11589 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
11590 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
11591 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
11592 <addr>.
11593
11594 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
11595 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
11596 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
11597 port.
11598
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011599 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
11600 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
11601 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
11602 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010011603 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011604 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
11605 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
11606 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
11607 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
11608 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
11609 HTTP header.
11610
11611 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
11612 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011613 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011614 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
11615 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11616 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
11617 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
11618 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
11619 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
11620 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
11621
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011622 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
11623 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
11624 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
11625 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
11626 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
11627 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
11628
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011629 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
11630 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
11631 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
11632 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
11633
11634 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
11635 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
11636 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
11637 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
11638 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
11639 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
11640
11641 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
11642 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
11643 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
11644 there are two methods :
11645
11646 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
11647 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
11648 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
11649 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
11650 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
11651 of the client ranges may be used.
11652
11653 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
11654 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
11655 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
11656 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
11657 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
11658 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
11659 same session.
11660
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011661 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
11662 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
11663 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011664 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011665
Willy Tarreaua547a212023-08-29 10:24:26 +020011666 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges, or on supported systems,
11667 the "cap_net_raw" capability. See also the "setcap" global directive.
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020011668
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011669 Examples :
11670 backend private
11671 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
11672 source 192.168.1.200
11673
11674 backend transparent_ssl1
11675 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
11676 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11677
11678 backend transparent_ssl2
11679 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
11680 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
11681 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
11682
11683 backend transparent_ssl3
11684 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
11685 # is more conntrack-friendly.
11686 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11687
11688 backend transparent_smtp
11689 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
11690 # with Tproxy version 4.
11691 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
11692
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011693 backend transparent_http
11694 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
11695 # proxy.
11696 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
11697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011698 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011699 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
11700
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011701
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011702srvtcpka-cnt <count>
11703 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
11704 the connection on the server side.
11705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11706 yes | no | yes | yes
11707 Arguments :
11708 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
11709
11710 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
11711 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011712 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11713 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011714
11715 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11716
11717
11718srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
11719 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
11720 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
11721 server side.
11722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11723 yes | no | yes | yes
11724 Arguments :
11725 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
11726 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
11727 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
11728 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
11729
11730 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
11731 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011732 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11733 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011734
11735 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11736
11737
11738srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
11739 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
11740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11741 yes | no | yes | yes
11742 Arguments :
11743 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
11744 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
11745 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
11746 document.
11747
11748 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
11749 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011750 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11751 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011752
11753 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
11754
11755
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011756stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
11757 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
11758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011759 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011760
11761 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
11762 matched.
11763
11764 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
11765 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
11766
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010011767 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
11768 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
11769 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
11770 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011771
11772 Example :
11773 # statistics admin level only for localhost
11774 backend stats_localhost
11775 stats enable
11776 stats admin if LOCALHOST
11777
11778 Example :
11779 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
11780 backend stats_auth
11781 stats enable
11782 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
11783 stats admin if TRUE
11784
11785 Example :
11786 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
11787 userlist stats-auth
11788 group admin users admin
11789 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
11790 group readonly users haproxy
11791 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
11792
11793 backend stats_auth
11794 stats enable
11795 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
11796 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
11797 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
11798 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
11799
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011800 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
11801 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011802
11803
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011804stats auth <user>:<passwd>
11805 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
11806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011807 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011808 Arguments :
11809 <user> is a user name to grant access to
11810
11811 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
11812
11813 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
11814 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
11815 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
11816 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
11817 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
11818 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
11819
11820 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
11821 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
11822 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011823 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011824
11825 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
11826 report using "stats scope".
11827
11828 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11829 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11830 unobvious parameters.
11831
11832 Example :
11833 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11834 backend public_www
11835 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11836 stats enable
11837 stats hide-version
11838 stats scope .
11839 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011840 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011841 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11842 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11843
11844 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11845 backend private_monitoring
11846 stats enable
11847 stats uri /admin?stats
11848 stats refresh 5s
11849
11850 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
11851
11852
11853stats enable
11854 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
11855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011856 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011857 Arguments : none
11858
11859 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
11860 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
11861 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
11862 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
11863 - stats auth : no authentication
11864 - stats scope : no restriction
11865
11866 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11867 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11868 unobvious parameters.
11869
11870 Example :
11871 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11872 backend public_www
11873 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11874 stats enable
11875 stats hide-version
11876 stats scope .
11877 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011878 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011879 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11880 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11881
11882 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11883 backend private_monitoring
11884 stats enable
11885 stats uri /admin?stats
11886 stats refresh 5s
11887
11888 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11889
11890
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011891stats hide-version
11892 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011894 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011895 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011896
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011897 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
11898 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
11899 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
11900 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
11901 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
11902 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011903
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011904 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11905 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11906 unobvious parameters.
11907
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011908 Example :
11909 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11910 backend public_www
11911 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011912 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011913 stats hide-version
11914 stats scope .
11915 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011916 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011917 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11918 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011919
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011920 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11921 backend private_monitoring
11922 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011923 stats uri /admin?stats
11924 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010011925
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011926 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011927
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011928
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020011929stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
11930 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
11931 Access control for statistics
11932
11933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11934 no | no | yes | yes
11935
11936 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
11937 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
11938 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
11939 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
11940 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
11941 should be asked to enter a username and password.
11942
11943 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
11944 instance.
11945
11946 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
11947 about ACL usage.
11948
11949
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011950stats realm <realm>
11951 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
11952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011953 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011954 Arguments :
11955 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
11956 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
11957 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
11958
11959 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
11960 using a backslash ('\').
11961
11962 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
11963 only related to authentication.
11964
11965 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11966 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11967 unobvious parameters.
11968
11969 Example :
11970 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11971 backend public_www
11972 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11973 stats enable
11974 stats hide-version
11975 stats scope .
11976 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011977 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011978 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11979 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11980
11981 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11982 backend private_monitoring
11983 stats enable
11984 stats uri /admin?stats
11985 stats refresh 5s
11986
11987 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
11988
11989
11990stats refresh <delay>
11991 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
11992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011993 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011994 Arguments :
11995 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
11996 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
11997 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
11998 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
11999 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
12000 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
12001
12002 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
12003 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
12004 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050012005 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012006
12007 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12008 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12009 unobvious parameters.
12010
12011 Example :
12012 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12013 backend public_www
12014 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12015 stats enable
12016 stats hide-version
12017 stats scope .
12018 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012019 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012020 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12021 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12022
12023 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12024 backend private_monitoring
12025 stats enable
12026 stats uri /admin?stats
12027 stats refresh 5s
12028
12029 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
12030
12031
12032stats scope { <name> | "." }
12033 Enable statistics and limit access scope
12034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012035 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012036 Arguments :
12037 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
12038 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
12039 section in which the statement appears.
12040
12041 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
12042 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
12043 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
12044 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
12045 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
12046 exists.
12047
12048 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12049 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12050 unobvious parameters.
12051
12052 Example :
12053 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12054 backend public_www
12055 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12056 stats enable
12057 stats hide-version
12058 stats scope .
12059 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012060 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012061 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12062 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12063
12064 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12065 backend private_monitoring
12066 stats enable
12067 stats uri /admin?stats
12068 stats refresh 5s
12069
12070 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
12071
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012072
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012073stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012074 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
12075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012076 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012077
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012078 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012079 description from global section is automatically used instead.
12080
12081 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
12082 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
12083
12084 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12085 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012086 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012087
12088 Example :
12089 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12090 backend private_monitoring
12091 stats enable
12092 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
12093 stats uri /admin?stats
12094 stats refresh 5s
12095
12096 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
12097 global section.
12098
12099
12100stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012101 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
12102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12103 yes | yes | yes | yes
12104 Arguments : none
12105
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012106 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012107 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
12108 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
12109 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
12110 - IP (socket, server)
12111 - cookie (backend, server)
12112
12113 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12114 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012115 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012116
12117 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
12118
12119
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020012120stats show-modules
12121 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
12122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12123 yes | yes | yes | yes
12124 Arguments : none
12125
12126 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
12127 values as a tooltip.
12128
12129 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12130 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12131 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
12132
12133 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
12134
12135
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012136stats show-node [ <name> ]
12137 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
12138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012139 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012140 Arguments:
12141 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
12142 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
12143
12144 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
12145 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012146 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012147
12148 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12149 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12150 unobvious parameters.
12151
12152 Example:
12153 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12154 backend private_monitoring
12155 stats enable
12156 stats show-node Europe-1
12157 stats uri /admin?stats
12158 stats refresh 5s
12159
12160 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
12161 section.
12162
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012163
12164stats uri <prefix>
12165 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
12166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012167 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012168 Arguments :
12169 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
12170 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
12171 query string.
12172
12173 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
12174 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
12175 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
12176 possible to reach it in the application.
12177
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012178 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012179 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012180 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
12181 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
12182 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
12183 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
12184
12185 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
12186 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
12187 an address or a port to statistics only.
12188
12189 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12190 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12191 unobvious parameters.
12192
12193 Example :
12194 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12195 backend public_www
12196 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12197 stats enable
12198 stats hide-version
12199 stats scope .
12200 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012201 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012202 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12203 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12204
12205 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12206 backend private_monitoring
12207 stats enable
12208 stats uri /admin?stats
12209 stats refresh 5s
12210
12211 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
12212
12213
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012214stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
12215 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012217 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012218
12219 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012220 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012221 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012222 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012223 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
12224
12225 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12226 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12227 the "stick-table" statement.
12228
12229 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
12230 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
12231 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
12232 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
12233 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
12234
12235 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12236 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
12237 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
12238 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
12239 transformation rules.
12240
12241 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12242 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12243 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12244 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12245 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12246 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12247 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12248
12249 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
12250 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
12251 ACL based conditions.
12252
12253 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
12254 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
12255 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
12256 matches can be used as fallbacks.
12257
12258 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
12259 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
12260 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
12261 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
12262
12263 Example :
12264 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
12265 # last 30 minutes
12266 backend pop
12267 mode tcp
12268 balance roundrobin
12269 stick store-request src
12270 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12271 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
12272 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
12273
12274 backend smtp
12275 mode tcp
12276 balance roundrobin
12277 stick match src table pop
12278 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
12279 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
12280
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012281 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
12282 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012283
12284
12285stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
12286 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
12287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12288 no | no | yes | yes
12289
12290 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
12291 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
12292 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
12293 for writing more maintainable configurations.
12294
12295 Examples :
12296 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010012297 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012298
12299 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
12300 stick match src table pop if !localhost
12301 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
12302
12303
12304 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
12305 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
12306 backend http
12307 mode http
12308 balance roundrobin
12309 stick on src table https
12310 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
12311 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
12312 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
12313
12314 backend https
12315 mode tcp
12316 balance roundrobin
12317 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12318 stick on src
12319 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12320 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12321
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012322 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012323
12324
12325stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
12326 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
12327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12328 no | no | yes | yes
12329
12330 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012331 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012332 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012333 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012334 server is selected.
12335
12336 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12337 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12338 the "stick-table" statement.
12339
12340 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12341 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12342 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
12343 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
12344 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
12345 address.
12346
12347 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12348 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
12349 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
12350 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
12351 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
12352 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
12353 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
12354 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
12355 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
12356 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
12357
12358 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12359 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12360 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12361 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12362 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12363 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12364 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12365
12366 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
12367 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12368 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
12369 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12370
12371 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
12372 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12373 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12374 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12375 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12376 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012377 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
12378 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12379 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12380 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12381 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12382 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012383
12384 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
12385 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
12386 the request.
12387
12388 Example :
12389 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
12390 # last 30 minutes
12391 backend pop
12392 mode tcp
12393 balance roundrobin
12394 stick store-request src
12395 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12396 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
12397 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
12398
12399 backend smtp
12400 mode tcp
12401 balance roundrobin
12402 stick match src table pop
12403 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
12404 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
12405
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012406 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012407
12408
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012409stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012410 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012411 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080012412 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012414 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012415
12416 Arguments :
12417 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
12418 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
12419 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12420 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12421
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010012422 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
12423 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
12424 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12425 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12426
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012427 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
12428 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
12429 instance.
12430
12431 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
12432 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
12433 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
12434 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
12435 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
12436 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012437 to 32 characters.
12438
12439 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
12440 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
12441 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012442 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012443 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
12444 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012445
12446 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012447 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
12448 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012449 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
12450 increase.
12451
12452 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012453 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
12454 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
12455 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012456
12457 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012458 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012459 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
12460 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012461 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012462 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
12463 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
12464 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
12465 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
12466 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
12467 parameter (see below).
12468
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012469 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
12470 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
12471 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
12472 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
12473 soft restart.
12474
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012475 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012476 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
12477 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012478 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
12479 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012480 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012481 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012482 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
12483 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012484 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
12485 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012486
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012487 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
12488 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
12489 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
12490 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
12491 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
12492 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
12493 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
12494 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
12495 token.
12496
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012497 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
12498 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
12499 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
12500 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012501 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
12502 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
12503 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
12504 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
12505 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
12506 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
12507 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
12508 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
12509 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
12510 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
12511 types and their arguments.
12512
12513 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
12514 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
12515 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
12516 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
12517
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012518 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
12519 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
12520 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
12521 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
12522 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
12523 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
12524 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
12525 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
12526 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
12527 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012528 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
12529 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
12530 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
12531 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012532
12533 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
12534 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
12535 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
12536 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
12537 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
12538 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012539 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpt(100)
12540 allowing the storage of gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer
12541 update message can fit into the buffer.
12542 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpc(1) if you want to
12543 store only the counter gpc0.
12544 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012545 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
12546 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
12547 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012548 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
12549 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
12550 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
12551 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012552
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012553 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12554 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12555 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012556 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012557
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012558 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12559 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12560 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012561 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012562 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012563 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012564
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012565 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12566 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12567 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12568 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
12569
12570 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
12571 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12572 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
12573 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
12574 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
12575 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
12576
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012577 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
12578 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
12579 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
12580 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
12581 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012582 elements: gpt(100) allowing the storage of gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that
12583 the build of a peer update message can fit into the buffer.
12584 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpt(1) if you want to
12585 to store only the tag gpt0.
12586 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of counters will
12587 increase the data size and the traffic load using peers protocol since
12588 all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020012589 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
12590 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
12591 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012592
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020012593 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12594 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12595 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12596 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
12597
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012598 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12599 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
12600 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
12601 they were received.
12602
12603 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12604 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
12605 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
12606 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
12607 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
12608
12609 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12610 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12611 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12612 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
12613 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12614
12615 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12616 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
12617 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
12618
12619 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12620 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12621 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12622 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
12623 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12624
12625 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12626 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
12627 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
12628 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
12629 the client side.
12630
12631 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12632 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12633 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12634 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
12635 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
12636 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
12637 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
12638
12639 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12640 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
12641 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12642 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
12643 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
12644 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012645 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012646
12647 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12648 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12649 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12650 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12651 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
12652 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12653
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010012654 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12655 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
12656 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12657 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
12658 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
12659
12660 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12661 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12662 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12663 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12664 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
12665 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12666
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012667 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012668 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012669 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
12670 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
12671
12672 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12673 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12674 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12675 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12676 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12677 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
12678 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
12679 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
12680 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
12681 recommended for better fairness.
12682
12683 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012684 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012685 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
12686 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
12687
12688 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12689 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12690 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12691 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12692 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12693 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
12694 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
12695 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
12696 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
12697 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012698
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012699 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
12700 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012701 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
12702 reference it.
12703
12704 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
12705 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010012706 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
12707 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
12708 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012709
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012710 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
12711 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
12712 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
12713 something that can be ignored.
12714
12715 Example:
12716 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
12717 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
12718 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
12719 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
12720
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012721 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010012722 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012723
12724
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012725stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010012726 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12728 no | no | yes | yes
12729
12730 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012731 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012732 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012733 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012734 server is selected.
12735
12736 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12737 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12738 the "stick-table" statement.
12739
12740 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12741 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12742 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
12743 when the response is a SSL server hello.
12744
12745 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12746 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
12747 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
12748 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
12749 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
12750 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012751 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012752 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
12753 rules.
12754
12755 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12756 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12757 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12758 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12759 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12760 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12761 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12762
12763 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
12764 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12765 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
12766 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12767
12768 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
12769 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12770 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12771 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12772 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12773 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012774 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
12775 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12776 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12777 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12778 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12779 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
12780 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
12781 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
12782 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012783
12784 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
12785
12786 Example :
12787 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
12788 backend https
12789 mode tcp
12790 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012791 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012792 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012793
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012794 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
12795 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012796
12797 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
12798 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12799 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
12800
12801 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
12802 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012803
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012804 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
12805 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
12806 # at offset 44.
12807
12808 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012809 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012810
12811 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012812 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012813
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012814 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12815 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12816
12817 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
12818 extraction.
12819
12820
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012821tcp-check comment <string>
12822 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
12823 it fails.
12824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12825 yes | no | yes | yes
12826
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012827 Arguments :
12828 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
12829 rule fails.
12830
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012831 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
12832 user-friendly error reporting.
12833
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012834 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
12835 "tcp-check expect".
12836
12837
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012838tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
12839 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012840 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012841 Opens a new connection
12842 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012843 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012844
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012845 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012846 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12847
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012848 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012849 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012850
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012851 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012852 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
12853 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012854 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012855
12856 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012857
12858 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
12859
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020012860 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
12861
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012862 ssl opens a ciphered connection
12863
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020012864 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
12865
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020012866 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
12867 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
12868 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12869 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12870
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012871 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
12872 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
12873 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
12874 haproxy -vv.
12875
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012876 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012877
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012878 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
12879 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
12880 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
12881
12882 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
12883 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
12884 of the sequence.
12885
12886 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
12887 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
12888 do.
12889
12890 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
12891 unset-var or comment rules.
12892
12893 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012894 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
12895 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
12896 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
12897 option tcp-check
12898 tcp-check connect
12899 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12900 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12901 tcp-check send \r\n
12902 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12903 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
12904 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12905 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12906 tcp-check send \r\n
12907 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12908 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
12909
12910 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
12911 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012912 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012913 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12914 tcp-check connect port 143
12915 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12916 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
12917
12918 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
12919
12920
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012921tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012922 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012923 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012924 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012925 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012926 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012927 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012928
12929 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012930 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12931
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012932 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
12933 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
12934 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
12935 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
12936 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
12937 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
12938 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
12939 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
12940 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
12941 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
12942
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012943 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012944 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
12945 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012946 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
12947 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
12948 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
12949
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012950 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12951 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
12952 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012953 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
12954 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012955 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12956 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012957 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
12958 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012959 By default "L7OK" is used.
12960
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012961 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12962 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012963 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
12964 supported :
12965 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12966 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012967 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12968 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
12969 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12970 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
12971 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012972
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012973 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012974 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012975 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
12976 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12977 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12978 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012979 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
12980
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020012981 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12982 informational message reported in logs if the expect
12983 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
12984 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
12985
12986 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12987 informational message reported in logs if an error
12988 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
12989 log-format string.
12990
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012991 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
12992 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
12993 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12994 followed by some converters.
12995
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012996 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
12997 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
12998 with the usual backslash ('\').
12999 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013000 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013001 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
13002 used upper or lower case.
13003
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013004 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
13005
13006 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
13007 A health check response will be considered valid if the
13008 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
13009 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
13010 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
13011 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
13012 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
13013 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
13014
13015 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
13016 A health check response will be considered valid if the
13017 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
13018 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
13019 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
13020 expression.
13021
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020013022 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
13023 A health check response will be considered valid if the
13024 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
13025 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
13026 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
13027 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
13028
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013029 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
13030 in the response buffer. A health check response will
13031 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
13032 this exact hexadecimal string.
13033 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
13034
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010013035 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
13036 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
13037 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
13038 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
13039 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
13040 size of the original response. As such, the expected
13041 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
13042 size.
13043
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020013044 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
13045 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
13046 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
13047 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
13048 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
13049 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
13050 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
13051 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
13052 in a binary string before matching the response's
13053 buffer.
13054
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013055 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013056 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013057 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
13058 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
13059 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
13060 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
13061 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
13062 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
13063 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
13064 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
13065 the null character.
13066
13067 Examples :
13068 # perform a POP check
13069 option tcp-check
13070 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
13071
13072 # perform an IMAP check
13073 option tcp-check
13074 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
13075
13076 # look for the redis master server
13077 option tcp-check
13078 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020013079 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013080 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
13081 tcp-check expect string role:master
13082 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
13083 tcp-check expect string +OK
13084
13085
13086 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013087 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013088
13089
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013090tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
13091tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
13092 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
13093 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013094 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013095 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013096
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013097 Arguments :
13098 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
13099
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013100 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
13101 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020013102
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013103 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
13104 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013105
13106 Examples :
13107 # look for the redis master server
13108 option tcp-check
13109 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
13110 tcp-check expect string role:master
13111
13112 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013113 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013114
13115
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013116tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
13117tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
13118 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
13119 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013120 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013121 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013122
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013123 Arguments :
13124 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013125
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013126 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
13127 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020013128
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013129 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
13130 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
13131 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013132
13133 Examples :
13134 # redis check in binary
13135 option tcp-check
13136 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
13137 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
13138
13139
13140 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013141 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013142
13143
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013144tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13145tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013146 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013147 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013148 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013149
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013150 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013151 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13152 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
13153 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
13154 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
13155 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
13156 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
13157 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
13158 and '-'.
13159
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013160 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
13161 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +050013162 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013163 conditions.
13164
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013165 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
13166
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013167 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
13168 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
13169
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013170 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013171 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013172 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013173
13174
13175tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013176 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013177 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013178 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013179
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013180 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013181 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13182 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
13183 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
13184 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
13185 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
13186 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
13187 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
13188 and '-'.
13189
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013190 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013191 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
13192
13193
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013194tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013195 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020013196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013197 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013198 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013199 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13200 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020013201
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013202 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013203
13204 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
13205 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013206 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
13207 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
13208 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
13209 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
13210 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
13211 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013212
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013213 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13214 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13215 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013216 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
13217 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
13218 is true.
13219
13220 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13221 supported:
13222 - accept
13223 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
13224 - expect-proxy layer4
13225 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013226 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013227 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13228 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13229 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13230 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13231 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13232 - set-dst <expr>
13233 - set-dst-port <expr>
13234 - set-mark <mark>
13235 - set-src <expr>
13236 - set-src-port <expr>
13237 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013238 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13239 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013240 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013241 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13242 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13243 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013244 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013245
13246 The supported actions are described below.
13247
13248 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
13249 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013250
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013251 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13252 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13253 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13254 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13255 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13256 a defaults section defining such rules.
13257
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013258 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13259 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13260 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013261
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013262 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
13263 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
13264 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013265
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013266 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13267 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
13268 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013269
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013270 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
13271 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
13272 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013273
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013274 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13275 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
13276 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013277
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013278 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013279
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013280 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013281
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013282 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013283
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013284 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013285
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013286tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013287
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013288 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
13289 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013290
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013291tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
13292 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013293
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013294 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
13295 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
13296 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
13297 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
13298 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
13299 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
13300 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013301
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013302tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013303
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013304 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
13305 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
13306 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
13307 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
13308 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
13309 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020013310
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013311tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013312
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013313 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
13314 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
13315 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
13316 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
13317 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
13318 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
13319 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
13320 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
13321 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
13322 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
13323 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013324
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013325tcp-request connection sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13326 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13327
13328 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13329 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13330 a complete description.
13331
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013332tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13333tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13334tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013335
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013336 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13337 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13338 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13339 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013340
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013341tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13342 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13343tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13344 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013345
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013346 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13347 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020013348 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020013349
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013350tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13351tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013352
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013353 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13354 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13355 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013356
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013357tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013358
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013359 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13360 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13361 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013362
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013363tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13364tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013365
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013366 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13367 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13368 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013369
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013370tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013371
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013372 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13373 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13374 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013375
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013376tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13377tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013378
13379 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13380 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
13381 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13382 for a complete description.
13383
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013384tcp-request connection silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013385
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013386 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13387 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13388 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13389 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013390
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013391tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13392tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13393tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013394
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013395 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13396 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13397 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013398
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013399tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13400
13401 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13402 details about variables.
13403
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013404
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013405tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13406 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013408 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013409 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013410 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13411 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013412
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013413 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013414
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013415 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013416 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13417 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013418 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
13419 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013420
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013421 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
13422 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
13423 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
13424 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013425 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013426 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013427 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
13428 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
13429 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
13430 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013431 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013432 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013433
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013434 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13435 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13436 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13437 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013438
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013439 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13440 supported:
13441 - accept
13442 - capture <sample> len <length>
13443 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13444 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013445 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013446 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013447 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013448 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013449 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010013450 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013451 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013452 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020013453 - set-dst <expr>
13454 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013455 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013456 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013457 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013458 - set-priority-class <expr>
13459 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013460 - set-src <expr>
13461 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013462 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013463 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13464 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013465 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013466 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013467 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13468 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13469 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013470 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013471 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013472
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013473 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013474
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013475 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
13476 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
13477 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
13478 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
13479 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
13480 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013481
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013482 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13483 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13484 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13485 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13486 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13487 a defaults section defining such rules.
13488
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013489 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013490 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13491 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013492
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020013493 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
13494 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
13495 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
13496 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
13497 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
13498 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
13499
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013500 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020013501 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
13502 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
13503 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
13504 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
13505 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
13506 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
13507 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
13508 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
13509 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
13510 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013511
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013512 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013513 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
13514 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
13515 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013516
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013517 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONd49b5592022-10-05 18:09:33 +020013518 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013519
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013520 Example:
13521
13522 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013523 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013524 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013525
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013526 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013527 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013528 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013529 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13530 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020013531 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013532 tcp-request content reject
13533
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013534 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
13535 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
13536 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13537 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13538 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
13539 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
13540 ...
13541 http-request reject unless is_host_com
13542
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013543 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013544 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
13545 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013546 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013547 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013548
13549 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
13550 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013551 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013552 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013553 tcp-request content reject
13554
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013555 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013556 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013557 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013558 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013559 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
13560 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013561
13562 Example:
13563 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13564 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013565 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013566
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013567 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013568 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013569
13570 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013571 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013572 # protecting all our sites
13573 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013574 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
13575 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013576 ...
13577 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
13578
13579 backend http_dynamic
13580 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013581 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013582 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013583 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013584 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013585 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013586 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013587
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013588 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013589
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030013590 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
13591 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013592
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013593tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13594
13595 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010013596 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013597
13598tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
13599 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13600
13601 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
13602 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
13603 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
13604 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
13605 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
13606 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
13607 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
13608 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
13609 information.
13610
13611tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13612
13613 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
13614 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
13615 complete description.
13616
13617tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13618
13619 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
13620 are evaluated.
13621
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013622tcp-request content sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13623 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13624
13625 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13626 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13627 a complete description.
13628
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013629tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13630tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13631tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13632
13633 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13634 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13635 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13636 description.
13637
13638tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13639 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13640tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13641 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13642
13643 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13644 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020013645 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013646
13647tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13648 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13649
13650 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
13651 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
13652
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013653tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
13654 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013655
13656 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13657 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13658 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13659
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013660tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13661tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13662
13663 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13664 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13665 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13666
13667tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13668
13669 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13670 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
13671
13672tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13673
13674 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13675 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13676 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13677
13678tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13679
13680 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13681 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
13682
13683tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13684
13685 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
13686 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
13687
13688tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13689
13690 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
13691 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
13692 description.
13693
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013694tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13695tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13696
13697 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13698 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13699 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13700
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013701tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13702
13703 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13704 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13705 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13706
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013707tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13708tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013709
13710 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13711 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13712 for a complete description.
13713
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013714tcp-request content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013715
13716 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13717 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13718 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13719 complete description.
13720
13721tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
13722 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13723
13724 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
13725 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
13726 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
13727 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
13728 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
13729 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
13730 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
13731 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
13732 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
13733 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
13734
13735 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
13736
13737tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13738tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13739tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13740
13741 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13742 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13743 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13744
13745tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13746
13747 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13748 details about variables.
13749
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +020013750tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013751
13752 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
13753 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
13754 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
13755 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
13756 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
13757
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013758
13759tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
13760 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
13761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013762 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013763 Arguments :
13764 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13765 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13766 as explained at the top of this document.
13767
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013768 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013769 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
13770 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
13771 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
13772 data for at most the specified amount of time.
13773
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020013774 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
13775 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
13776 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
13777 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
13778
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013779 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013780 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013781 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013782 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013783 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010013784 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
13785 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
13786 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013787
Christopher Faulet43525ab2023-05-16 08:15:12 +020013788 Note the inspection delay is shortened if an connection error or shutdown is
13789 experienced or if the request buffer appears as full.
13790
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013791 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
13792 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
13793 it pass through unaffected.
13794
13795 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
13796 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
13797 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013798 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013799 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
13800 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020013801 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
13802 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
13803 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013804
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013805 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13806 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13807
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013808 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013809 "timeout client".
13810
13811
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013812tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13813 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
13814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013815 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013816 Arguments :
13817 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13818 below.
13819
13820 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13821
13822 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
13823 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
13824 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
13825 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053013826 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013827 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
13828 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
13829 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
13830 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
13831 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
13832 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
13833 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
13834 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
13835 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
13836 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
13837 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
13838 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
13839 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
13840 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
13841 instead.
13842
13843 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13844 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13845 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
13846 rules which may be inserted.
13847
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013848 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13849 supported:
13850 - accept
13851 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013852 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013853 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13854 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13855 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13856 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13857 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013858 - set-dst <expr>
13859 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013860 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013861 - set-src <expr>
13862 - set-src-port <expr>
13863 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013864 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13865 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013866 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013867 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13868 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13869 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
13870 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013871
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013872 The supported actions are described below.
13873
13874 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13875 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13876 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13877 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13878 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13879 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013880
13881 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13882 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13883 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
13884
13885 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
13886 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
13887 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
13888 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
13889 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
13890
13891 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
13892 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13893
13894 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
13895 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
13896 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
13897
13898 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13899 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
13900 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13901
13902 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
13903 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
13904 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
13905
13906 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13907 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13908 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
13909
13910 See section 7 about ACL usage.
13911
13912 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
13913
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013914tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13915
13916 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
13917 rules are evaluated.
13918
13919tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13920
13921 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
13922 are evaluated.
13923
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013924tcp-request session sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13925 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13926
13927 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13928 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13929 a complete description.
13930
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013931tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13932tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13933tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13934
13935 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13936 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13937 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13938 description.
13939
13940tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13941 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13942tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13943 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13944
13945 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13946 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020013947 sc-set-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013948 description.
13949
13950tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13951tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13952
13953 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13954 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13955 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13956
13957tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13958
13959 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13960 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13961 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13962
13963tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13964tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13965
13966 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13967 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13968 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13969
13970tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13971
13972 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13973 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13974 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13975
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013976tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13977tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013978
13979 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13980 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13981 for a complete description.
13982
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013983tcp-request session silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013984
13985 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13986 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13987 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13988 complete description.
13989
13990tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13991tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13992tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13993
13994 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13995 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13996 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13997
13998tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13999
14000 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
14001 details about variables.
14002
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020014003
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014004tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
14005 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
14006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014007 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014008 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020014009 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
14010 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014011
14012 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
14013
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014014 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014015 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
14016 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020014017 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
14018 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014019
14020 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
14021
14022 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
14023 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
14024 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
14025 inserted.
14026
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014027 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
14028 supported:
14029 - accept
14030 - close
14031 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010014032 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014033 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
14034 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
14035 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
14036 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14037 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14038 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010014039 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014040 - set-log-level <level>
14041 - set-mark <mark>
14042 - set-nice <nice>
14043 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010014044 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
14045 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010014046 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014047 - unset-var(<var-name>)
14048
14049 The supported actions are described below.
14050
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014051 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
14052 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
14053 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
14054 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
14055 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
14056 a defaults section defining such rules.
14057
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014058 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
14059 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
14060 for changing the default action to a reject.
14061
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014062 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014063
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014064 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
14065 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
14066 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
14067 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
14068 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020014069
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014070 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014071
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014072 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020014073
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014074tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020014075
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014076 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
14077 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020014078
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014079tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020014080
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014081 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
14082 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
14083 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
14084 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
14085 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
14086 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014087
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014088tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020014089
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014090 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
14091 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014092
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010014093tcp-response content sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14094 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14095
14096 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
14097 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
14098 a complete description.
14099
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014100tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14101tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14102tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020014103
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014104 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
14105 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
14106 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
14107 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020014108
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014109tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14110 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14111tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14112 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014113
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014114 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
14115 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020014116 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020014117
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014118tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
14119 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014120
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014121 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
14122 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020014123
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020014124
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010014125tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
14126 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020014127
14128 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
14129 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
14130 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
14131
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014132tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014133
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014134 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
14135 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014136
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014137tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014138
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014139 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
14140 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
14141 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014142
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014143tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014144
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014145 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
14146 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014147
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014148tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020014149
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014150 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
14151 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
14152 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014153
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010014154tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14155tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014156
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014157 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
14158 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
14159 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014160
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010014161tcp-response content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014162
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014163 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
14164 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
14165 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
14166 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014167
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014168tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014169
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014170 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
14171 details about variables.
14172
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014173
14174tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
14175 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
14176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014177 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014178 Arguments :
14179 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14180 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14181 as explained at the top of this document.
14182
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014183 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
14184 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014185
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014186 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
14187
14188
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014189timeout check <timeout>
14190 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
14191 established.
14192
14193 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14194 yes | no | yes | yes
14195 Arguments:
14196 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14197 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14198 as explained at the top of this document.
14199
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014200 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014201 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014202 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014203 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010014204 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
14205 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
14206 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014207
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014208 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014209 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
14210
14211 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
14212 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010014213 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014214
14215 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14216 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14217 forget about it.
14218
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014219 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
14220 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
14221
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010014222 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
14223 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014224
14225
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014226timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014227 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
14228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14229 yes | yes | yes | no
14230 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014231 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014232 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14233 as explained at the top of this document.
14234
14235 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
14236 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
14237 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010014238 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
14239 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
14240 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
14241 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014242 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
14243 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
14244 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014245 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014246 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014247 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
14248 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014249 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
14250 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014251
14252 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
14253 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14254 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14255 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014256 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014257 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14258
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014259 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014260
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014261
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014262timeout client-fin <timeout>
14263 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
14264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14265 yes | yes | yes | no
14266 Arguments :
14267 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14268 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14269 as explained at the top of this document.
14270
14271 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
14272 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
14273 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
14274 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
14275 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
14276 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
14277 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010014278 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
14279 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
14280 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014281
14282 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
14283 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
14284 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
14285
14286 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
14287
14288
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014289timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014290 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
14291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14292 yes | no | yes | yes
14293 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014294 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014295 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14296 as explained at the top of this document.
14297
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014298 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014299 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014300 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014301 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014302 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
14303 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014304
14305 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14306 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14307 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14308 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014309 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014310 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14311
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014312 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014313
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014314
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014315timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
14316 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
14317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14318 yes | yes | yes | yes
14319 Arguments :
14320 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14321 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14322 as explained at the top of this document.
14323
14324 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
14325 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
14326 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
14327 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
14328 once the request has started to present itself.
14329
14330 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
14331 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
14332 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
14333 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
14334 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
14335
14336 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
14337 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
14338 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
14339 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
14340
14341 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
14342 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014343 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014344 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
14345 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014346 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014347
14348 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
14349 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
14350 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
14351 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
14352
14353 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
14354
14355
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014356timeout http-request <timeout>
14357 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
14358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020014359 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014360 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014361 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014362 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14363 as explained at the top of this document.
14364
14365 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
14366 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
14367 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
14368 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
14369 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
14370 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
14371 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020014372 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
14373 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
14374 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
14375 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014376 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014377 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
14378 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014379
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014380 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
14381 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
14382 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
14383 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
14384 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014385 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014386
14387 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
14388 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014389 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014390 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
14391 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
14392
14393 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020014394 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
14395 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
14396 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014397
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014398 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014399 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014400
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014401
14402timeout queue <timeout>
14403 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
14404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14405 yes | no | yes | yes
14406 Arguments :
14407 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14408 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14409 as explained at the top of this document.
14410
14411 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
14412 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
14413 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
14414 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
14415 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
14416
14417 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
14418 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
14419 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
14420 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
14421
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014422 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014423
14424
14425timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014426 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
14427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14428 yes | no | yes | yes
14429 Arguments :
14430 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14431 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14432 as explained at the top of this document.
14433
14434 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14435 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
14436 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
14437 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
14438 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
14439 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
14440 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
14441
14442 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14443 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14444 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
14445 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
14446 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014447 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014448 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014449 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
14450 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014451 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
14452 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014453
14454 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14455 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14456 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14457 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014458 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014459 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14460
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014461 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014462
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014463
14464timeout server-fin <timeout>
14465 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
14466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14467 yes | no | yes | yes
14468 Arguments :
14469 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14470 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14471 as explained at the top of this document.
14472
14473 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14474 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
14475 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
14476 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
14477 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
14478 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
14479 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
14480 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
14481 situations, it should not be needed.
14482
14483 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14484 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
14485 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
14486
14487 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
14488
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014489
14490timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014491 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14493 yes | yes | yes | yes
14494 Arguments :
14495 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
14496 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14497 as explained at the top of this document.
14498
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014499 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
14500 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
14501 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014502
14503 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14504 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14505 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
14506 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014507 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014508
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014509 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014510
14511
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014512timeout tunnel <timeout>
14513 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
14514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14515 yes | no | yes | yes
14516 Arguments :
14517 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14518 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14519 as explained at the top of this document.
14520
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014521 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014522 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
14523 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
14524 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014525 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
14526 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014527 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
14528 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
14529 specified.
14530
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014531 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
14532 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
14533 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
14534 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
14535 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
14536 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
14537 state.
14538
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014539 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14540 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14541 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
14542 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014543 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014544
14545 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14546 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14547 forget about it.
14548
14549 Example :
14550 defaults http
14551 option http-server-close
14552 timeout connect 5s
14553 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014554 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014555 timeout server 30s
14556 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
14557
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014558 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014559
14560
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014561transparent (deprecated)
14562 Enable client-side transparent proxying
14563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010014564 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014565 Arguments : none
14566
14567 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
14568 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
14569 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
14570 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
14571 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
14572 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
14573 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
14574 appropriate server.
14575
14576 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
14577
14578 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
14579 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
14580
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014581 See also: "option transparent"
14582
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014583unique-id-format <string>
14584 Generate a unique ID for each request.
14585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14586 yes | yes | yes | no
14587 Arguments :
14588 <string> is a log-format string.
14589
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014590 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
14591 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
14592 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
14593 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014594
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014595 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014596 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014597 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
14598 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
14599 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
14600 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
14601 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
14602 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014603
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014604 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
14605 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014606
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014607 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014608
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014609 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014610
14611 will generate:
14612
14613 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14614
14615 See also: "unique-id-header"
14616
14617unique-id-header <name>
14618 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
14619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14620 yes | yes | yes | no
14621 Arguments :
14622 <name> is the name of the header.
14623
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014624 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
14625 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014626
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014627 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014628
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014629 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014630 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
14631
14632 will generate:
14633
14634 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14635
14636 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014637
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014638use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014639 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14641 no | yes | yes | no
14642 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014643 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
14644 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014645
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014646 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
14647 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014648
14649 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
14650 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
14651 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014652 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014653 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014654 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
14655 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014656
14657 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
14658 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
14659 assign the backend.
14660
14661 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
14662 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14663 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
14664 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
14665 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
14666 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
14667
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014668 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014669 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014670 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
14671 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
14672 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
14673
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014674 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
14675 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
14676 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
14677 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
14678 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
14679 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
14680 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
14681 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
14682 cannot be forced from the request.
14683
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014684 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014685 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
14686 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
14687
14688 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
14689 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014690
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020014691use-fcgi-app <name>
14692 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
14693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14694 no | no | yes | yes
14695 Arguments :
14696 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
14697
14698 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014699
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014700use-server <server> if <condition>
14701use-server <server> unless <condition>
14702 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
14703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14704 no | no | yes | yes
14705 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014706 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
14707 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014708
14709 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
14710
14711 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
14712 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
14713 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
14714
14715 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
14716 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
14717 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
14718 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
14719 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
14720 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
14721 matches will assign the server.
14722
14723 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
14724 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
14725 with the next rules until one matches.
14726
14727 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
14728 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14729 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
14730 according to other persistence mechanisms.
14731
14732 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
14733 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
14734 stripped.
14735
14736 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
14737 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014738 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014739 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014740 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014741
14742 Example :
14743 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014744 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014745 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014746 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014747 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014748 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000014749 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014750 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
14751 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
14752
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014753 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
14754 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
14755 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
14756 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050014757 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014758 and we fall back to load balancing.
14759
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014760 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014761
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014762
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014764--------------------------
14765
14766The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
14767depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
14768settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
14769written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
14770described in this section.
14771
14772
147735.1. Bind options
14774-----------------
14775
14776The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
14777as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
14778no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
14779parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
14780while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
14781provided immediately after the setting name.
14782
14783The currently supported settings are the following ones.
14784
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014785accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
14786 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
14787 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
14788 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
14789 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
14790 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
14791 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
14792 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
14793 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
14794 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010014795 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
14796 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
14797 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014798
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014799accept-proxy
14800 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020014801 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
14802 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014803 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
14804 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
14805 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
14806 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014807 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014808 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
14809 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020014810 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
14811 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014812
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014813allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010014814 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014815 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014816 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014817 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
14818 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014819
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014820alpn <protocols>
14821 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14822 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14823 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014824 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014825 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020014826 initial NPN extension. At the protocol layer, ALPN is required to enable
14827 HTTP/2 on an HTTPS frontend and HTTP/3 on a QUIC frontend. However, when such
14828 frontends have none of "npn", "alpn" and "no-alpn" set, a default value of
14829 "h2,http/1.1" will be used for a regular HTTPS frontend, and "h3" for a QUIC
14830 frontend. Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only
14831 supposed the now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most
14832 browsers still support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may
14833 still work for a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. Protocols
14834 not advertised are not negotiated. For example it is possible to only accept
14835 HTTP/2 connections with this:
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014836
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020014837 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2 # explicitly disable HTTP/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014838
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020014839 QUIC supports only h3 and hq-interop as ALPN. h3 is for HTTP/3 and hq-interop
14840 is used for http/0.9 and QUIC interop runner (see https://interop.seemann.io).
Willy Tarreau74d7cc02023-04-19 09:10:47 +020014841 Each "alpn" statement will replace a previous one. In order to remove them,
14842 use "no-alpn".
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020014843
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020014844 Note that some old browsers such as Firefox 88 used to experience issues with
14845 WebSocket over H2, and in case such a setup is encountered, it may be needed
14846 to either explicitly disable HTTP/2 in the "alpn" string by forcing it to
14847 "http/1.1" or "no-alpn", or to enable "h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients"
14848 globally.
14849
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014850backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010014851 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014852 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
14853
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010014854curves <curves>
14855 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14856 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
14857 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
14858 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
14859 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
14860 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
14861
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014862ecdhe <named curve>
14863 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010014864 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
14865 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014866
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014867ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014868 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14869 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014870 client's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
14871 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020014872 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014873
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014874 Warning: The "@system-ca" parameter could be used in place of the cafile
14875 in order to use the trusted CAs of your system, like its done with the server
14876 directive. But you mustn't use it unless you know what you are doing.
14877 Configuring it this way basically mean that the bind will accept any client
14878 certificate generated from one of the CA present on your system, which is
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050014879 extremely insecure.
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014880
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014881ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
14882 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14883 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010014884 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
14885 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
14886 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
14887 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
14888 in new version of OpenSSL.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014889 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
14890 error is ignored.
14891
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014892ca-sign-file <cafile>
14893 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14894 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
14895 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
14896 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14897 'generate-certificates' for details.
14898
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000014899ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014900 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
14901 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
14902 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14903 'generate-certificates' for details.
14904
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014905ca-verify-file <cafile>
14906 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
14907 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
14908 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
14909 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
14910 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
14911
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014912ciphers <ciphers>
14913 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14914 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000014915 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014916 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014917 information and recommendations see e.g.
14918 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14919 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14920 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
14921
14922ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14923 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14924 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
14925 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
14926 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014927 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
14928 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014929
William Lallemandb6ae2aa2023-05-05 00:05:46 +020014930client-sigalgs <sigalgs>
14931 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14932 the string describing the list of signature algorithms related to client
14933 authentication that are negotiated . The format of the string is defined in
14934 "man 3 SSL_CTX_set1_client_sigalgs" from the OpenSSL man pages. It is not
14935 recommended to use this setting if no specific usecase was identified.
14936
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014937crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014938 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14939 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020014940 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
14941 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014942
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014943crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014944 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14945 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
14946 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
14947 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
14948 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010014949 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
14950 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014951
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010014952 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
14953 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
14954
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014955 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
14956 are loaded.
14957
14958 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010014959 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
William Lallemand589570d2022-05-09 10:30:51 +020014960 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). Files
14961 starting with a dot are also ignored. This directive may be specified multiple
14962 times in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
14963 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
14964 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
14965 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
14966 hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
William Lallemand5c099352023-04-04 16:28:58 +020014967 www.sub.example.org). If an empty directory is used, HAProxy will not start
14968 unless the "strict-sni" keyword is used.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014969
14970 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
14971 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
14972 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
14973 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010014974 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
14975 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014976
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020014977 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014978
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014979 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014980 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014981 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
14982 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014983 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
14984 clients).
14985
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014986 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014987 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
14988 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
14989 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
14990 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
14991 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
14992 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
14993 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
14994 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
14995 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
14996 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
14997 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
14998 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
14999
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015000 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010015001 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
15002 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
15003 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
15004 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
15005
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050015006 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
15007 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
15008 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
15009 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050015010
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020015011 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
15012 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
15013 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050015014
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020015015crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015016 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010015017 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
15018 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
15019 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
15020 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
15021 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
15022 in new version of OpenSSL.
15023 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
15024 error is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020015025
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015026crt-list <file>
15027 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015028 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
15029 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015030
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015031 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
15032
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020015033 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
15034 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
15035 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
15036 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
15037 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015038
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020015039 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030015040 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
15041 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
15042 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
15043 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
15044 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020015045 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
15046 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
15047 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015048
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020015049 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
15050 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
15051 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050015052
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020015053 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
15054
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030015055 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015056 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030015057 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
15058 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
15059 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
15060 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
15061 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
15062 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030015063
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020015064 When no ALPN is set, the "bind" line's default one is used. If a "bind" line
15065 has no "no-alpn", "alpn" nor "npn" set, a default value will be used
15066 depending on the protocol (see "alpn" above). However if the "bind" line has
15067 a different default, or explicitly disables ALPN using "no-alpn", it is
15068 possible to force a specific value for a certificate.
15069
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015070 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030015071 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020015072 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010015073 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015074 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010015075 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015076
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015077defer-accept
15078 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
15079 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
15080 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015081 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015082 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
15083 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
15084 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
15085 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
15086 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
15087 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
15088 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
15089
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020015090expose-fd listeners
15091 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
15092 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010015093 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
15094 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015095 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020015096
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015097force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015098 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015099 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015100 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015101 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015102
15103force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015104 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015105 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015106 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015107
15108force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015109 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015110 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015111 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015112
15113force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015114 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015115 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015116 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015117
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015118force-tlsv13
15119 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
15120 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015121 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015122
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020015123generate-certificates
15124 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15125 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
15126 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
15127 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
15128 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
15129 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
15130 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
15131 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
15132 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
15133 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
15134 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
15135
15136 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
15137 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015138 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020015139 certificate is used many times.
15140
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015141gid <gid>
15142 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
15143 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15144 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
15145 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
15146 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15147
15148group <group>
15149 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
15150 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
15151 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
15152 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
15153 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15154
15155id <id>
15156 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
15157 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
15158 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
15159 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
15160
15161interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010015162 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
15163 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
15164 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
15165 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
15166 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
15167 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010015168 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
15169 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
15170 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
15171 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
15172 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
15173 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015174
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015175level <level>
15176 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
15177 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
15178 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015179 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015180 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
15181 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
15182 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015183 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015184 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015185 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015186 all counters).
15187
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020015188severity-output <format>
15189 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
15190 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
15191 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
15192 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
15193 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
15194 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
15195 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
15196 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
15197 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
15198 rfc5424 convention.
15199
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015200maxconn <maxconn>
15201 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
15202 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
15203 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
15204 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
15205 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
15206 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
15207 eat all memory.
15208
15209mode <mode>
15210 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
15211 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
15212 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
15213 UNIX sockets.
15214
15215mss <maxseg>
15216 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
15217 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
15218 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
15219 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
15220 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
15221 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
15222 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
15223 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
15224 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
15225 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
15226 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
15227
15228name <name>
15229 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
15230 page.
15231
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020015232namespace <name>
15233 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
15234 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
15235 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
15236 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
15237
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015238nice <nice>
15239 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
15240 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
15241 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
15242 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
15243 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
15244 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
15245 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
15246 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
15247 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
15248 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
15249 one for an RDP socket.
15250
Willy Tarreau74d7cc02023-04-19 09:10:47 +020015251no-alpn
15252 Disables ALPN processing (technically speaking this sets the ALPN string to
15253 an empty string that will not be advertised). It permits to cancel a previous
15254 occurrence of an "alpn" setting and to disable application protocol
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020015255 negotiation. It may also be used to prevent a listener from negotiating ALPN
15256 with a client on an HTTPS or QUIC listener; by default, HTTPS listeners will
15257 advertise "h2,http/1.1" and QUIC listeners will advertise "h3". See also
15258 "alpn" bove. Note that when using "crt-list", a certificate may override the
15259 "alpn" setting and re-enable its processing.
Willy Tarreau74d7cc02023-04-19 09:10:47 +020015260
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020015261no-ca-names
15262 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15263 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010015264 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020015265
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015266no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015267 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015268 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015269 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015270 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015271 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
15272 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015273
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020015274no-tls-tickets
15275 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15276 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
15277 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015278 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
15279 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015280 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15281 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15282 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020015283
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015284no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015285 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015286 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015287 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015288 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015289 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15290 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015291
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015292no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015293 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015294 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015295 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015296 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015297 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15298 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015299
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015300no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015301 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015302 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015303 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015304 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015305 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15306 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015307
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015308no-tlsv13
15309 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15310 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
15311 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
15312 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015313 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15314 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015315
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020015316npn <protocols>
15317 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
15318 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
15319 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015320 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015321 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010015322 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
15323 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
15324 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
15325 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
15326 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020015327
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015328ocsp-update [ off | on ] (crt-list only)
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015329 Enable automatic OCSP response update when set to 'on', disable it otherwise.
15330 Its value defaults to 'off'.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015331 Please note that for now, this option can only be used in a crt-list line, it
15332 cannot be used directly on a bind line. It lies in this "Bind options"
15333 section because it is still a frontend option. This limitation was set so
15334 that the option applies to only one certificate at a time.
15335 If a given certificate is used in multiple crt-lists with different values of
15336 the 'ocsp-update' set, an error will be raised. Here is an example
15337 configuration enabling it:
15338
15339 haproxy.cfg:
15340 frontend fe
15341 bind :443 ssl crt-list haproxy.list
15342
15343 haproxy.list:
15344 server_cert.pem [ocsp-update on] foo.bar
15345
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015346 When the option is set to 'on', we will try to get an ocsp response whenever
15347 an ocsp uri is found in the frontend's certificate. The only limitation of
15348 this mode is that the certificate's issuer will have to be known in order for
15349 the OCSP certid to be built.
15350 Each OCSP response will be updated at least once an hour, and even more
15351 frequently if a given OCSP response has an expire date earlier than this one
15352 hour limit. A minimum update interval of 5 minutes will still exist in order
15353 to avoid updating too often responses that have a really short expire time or
15354 even no 'Next Update' at all. Because of this hard limit, please note that
15355 when auto update is set to 'on' or 'auto', any OCSP response loaded during
15356 init will not be updated until at least 5 minutes, even if its expire time
15357 ends before now+5m. This should not be too much of a hassle since an OCSP
15358 response must be valid when it gets loaded during init (its expire time must
15359 be in the future) so it is unlikely that this response expires in such a
15360 short time after init.
15361 On the other hand, if a certificate has an OCSP uri specified and no OCSP
15362 response, setting this option to 'on' for the given certificate will ensure
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015363 that the OCSP response gets fetched automatically right after init.
15364 The default minimum and maximum delays (5 minutes and 1 hour respectively)
15365 can be configured by the "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay" and
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +010015366 "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay" global options.
15367
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015368 Whenever an OCSP response is updated by the auto update task or following a
15369 call to the "update ssl ocsp-response" CLI command, a dedicated log line is
15370 emitted. It follows a dedicated log-format that contains the following header
15371 "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft" and is followed by specific OCSP-related information:
15372 - the path of the corresponding frontend certificate
15373 - a numerical update status
15374 - a textual update status
15375 - the number of update failures for the given response
15376 - the number of update successes for the givan response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb33fe2f2023-02-28 17:46:25 +010015377 See "show ssl ocsp-updates" CLI command for a full list of error codes and
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015378 error messages. This line is emitted regardless of the success or failure of
15379 the concerned OCSP response update.
15380 The OCSP request/response is sent and received through an http_client
15381 instance that has the dontlog-normal option set and that uses the regular
15382 HTTP log format in case of error (unreachable OCSP responder for instance).
15383 If such an error occurs, another log line that contains HTTP-related
15384 information will then be emitted alongside the "regular" OCSP one (which will
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5c24f902023-06-23 17:01:08 +020015385 likely have "HTTP error" as text status). But if a purely HTTP error happens
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015386 (unreachable OCSP responder for instance), an extra log line that follows the
15387 regular HTTP log-format will be emitted.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5c24f902023-06-23 17:01:08 +020015388 Here are two examples of such log lines, with a successful OCSP update log
15389 line first and then an example of an HTTP error with the two different lines
15390 (lines were spit and the URL was shortened for readability):
15391 <134>Mar 6 11:16:53 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:16:52.808] \
15392 <OCSP-UPDATE> /path_to_cert/foo.pem 1 "Update successful" 0 1
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015393
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5c24f902023-06-23 17:01:08 +020015394 <134>Mar 6 11:18:55 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:18:54.207] \
15395 <OCSP-UPDATE> /path_to_cert/bar.pem 2 "HTTP error" 1 0
15396 <134>Mar 6 11:18:55 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:18:52.200] \
15397 <OCSP-UPDATE> -/- 2/0/-1/-1/3009 503 217 - - SC-- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0 {} \
15398 "GET http://127.0.0.1:12345/MEMwQT HTTP/1.1"
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015399
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015400 Troubleshooting:
15401 A common error that can happen with let's encrypt certificates is if the DNS
15402 resolution provides an IPv6 address and your system does not have a valid
15403 outgoing IPv6 route. In such a case, you can either create the appropriate
15404 route or set the "httpclient.resolvers.prefer ipv4" option in the global
15405 section.
15406 In case of "OCSP response check failure" error, you might want to check that
15407 the issuer certificate that you provided is valid.
15408
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000015409prefer-client-ciphers
15410 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
15411 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
15412 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020015413 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
15414 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
15415 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000015416
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015417proto <name>
15418 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
15419 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
15420 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015421 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
15422 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15423
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015424 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15425 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15426 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015427
15428 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
15429 a bind line :
15430
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015431 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015432 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15433 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15434
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015435 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015436 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080015437 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015438 h2" on the bind line.
15439
Frédéric Lécaille43910a92022-07-11 10:24:21 +020015440quic-cc-algo [ cubic | newreno ]
Frédéric Lécaille43910a92022-07-11 10:24:21 +020015441 This is a QUIC specific setting to select the congestion control algorithm
15442 for any connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. They are similar
15443 to those used by TCP.
15444
15445 Default value: cubic
15446
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015447quic-force-retry
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015448 This is a QUIC specific setting which forces the use of the QUIC Retry feature
15449 for all the connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. It consists
15450 in veryfying the peers are able to receive packets at the transport address
15451 they used to initiate a new connection, sending them a Retry packet which
15452 contains a token. This token must be sent back to the Retry packet sender,
15453 this latter being the only one to be able to validate the token. Note that QUIC
15454 Retry will always be used even if a Retry threshold was set (see
Amaury Denoyelle996ca7d2022-11-14 16:17:13 +010015455 "tune.quic.retry-threshold" setting).
15456
15457 This setting requires the cluster secret to be set or else an error will be
15458 reported on startup (see "cluster-secret").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015459
15460 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
15461 information about QUIC retry.
15462
Willy Tarreaua07635e2023-04-13 17:25:43 +020015463shards <number> | by-thread | by-group
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020015464 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
15465 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
15466 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
15467 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
15468 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
15469 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
15470 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
15471 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
15472 little bit.
15473
15474 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
15475 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
15476 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
15477 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
15478 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
Willy Tarreaua07635e2023-04-13 17:25:43 +020015479 is an integral divisor of the number of threads. Alternately, the other
15480 special value "by-group" will create one shard per thread group. This can
15481 be useful when dealing with many threads and not wanting to create too many
15482 sockets. The load distribution will be a bit less optimal but the contention
15483 (especially in the system) will still be lower than with a single socket.
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020015484
Willy Tarreauc1fbdd62023-04-22 11:38:55 +020015485 On operating systems that do not support multiple sockets bound to the same
15486 address, "by-thread" and "by-group" will automatically fall back to a single
15487 shard. For "by-group" this is done without any warning since it doesn't
15488 change anything for a single group, and will result in sockets being
15489 duplicated for each group anyway. However, for "by-thread", a diagnostic
15490 warning will be emitted if this happens since the resulting number of
15491 listeners will not be the expected one.
15492
William Lallemand1d3c8222023-05-04 15:33:55 +020015493sigalgs <sigalgs>
15494 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
15495 the string describing the list of signature algorithms that are negotiated
15496 during the TLSv1.2 and TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined
15497 in "man 3 SSL_CTX_set1_sigalgs" from the OpenSSL man pages. It is not
15498 recommended to use this setting unless compatibility with a middlebox is
15499 required.
15500
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015501ssl
15502 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015503 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015504 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
15505 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020015506 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
15507 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015508
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015509ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15510 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015511 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
15512 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
15513 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015514 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15515
15516ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015517 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
15518 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
15519 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
15520 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015521
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010015522strict-sni
15523 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
15524 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
William Lallemand5c099352023-04-04 16:28:58 +020015525 a certificate. The default certificate is not used. This option also allows
15526 to start without any certificate on a bind line, so an empty directory could
15527 be used and filled later from the stats socket.
15528 See the "crt" option for more information. See "add ssl crt-list" command in
15529 the management guide.
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010015530
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015531tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015532 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015533 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015534 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015535 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015536 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
15537 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
15538 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
15539 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
15540 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
15541 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
15542 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15543
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015544tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010015545 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015546 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
15547 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
15548 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
15549 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
15550 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
15551 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
15552 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020015553 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
15554 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
15555 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015556
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015557thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>[,...]
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015558 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
15559 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
15560 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015561
15562 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
15563 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015564 It is also possible to designate a thread number using its relative number
15565 inside its thread group, by specifying the thread group number first, then a
15566 slash ('/') and the relative thread number(s). In this case thread numbers
15567 also start at 1 and end at 32 or 64 depending on the platform. When absolute
15568 thread numbers are specified, they will be automatically translated to
15569 relative numbers once thread groups are known. Usually, absolute numbers are
15570 preferred for simple configurations, and relative ones are preferred for
15571 complex configurations where CPU arrangement matters for performance.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015572
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015573 After the optional thread group number, the "thread-set" specification must
15574 use the following format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015575
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015576 "all" | "odd" | "even" | [number][-[number]]
15577
15578 As their names imply, "all" validates all threads within the set (either all
15579 of the group's when a group is specified, or all of the process' threads),
15580 "odd" validates all odd-numberred threads (every other thread starting at 1)
15581 either for the process or the group, and "even" validates all even-numberred
15582 threads (every other thread starting at 2). If instead thread number ranges
15583 are used, then all threads included in the range from the first to the last
15584 thread number are validated. The numbers are either relative to the group
Willy Tarreau7fd87562023-02-28 08:19:37 +010015585 or absolute depending on the presence of a thread group number. If the first
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015586 thread number is omitted, "1" is used, representing either the first thread
15587 of the group or the first thread of the process. If the last thread number is
15588 omitted, either the last thread number of the group (32 or 64) is used, or
15589 the last thread number of the process (global.nbthread).
15590
15591 These ranges may be repeated and delimited by a comma, so that non-contiguous
15592 thread sets can be specified, and the group, if present, must be specified
15593 again for each new range. Note that it is not permitted to mix group-relative
15594 and absolute specifications because the whole "bind" line must use either
15595 an absolute notation or a relative one, as those not set will be resolved at
15596 the end of the parsing.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015597
Willy Tarreau09b52d12023-02-27 16:42:32 +010015598 It is important to know that each listener described by a "bind" line creates
15599 at least one socket represented by at least one file descriptor. Since file
15600 descriptors cannot span multiple thread groups, if a "bind" line specifies a
15601 thread range that covers more than one group, several file descriptors will
15602 automatically be created so that there is at least one per group. Technically
15603 speaking they all refer to the same socket in the kernel, but they will get a
15604 distinct identifier in haproxy and will even have a dedicated stats entry if
15605 "option socket-stats" is used.
15606
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015607 The main purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but
15608 not the same thread in a listener, so that the system can distribute the
15609 incoming connections into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue
15610 load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau09b52d12023-02-27 16:42:32 +010015611 See also the "shards" keyword above that automates duplication of "bind"
15612 lines and their assignment to multiple groups of threads.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015613
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015614tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
15615 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010015616 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
15617 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
15618 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
15619 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
15620 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
15621 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
15622 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
15623 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
15624 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
15625 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015626 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
15627 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
15628
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015629transparent
15630 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
15631 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
15632 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
15633 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
15634 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
15635 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
15636 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
15637 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
15638 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
15639 so check for support with your vendor.
15640
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015641v4v6
15642 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15643 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
15644 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
15645 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015646 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015647
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015648v6only
15649 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15650 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
15651 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015652 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
15653 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015654
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015655uid <uid>
15656 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
15657 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15658 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
15659 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
15660 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15661
15662user <user>
15663 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
15664 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15665 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
15666 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
15667 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15668
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015669verify [none|optional|required]
15670 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
15671 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
15672 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
15673 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
15674 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020015675 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
15676 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
15677 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
15678 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020015679
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200156805.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010015681------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015682
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015683The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
15684which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
15685arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
15686settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
15687after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
15688Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
15689address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015691 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015692 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015693
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015694Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
15695keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
15696
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015697The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015698
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015699addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015700 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010015701 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15702 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
15703 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
15704 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
15705 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015706
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015707agent-check
15708 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015709 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010015710 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
15711 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
15712 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015713
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015714 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015715 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015716 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020015717 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
15718 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015719
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015720 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
15721 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
15722 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
15723 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
15724 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020015725
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015726 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015727 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015728
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015729 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15730 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
15731 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015732
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015733 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15734 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
15735 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015736
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020015737 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015738 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
15739 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
15740 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
15741 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015742 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015743 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015744
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015745 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
15746 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015747
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015748 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
15749 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
15750 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
15751 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
15752 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
15753 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
15754 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
15755 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
15756 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015757
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015758 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
15759 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015760 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
15761 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
15762 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010015763 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015764
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015765 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015766 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015767
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015768agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015769 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015770 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
15771 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
15772 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
15773 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
15774
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015775agent-inter <delay>
15776 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
15777 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15778
15779 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
15780 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
15781 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
15782 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
15783 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15784 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15785 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15786 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15787 of backends use the same servers.
15788
15789 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
15790
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015791agent-addr <addr>
15792 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
15793
15794 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015795 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015796 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
15797 hostname, it will be resolved.
15798
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015799agent-port <port>
15800 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
15801
15802 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
15803
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015804allow-0rtt
15805 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020015806 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
15807 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015808
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015809alpn <protocols>
15810 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
15811 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
15812 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015813 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015814 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
15815 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
15816 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
15817 now obsolete NPN extension.
15818 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
15819 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
15820
15821 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
15822
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015823 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
15824
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015825backup
15826 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
15827 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
15828 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
15829 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015830 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
15831 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015832
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015833ca-file <cafile>
15834 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15835 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015836 server's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
15837 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020015838 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015839
15840 In order to use the trusted CAs of your system, the "@system-ca" parameter
15841 could be used in place of the cafile. The location of this directory could be
15842 overwritten by setting the SSL_CERT_DIR environment variable.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015843
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015844check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015845 This option enables health checks on a server:
15846 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
15847 considered available.
15848 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
15849 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
15850 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
15851 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
15852 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015853 set. This behavior is slightly different for dynamic servers, read the
15854 following paragraphs for more details.
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015855 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
15856 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
15857 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
15858 exchanges succeed.
15859
15860 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
15861 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
15862 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
15863 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
15864 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050015865 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015866 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
15867
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015868 Note that the implicit configuration of ssl and PROXY protocol is not
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +020015869 performed for dynamic servers. In this case, it is required to explicitly
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015870 use "check-ssl" and "check-send-proxy" when wanted, even if the check port is
15871 not overridden.
15872
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015873 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
15874 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
15875
15876 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
15877 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
15878
15879 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
15880 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
15881 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
15882 available.
15883
15884 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
15885 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
15886 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
15887
15888 Example:
15889 # simple tcp check
15890 backend foo
15891 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
15892 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
15893 backend foo
15894 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
15895 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
15896 backend foo
15897 option tcp-check
15898 tcp-check connect
15899 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015900
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020015901check-send-proxy
15902 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
15903 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
15904 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
15905 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
15906 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
15907 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
15908 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
15909
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010015910check-alpn <protocols>
15911 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
15912 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
15913 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
15914
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020015915check-proto <name>
15916 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
15917 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
15918 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015919 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
15920 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15921
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015922 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15923 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15924 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015925
15926 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
15927 directive on a server line:
15928
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015929 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015930 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15931 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15932 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15933
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015934 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020015935 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
15936 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
15937
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010015938check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020015939 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010015940 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
15941 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020015942
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015943check-ssl
15944 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
15945 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
15946 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
15947 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015948 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015949 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
15950 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015951 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015952 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
15953 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015954
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015955check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015956 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015957 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
15958 for normal traffic.
15959
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015960ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015961 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
15962 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
15963 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000015964 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
15965 information and recommendations see e.g.
15966 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
15967 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
15968 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015969
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015970ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
15971 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
15972 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
15973 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
15974 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000015975 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
15976 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
15977 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015979cookie <value>
15980 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
15981 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
15982 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
15983 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
15984 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
15985 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
15986 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
15987
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015988crl-file <crlfile>
15989 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15990 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
15991 to verify server's certificate.
15992
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020015993crt <cert>
15994 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
15995 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
15996 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
15997 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
15998 certificate request.
15999
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020016000 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
16001 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
16002 option is set accordingly).
16003
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020016004disabled
16005 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
16006 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
16007 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
16008 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
16009 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016010 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020016011
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016012enabled
16013 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
16014 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
16015 default value.
16016 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
16017 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020016018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016019error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010016020 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
16021 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
16022 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016023
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016024 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016025
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016026fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016027 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
16028 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
16029 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
16030
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016031force-sslv3
16032 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
16033 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016034 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016035 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016036
16037force-tlsv10
16038 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016039 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016040 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016041
16042force-tlsv11
16043 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016044 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016045 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016046
16047force-tlsv12
16048 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016049 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016050 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016051
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020016052force-tlsv13
16053 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
16054 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016055 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020016056
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016057id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020016058 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
16059 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
16060 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016061
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016062init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
16063 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
16064 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016065 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016066 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
16067 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
16068 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
16069 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
16070 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
16071 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
16072 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
16073 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
16074 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016075 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016076 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
16077 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
16078 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
16079 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
16080 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
16081 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016082 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016083
16084 Example:
16085 defaults
16086 # never fail on address resolution
16087 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
16088
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016089inter <delay>
16090fastinter <delay>
16091downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016092 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
16093 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
16094 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
16095 between checks depending on the server state :
16096
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020016097 Server state | Interval used
16098 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
16099 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
16100 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
16101 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
16102 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
16103 or yet unchecked. |
16104 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
16105 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
16106 | "inter" otherwise.
16107 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016108
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016109 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
16110 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
16111 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
16112 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090016113 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
16114 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
16115 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
16116 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
16117 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016118
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020016119log-proto <logproto>
16120 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
16121 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
16122 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
16123 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
16124
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016125maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016126 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
16127 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010016128 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
16129 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016130 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
16131 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
16132 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
16133 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
16134
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010016135 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
16136 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
16137 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
16138 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
16139 than 50 concurrent requests.
16140
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016141maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016142 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
16143 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
16144 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
16145 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020016146 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
16147 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
16148 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
16149 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
16150 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
16151 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
16152 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016153
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010016154max-reuse <count>
16155 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
16156 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
16157 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
16158 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
16159 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
16160 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
16161 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
16162 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
16163
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016164minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016165 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
16166 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
16167 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
16168 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
16169 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
16170 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016171 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016172 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016173
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020016174namespace <name>
16175 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
16176 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
16177 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
16178 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
16179
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016180no-agent-check
16181 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
16182 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16183 default value.
16184 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16185 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
16186
16187no-backup
16188 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
16189 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16190 default value.
16191 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16192 "default-server" "backup" setting.
16193
16194no-check
16195 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
16196 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16197 default value.
16198 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16199 "default-server" "check" setting.
16200
16201no-check-ssl
16202 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
16203 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16204 default value.
16205 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16206 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
16207
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016208no-send-proxy
16209 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
16210 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16211 default value.
16212 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16213 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
16214
16215no-send-proxy-v2
16216 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
16217 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16218 default value.
16219 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16220 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
16221
16222no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
16223 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
16224 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16225 default value.
16226 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16227 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
16228
16229no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
16230 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
16231 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16232 default value.
16233 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16234 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
16235
16236no-ssl
16237 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
16238 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16239 default value.
16240 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16241 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
16242
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010016243 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
16244 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
16245 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
16246
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010016247no-ssl-reuse
16248 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
16249 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
16250 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
16251 and for paranoid users.
16252
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016253no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016254 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
16255 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016256 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016257
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016258 Supported in default-server: No
16259
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020016260no-tls-tickets
16261 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
16262 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
16263 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016264 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
16265 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010016266 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
16267 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
16268 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016269 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020016270
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016271no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016272 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020016273 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16274 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016275 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16276 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016277 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016278
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016279 Supported in default-server: No
16280
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016281no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016282 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020016283 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16284 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016285 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16286 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016287 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016288
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016289 Supported in default-server: No
16290
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016291no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016292 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016293 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16294 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016295 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16296 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016297 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020016298
16299 Supported in default-server: No
16300
16301no-tlsv13
16302 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
16303 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16304 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
16305 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16306 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016307 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016308
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016309 Supported in default-server: No
16310
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016311no-verifyhost
16312 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
16313 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16314 default value.
16315 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16316 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016317
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020016318no-tfo
16319 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
16320 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16321 default value.
16322 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16323 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
16324
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090016325non-stick
16326 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
16327 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
16328 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
16329
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010016330npn <protocols>
16331 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
16332 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
16333 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016334 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010016335 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
16336 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
16337 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
16338
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016339observe <mode>
16340 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
16341 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
16342 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
16343 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
16344 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
16345 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010016346 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016347
16348 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
16349
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016350on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016351 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
16352 Currently, four modes are available:
16353 - fastinter: force fastinter
16354 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
16355 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
16356 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
16357 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
16358
16359 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
16360
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090016361on-marked-down <action>
16362 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
16363 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016364 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
16365 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
16366 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
16367 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
16368 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
16369 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
16370 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
16371 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090016372
16373 Actions are disabled by default
16374
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016375on-marked-up <action>
16376 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
16377 Currently one action is available:
16378 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
16379 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
16380 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
16381 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016382 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
16383 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016384 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
16385 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
16386
16387 Actions are disabled by default
16388
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020016389pool-low-conn <max>
16390 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
16391 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
16392 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
16393 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
16394 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
16395 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
16396 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
16397 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
16398 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
16399 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010016400 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
16401 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
16402 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
16403 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020016404
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010016405pool-max-conn <max>
16406 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
16407 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
16408 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
16409 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
16410 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
16411 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
16412
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010016413pool-purge-delay <delay>
16414 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010016415 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020016416 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010016417
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016418port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016419 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010016420 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
16421 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
16422 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
16423 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
16424 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016425
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016426proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016427 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
16428 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
16429 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016430 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
16431 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
16432
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016433 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
16434 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
16435 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016436
16437 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
16438 a server line :
16439
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016440 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016441 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
16442 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
16443 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
16444
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016445 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016446 protocol for all connections established to this server.
16447
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016448 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
16449
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016450redir <prefix>
16451 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
16452 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
16453 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
16454 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
16455 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
16456 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
16457 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
16458 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016459 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016460 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016461 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
16462 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
16463 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
16464 loop between the client and HAProxy!
16465
16466 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
16467
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016468rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016469 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
16470 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
16471 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
16472
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020016473resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
16474 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
16475 server.
16476
16477 Available options:
16478
16479 * allow-dup-ip
16480 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
16481 resolution at runtime is in operation.
16482 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
16483 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
16484 For such case, simply enable this option.
16485 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
16486
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050016487 * ignore-weight
16488 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
16489 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
16490 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
16491
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020016492 * prevent-dup-ip
16493 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
16494 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
16495 same fqdn.
16496 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
16497
16498 Example:
16499 backend b_myapp
16500 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
16501 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
16502 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
16503
16504 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
16505 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
16506 it
16507 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
16508 different address
16509
16510 Default value: not set
16511
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016512resolve-prefer <family>
16513 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
16514 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
16515 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
16516 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
16517
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020016518 Default value: ipv6
16519
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016520 Example:
16521
16522 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016523
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016524resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016525 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016526 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016527 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016528 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
16529 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016530 configured network, another address is selected.
16531
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016532 Example:
16533
16534 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016535
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016536resolvers <id>
16537 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
16538 hostname.
16539
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016540 Example:
16541
16542 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016543
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016544 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016545
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016546send-proxy
16547 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
16548 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
16549 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
16550 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016551 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
16552 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
16553 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
16554 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016555 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016556 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
16557 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
16558 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
16559 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
16560 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016561 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
16562 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016563
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016564send-proxy-v2
16565 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
16566 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16567 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16568 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020016569 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
16570 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
16571 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
16572 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016573
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016574proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010016575 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
16576 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
16577
16578 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
16579 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
16580 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
16581 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
16582 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
16583 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
16584 connection is supported).
16585 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
16586 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
16587 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
16588 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
16589 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
16590 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
16591 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016592
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016593send-proxy-v2-ssl
16594 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16595 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16596 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16597 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16598 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16599 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
16600 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016601 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
16602 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016603
16604send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
16605 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16606 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16607 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16608 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16609 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16610 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
16611 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
16612 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016613 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
16614 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016615
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +020016616shard <shard>
16617 This parameter in used only in the context of stick-tables synchronisation
16618 with peers protocol. The "shard" parameter identifies the peers which will
16619 receive all the stick-table updates for keys with this shard as distribution
16620 hash. The accepted values are 0 up to "shards" parameter value specified in
16621 the "peers" section. 0 value is the default value meaning that the peer will
16622 receive all the key updates. Greater values than "shards" will be ignored.
16623 This is also the case for any value provided to the local peer.
16624
16625 Example :
16626
16627 peers mypeers
16628 shards 3
16629 peer A 127.0.0.1:40001 # local peer without shard value (0 internally)
16630 peer B 127.0.0.1:40002 shard 1
16631 peer C 127.0.0.1:40003 shard 2
16632 peer D 127.0.0.1:40004 shard 3
16633
16634
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016635slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016636 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
16637 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
16638 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
16639 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
16640 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
16641 parameters :
16642
16643 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
16644 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
16645
16646 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
16647 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
16648 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
16649 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
16650
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016651 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016652 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
16653 seen as failed.
16654
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016655sni <expression>
16656 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
16657 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
16658 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010016659 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
16660 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
16661 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
16662 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020016663 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016664 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010016665 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
16666 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016667
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016668source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020016669source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016670source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016671 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
16672 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
16673 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
16674 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
16675
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016676 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
16677 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
16678 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
16679 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
16680 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
16681 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
16682 server.
16683
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000016684 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
16685 specifying the source address without port(s).
16686
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016687ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020016688 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
16689 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
16690 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
16691 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
16692 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
16693 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016694 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
16695 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016696
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016697ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16698 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
16699 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16700 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
16701
16702ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16703 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
16704 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16705 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
16706
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016707ssl-reuse
16708 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
16709 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16710 default value.
16711 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16712 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
16713
16714stick
16715 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
16716 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16717 default value.
16718 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16719 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016720
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016721socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016722 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016723 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
16724 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
16725
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016726tcp-ut <delay>
16727 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016728 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016729 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016730 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016731 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
16732 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
16733 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
16734 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
16735 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
16736 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
16737 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
16738 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
16739 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
16740
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016741tfo
16742 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
16743 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
16744 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
16745 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016746 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020016747 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016748
Willy Tarreaue54afdc2023-11-10 16:26:32 +010016749track [<backend>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020016750 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
16751 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
16752 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
Willy Tarreaue54afdc2023-11-10 16:26:32 +010016753 enabled. If <backend> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016754 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
16755
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016756tls-tickets
16757 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
16758 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16759 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010016760 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
16761 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
16762 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016763 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010016764 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016765
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016766verify [none|required]
16767 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010016768 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016769 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
16770 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016771 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016772 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
16773 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
16774 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
16775 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
16776 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
16777 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
16778 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
16779 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016780
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016781verifyhost <hostname>
16782 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016783 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
16784 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
16785 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
16786 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
16787 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
16788 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
16789 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
16790 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016791
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016792weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016793 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
16794 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
16795 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020016796 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
16797 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
16798 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
16799 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
16800 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
16801 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016802
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016803ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
16804 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
16805 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
16806 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
16807
16808 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
16809 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
16810 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
16811 server ALPN contains it.
16812
16813 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
16814 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
16815 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
16816 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
16817
16818 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
16819 favor of the ALPN extension.
16820
16821 See also "alpn" and "proto".
16822
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016823
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200168245.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
16825-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016826
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016827HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
16828using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070016829configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016830This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
16831can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
16832workload.
16833This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
16834resolution at run time.
16835Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
16836carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
16837
16838
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200168395.3.1. Global overview
16840----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016841
16842As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
16843different steps of the process life:
16844
16845 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
16846 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
16847 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
16848
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016849 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
16850 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016851
16852A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
16853 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
16854 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
16855 resolution to know this new IP.
16856
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016857When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016858HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016859SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
16860from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016861will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016862will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020016863
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016864A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016865 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016866 first valid response.
16867
16868 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
16869 servers return an error.
16870
16871
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200168725.3.2. The resolvers section
16873----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016874
16875This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016876HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
16877contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016878
William Lallemandc33df2e2022-05-06 17:14:00 +020016879At startup, HAProxy tries to generate a resolvers section named "default", if
16880no section was named this way in the configuration. This section is used by
16881default by the httpclient and uses the parse-resolv-conf keyword. If HAProxy
16882failed to generate automatically this section, no error or warning are emitted.
16883
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016884When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
16885uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
16886is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
16887answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
16888
16889When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016890used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016891
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016892 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
16893 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
16894 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016895
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016896 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
16897 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016898
Thierry Fournier55c40ea2021-12-15 19:03:52 +010016899 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016900 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
16901 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016902
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016903For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
16904following scenarios are possible:
16905
16906 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
16907 ignored
16908
16909 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
16910 applied
16911
16912 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
16913 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
16914
16915 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
16916 retries the query with a new type
16917
16918 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
16919 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016920
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016921As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016922a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016923<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016924
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016925
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016926resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016927 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016928
16929A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
16930
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020016931accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016932 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016933 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020016934 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
16935 by RFC 6891)
16936
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010016937 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
16938 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
16939 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
16940 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
16941 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
16942 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020016943
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020016944nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
16945 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
16946 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
16947 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
16948 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
16949 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
16950 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
16951 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
16952 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
16953 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010016954 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
16955
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060016956parse-resolv-conf
16957 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
16958 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
16959 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
16960
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016961hold <status> <period>
Christopher Faulet24b319b2023-02-27 17:53:31 +010016962 Upon receiving the DNS response <status>, determines whether a server's state
16963 should change from UP to DOWN. To make that determination, it checks whether
16964 any valid status has been received during the past <period> in order to
16965 counteract the just received invalid status.
16966
16967 <status> : last name resolution status.
16968 nx After receiving an NXDOMAIN status, check for any valid
16969 status during the concluding period.
16970
16971 refused After receiving a REFUSED status, check for any valid
16972 status during the concluding period.
16973
16974 timeout After the "timeout retry" has struck, check for any
16975 valid status during the concluding period.
16976
16977 other After receiving any other invalid status, check for any
16978 valid status during the concluding period.
16979
16980 valid Applies only to "http-request do-resolve" and
16981 "tcp-request content do-resolve" actions. It defines the
16982 period for which the server will maintain a valid response
16983 before triggering another resolution. It does not affect
16984 dynamic resolution of servers.
16985
16986 obsolete Defines how long to wait before removing obsolete DNS
16987 records after an updated answer record is received. It
16988 applies to SRV records.
16989
16990 <period> : Amount of time into the past during which a valid response must
16991 have been received. It follows the HAProxy time format and is in
16992 milliseconds by default.
16993
16994 For a server that relies on dynamic DNS resolution to determine its IP
16995 address, receiving an invalid DNS response, such as NXDOMAIN, will lead to
16996 changing the server's state from UP to DOWN. The hold directives define how
16997 far into the past to look for a valid response. If a valid response has been
16998 received within <period>, the just received invalid status will be ignored.
16999
17000 Unless a valid response has been receiving during the concluding period, the
17001 server will be marked as DOWN. For example, if "hold nx 30s" is set and the
17002 last received DNS response was NXDOMAIN, the server will be marked DOWN
17003 unless a valid response has been received during the last 30 seconds.
17004
17005 A server in the DOWN state will be marked UP immediately upon receiving a
17006 valid status from the DNS server.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017007
Christopher Faulet24b319b2023-02-27 17:53:31 +010017008 A separate behavior exists for "hold valid" and "hold obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017009
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017010resolve_retries <nb>
17011 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
17012 giving up.
17013 Default value: 3
17014
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017015 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
17016 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
17017 type.
17018
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017019timeout <event> <time>
17020 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
17021 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
17022 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017023 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
17024 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017025 Default value: 1s
17026 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017027 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017028 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017029 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
17030 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
17031
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020017032 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017033
17034 resolvers mydns
17035 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
17036 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020017037 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060017038 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017039 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017040 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017041 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010017042 hold other 30s
17043 hold refused 30s
17044 hold nx 30s
17045 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017046 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020017047 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017048
17049
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200170506. Cache
17051---------
17052
17053HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17054(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17055RAM.
17056
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020017057The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
17058blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017059
17060If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17061independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17062when we try to allocate a new one.
17063
17064The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
17065
17066It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17067"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17068for more details.
17069
17070When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17071replaced by "<CACHE>".
17072
17073
170746.1. Limitation
17075----------------
17076
17077The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17078
17079- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010017080- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
17081 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
17082 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017083- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
17084- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010017085- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
17086 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
17087 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010017088- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
17089 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010017090- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
17091 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
17092 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017093
17094- If the request is not a GET
17095- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
17096- If the request contains an Authorization header
17097
17098
170996.2. Setup
17100-----------
17101
17102To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17103the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17104
17105
171066.2.1. Cache section
17107---------------------
17108
17109cache <name>
17110 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17111 size of cache is mandatory.
17112
17113total-max-size <megabytes>
17114 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
17115 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
17116
17117max-object-size <bytes>
17118 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
17119 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
17120 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
17121
17122max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010017123 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017124 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17125 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17126 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17127 default.
17128
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010017129process-vary <on/off>
17130 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010017131 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
17132 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
17133 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010017134 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010017135
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010017136max-secondary-entries <number>
17137 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
17138 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
17139 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
17140
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017141
171426.2.2. Proxy section
17143---------------------
17144
17145http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
17146 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17147 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17148 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17149 after this one.
17150
17151http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
17152 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17153 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17154 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17155 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17156
17157
17158Example:
17159
17160 backend bck1
17161 mode http
17162
17163 http-request cache-use foobar
17164 http-response cache-store foobar
17165 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17166
17167 cache foobar
17168 total-max-size 4
17169 max-age 240
17170
17171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200171727. Using ACLs and fetching samples
17173----------------------------------
17174
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017175HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017176client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
17177The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
17178these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
17179but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
17180data called patterns.
17181
17182
171837.1. ACL basics
17184---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017185
17186The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
17187content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
17188from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
17189simple :
17190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017191 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017192 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017193 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
17194 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017196The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
17197adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017198
17199In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
17200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017201 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017202
17203This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
17204Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
17205and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017206an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
17207conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
17208as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
17209are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017210
17211ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
17212'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
17213which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
17214
17215There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
17216performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
17217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017218The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
17219specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
17220this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017221methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
17222ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017223
17224Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
17225 - boolean
17226 - integer (signed or unsigned)
17227 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
17228 - string
17229 - data block
17230
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017231Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
17232converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
17233would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
17234The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
17235which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
17236
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017237Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
17238keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
17239fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
17240which are summarized in the table below :
17241
17242 +---------------------+-----------------+
17243 | Sample or converter | Default |
17244 | output type | matching method |
17245 +---------------------+-----------------+
17246 | boolean | bool |
17247 +---------------------+-----------------+
17248 | integer | int |
17249 +---------------------+-----------------+
17250 | ip | ip |
17251 +---------------------+-----------------+
17252 | string | str |
17253 +---------------------+-----------------+
17254 | binary | none, use "-m" |
17255 +---------------------+-----------------+
17256
17257Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
17258matching method, see below.
17259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017260The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
17261 - boolean
17262 - integer or integer range
17263 - IP address / network
17264 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
17265 - regular expression
17266 - hex block
17267
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017268The following ACL flags are currently supported :
17269
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017270 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
17271 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017272 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010017273 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010017274 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010017275 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017276 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
17277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017278The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
17279read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
17280if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
17281lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
17282will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
17283beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017284a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017285lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
17286exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
17287
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010017288The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
17289parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
17290ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
17291a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
17292check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
17293
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010017294The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
17295socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
17296file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
17297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017298Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
17299loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
17300
17301 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
17302
17303In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
17304the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
17305case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
17306as well.
17307
17308The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
17309sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
17310do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
17311methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
17312is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017313obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017314followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
17315default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
17316that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
17317string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
17318
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010017319The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
17320By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
17321string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
17322resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017323server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017324waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010017325flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
17326function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
17327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017328There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
17329sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
17330be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017331
17332 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
17333 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017334 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
17335 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
17336 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
17337 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017338
17339 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
17340 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017341 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017342
17343 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017344 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017345
17346 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017347 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017348
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017349 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017350 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
17351
17352 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
17353 binary or string samples.
17354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017355 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
17356 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017358 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
17359 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
17360 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017362 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
17363 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017365 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
17366 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017368 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
17369 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017371 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
17372 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017373 This may be used with binary or string samples.
17374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017375 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
17376 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
17377 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017378
17379For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
17380request, it is possible to do :
17381
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017382 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017383
17384In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
17385buffer, one would use the following acl :
17386
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017387 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017388
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017389On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
17390possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
17391
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017392 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017394All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
17395criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
17396method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreau4f4fea42022-11-25 10:49:41 +010017397to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
17398usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
17399converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
17400method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
17401matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017402criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
17403the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017405If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017406the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
17407For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017409 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
17410 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
17411 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
17412 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017413
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017414
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017415The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
17416types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
17417combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
17418brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
17419default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017421 +-------------------------------------------------+
17422 | Input sample type |
17423 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017424 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017425 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
17426 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
17427 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017428 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017429 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017430 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017431 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017432 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017433 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017434 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017435 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017436 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017437 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017438 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017439 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017440 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017441 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017442 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017443 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017444 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017445 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017446 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017447 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017448 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017449 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
17450 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
17451 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017452
17453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200174547.1.1. Matching booleans
17455------------------------
17456
17457In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
17458Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
17459When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
17460that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
17461
17462Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
17463return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
17464"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
17465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200174677.1.2. Matching integers
17468------------------------
17469
17470Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
17471enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
17472to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
17473
17474Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
17475matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
17476lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017477
17478For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
17479unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
17480representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
17481
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017482As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
17483two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
17484instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
17485ranges and operators.
17486
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017487For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017488operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
17489Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
17490of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017491
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017492Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017493
17494 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
17495 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
17496 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
17497 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
17498 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
17499
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017500For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017501
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017502 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017503
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017504This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
17505
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017506 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017507
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200175097.1.3. Matching strings
17510-----------------------
17511
17512String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
17513different forms :
17514
17515 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017516 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017517
17518 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017519 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017520
17521 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
17522 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
17523
17524 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
17525 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
17526
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010017527 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
17528 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
17529 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
17530 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
17531 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
17532 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017533
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010017534 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
17535 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
17536 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
17537 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
17538 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
17539 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
17540 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
17541 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
17542 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
17543 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
17544 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017545
17546String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
17547exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
17548characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
17549string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
17550to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017551before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017552
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010017553Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
17554(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
17555Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
17556
17557Example:
17558 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
17559 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
17560
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200175627.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
17563---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017564
17565Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
17566they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
17567possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
17568passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
17569the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017570the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
17571match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017572
17573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200175747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
17575-------------------------------------
17576
17577It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
17578not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
17579a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
17580to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
17581digits may be used upper or lower case.
17582
17583Example :
17584 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017585 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017586
17587
175887.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
17589---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017590
17591IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
17592netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
17593within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010017594host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017595difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
17596at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
17597does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
17598parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017599
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020017600The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
17601abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
17602
17603 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17604 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
17605 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17606 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
17607 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
17608 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
17609 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
17610 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17611
17612Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
17613192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
17614
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020017615IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
17616Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
17617trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
17618IPv6 patterns.
17619
17620HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
17621following situations :
17622 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
17623 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
17624 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
17625 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
17626 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
17627 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
17628 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
17629 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
17630 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
17631 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
17632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017633
176347.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
17635----------------------------------
17636
17637Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
17638combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
17639
17640 - AND (implicit)
17641 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
17642 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017644A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017646 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017648Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
17649indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017651For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
17652"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
17653requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
17654is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
17655
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017656 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017657 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
17658 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
17659 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017660
17661To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
17662and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
17663
17664 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
17665 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
17666 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
17667 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
17668
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017669 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017670 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
17671 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
17672 use_backend www if host_www
17673
17674It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
17675expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
17676be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
17677the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
17678
17679 The following rule :
17680
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017681 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017682 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017683
17684 Can also be written that way :
17685
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017686 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017687
17688It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
17689to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
17690simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
17691sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
17692good use is the following :
17693
17694 With named ACLs :
17695
17696 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
17697 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
17698 monitor fail if site_dead
17699
17700 With anonymous ACLs :
17701
17702 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
17703
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017704See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
17705keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017706
17707
177087.3. Fetching samples
17709---------------------
17710
17711Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
17712against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
17713sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
17714ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
17715of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
17716available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
17717
17718This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
17719Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
17720compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
17721deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
17722
17723The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
17724matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
17725method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
17726indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
17727
17728As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
17729when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
17730mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
17731the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
17732ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
17733
17734Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
17735multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
17736when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017737incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
17738are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017739is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
17740all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
17741
17742Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
17743 - name
17744 - name(arg1)
17745 - name(arg1,arg2)
17746
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017747
177487.3.1. Converters
17749-----------------
17750
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017751Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
17752of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
17753is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
17754was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017755has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017756unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
17757
17758These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
17759sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
17760the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017761support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017762
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017763A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
17764support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
17765supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
17766(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
17767bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
17768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017769The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017770
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001777151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
17772 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17773 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17774 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
17775 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17776 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17777
17778 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017779 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
17780 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000017781 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
17782 frontend http-in
17783 bind *:8081
17784 default_backend servers
17785 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17786 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17787
Aurelien DARRAGON5c6f86f2022-12-30 16:23:08 +010017788rfc7239_is_valid
17789 Returns true if input header is RFC 7239 compliant header value and false
17790 otherwise.
17791
17792 Example:
17793 acl valid req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_is_valid
17794 #input: "for=127.0.0.1;proto=http"
17795 # output: TRUE
17796 #input: "proto=custom"
17797 # output: FALSE
17798
Aurelien DARRAGON6fb58b82022-12-30 16:37:03 +010017799rfc7239_field(<field>)
17800 Extracts a single field/parameter from RFC 7239 compliant header value input.
17801
17802 Supported fields are:
17803 - proto: either 'http' or 'https'
17804 - host: http compliant host
17805 - for: RFC7239 node
17806 - by: RFC7239 node
17807
17808 More info here:
17809 https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html#section-6
17810
17811 Example:
17812 # extract host field from forwarded header and store it in req.fhost var
17813 http-request set-var(req.fhost) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(host)
17814 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\""
17815 # output: "haproxy.org:80"
17816
17817 # extract for field from forwarded header and store it in req.ffor var
17818 http-request set-var(req.ffor) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for)
17819 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\";for=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
17820 # output: "127.0.0.1:9999"
17821
Aurelien DARRAGON07d67532022-12-30 16:45:42 +010017822rfc7239_n2nn
17823 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17824 into its corresponding nodename final form:
17825 - ipv4 address
17826 - ipv6 address
17827 - 'unknown'
17828 - '_obfs' identifier
17829
17830 Example:
17831 # extract 'for' field from forwarded header, extract nodename from
17832 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnn
17833 http-request set-var(req.fnn) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for),rfc7239_n2nn
Aurelien DARRAGONac456ab2023-05-30 09:47:53 +020017834 #input: "127.0.0.1:9999"
17835 # output: 127.0.0.1 (ipv4)
17836 #input: "[ab:cd:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff]:9998"
17837 # output: ab:cd:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff (ipv6)
17838 #input: "_name:_port"
17839 # output: "_name" (string)
Aurelien DARRAGON07d67532022-12-30 16:45:42 +010017840
Aurelien DARRAGON9a273b42022-12-30 16:56:08 +010017841rfc7239_n2np
17842 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17843 into its corresponding nodeport final form:
17844 - unsigned integer
17845 - '_obfs' identifier
17846
17847 Example:
17848 # extract 'by' field from forwarded header, extract node port from
17849 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnp
17850 http-request set-var(req.fnp) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(by),rfc7239_n2np
Aurelien DARRAGON06d8aad2023-06-02 15:29:17 +020017851 #input: "127.0.0.1:9999"
Aurelien DARRAGONac456ab2023-05-30 09:47:53 +020017852 # output: 9999 (integer)
17853 #input: "[ab:cd:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff]:9998"
17854 # output: 9998 (integer)
17855 #input: "_name:_port"
17856 # output: "_port" (string)
Aurelien DARRAGON9a273b42022-12-30 16:56:08 +010017857
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017858add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017859 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017860 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017861 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
17862 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017863 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017864 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17865 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17866 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17867 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017868 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017869 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017870
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020017871add_item(<delim>,[<var>][,<suff>]])
17872 Concatenates a minimum of 2 and up to 3 fields after the current sample which
17873 is then turned into a string. The first one, <delim>, is a constant string,
17874 that will be appended immediately after the existing sample if an existing
17875 sample is not empty and either the <var> or the <suff> is not empty. The
17876 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
17877 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after
17878 the <delim> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It is
17879 optional and may optionally be followed by a constant string <suff>, however
17880 if <var> is omitted, then <suff> is mandatory. This converter is similar to
17881 the concat converter and can be used to build new variables made of a
17882 succession of other variables but the main difference is that it does the
17883 checks if adding a delimiter makes sense as wouldn't be the case if e.g. the
17884 current sample is empty. That situation would require 2 separate rules using
17885 concat converter where the first rule would have to check if the current
17886 sample string is empty before adding a delimiter. If commas or closing
17887 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
17888 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreaub143d112022-11-25 09:27:15 +010017889 level parser (please see section 2.2 for quoting and escaping). See examples
17890 below.
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020017891
17892 Example:
17893 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1,"(site1)") if src,in_table(site1)'
17894 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score2,"(site2)") if src,in_table(site2)'
17895 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score3,"(site3)") if src,in_table(site3)'
17896 http-request set-header x-tagged %[var(req.tagged)]
17897
17898 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1),add_item(",",req.score2)'
17899 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",,(site1))' if src,in_table(site1)
17900
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010017901aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
17902 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
17903 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
17904 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
17905 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
17906 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
17907 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
17908
17909 Example:
17910 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
17911 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
17912
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017913and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017914 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017915 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017916 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
17917 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017918 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017919 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17920 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17921 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17922 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017923 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017924 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017925
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020017926b64dec
17927 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
17928 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017929 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
17930 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020017931
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020017932base64
17933 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017934 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017935 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
17936 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020017937
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020017938be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
17939 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
17940 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
17941 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
17942 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
17943 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
17944
17945 Example:
17946 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
17947 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
17948 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
17949 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
17950
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020017951be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
17952 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
17953 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
17954 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
17955 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
17956 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
17957 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
17958
17959 Example:
17960 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
17961 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
17962 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
17963 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
17964
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017965bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017966 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017967 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017968 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017969 presence of a flag).
17970
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010017971bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
17972 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
17973 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017974 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010017975
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017976concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
17977 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
17978 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
17979 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
17980 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
17981 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
17982 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
17983 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
17984 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
17985 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
17986 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017987 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040017988 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017989 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020017990 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
17991 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
17992 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017993
17994 Example:
17995 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
17996 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
17997 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017998 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020017999 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010018000 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
18001
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018002cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018003 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
18004 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018005
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010018006crc32([<avalanche>])
18007 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
18008 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18009 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18010 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18011 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18012 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
18013 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
18014 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
18015 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
18016 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018017 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
18018
18019crc32c([<avalanche>])
18020 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
18021 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18022 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18023 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
18024 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
18025 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
18026 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
18027 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010018028
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020018029cut_crlf
18030 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
18031 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
18032 updated.
18033
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010018034da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020018035 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
18036 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
18037 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
18038 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018039 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020018040 configuration language.
18041
18042 Example:
18043 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018044 bind *:8881
18045 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000018046 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020018047
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010018048debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
18049 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
18050 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
18051 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
18052 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
18053 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
18054 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
18055 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
18056 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
18057 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
18058 printable sample types.
18059
18060 Example:
18061 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020018062
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018063digest(<algorithm>)
18064 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
18065 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
18066
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018067 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018068 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18069
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018070div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018071 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
18072 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018073 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018074 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
18075 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018076 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018077 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18078 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18079 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18080 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018081 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018082 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018083
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018084djb2([<avalanche>])
18085 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
18086 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18087 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18088 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18089 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18090 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18091 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018092 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
18093 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018094
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018095even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018096 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018097 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
18098
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018099field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
18100 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
18101 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
18102 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
18103 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
18104 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
18105 fields.
18106
18107 Example :
18108 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
18109 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
18110 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
18111 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
18112 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010018113
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018114fix_is_valid
18115 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
18116 Information eXchange):
18117
18118 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
18119 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018120 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018121 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010018122 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018123 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
18124 checksum
18125
18126 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18127 the server can be parsed.
18128
18129 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
18130 message, false if not.
18131
18132 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
18133
18134 Example:
18135 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18136 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
18137
18138fix_tag_value(<tag>)
18139 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
18140 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
18141 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
18142 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050018143 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018144 added.
18145
18146 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18147 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
18148 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
18149 fix_is_valid converter.
18150
18151 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
18152
18153 Example:
18154 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18155 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
18156 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
18157 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
18158 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
18159
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018160hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018161 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018162 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018163 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018164 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010018165
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020018166hex2i
18167 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018168 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020018169
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020018170htonl
18171 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
18172 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
18173 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
18174 unsigned 32-bit integer.
18175
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010018176hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018177 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
18178 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
18179 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
18180 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
18181
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018182 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018183 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18184
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020018185host_only
18186 Converts a string which contains a Host header value and removes its port.
18187 The input must respect the format of the host header value
18188 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
18189 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
18190
18191 This converter also sets the string in lowercase.
18192
18193 See also: "port_only" converter which will return the port.
18194
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010018195http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018196 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18197 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018198 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
18199 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
18200 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
18201 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
18202 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
18203 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
18204 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
18205 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018206
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020018207iif(<true>,<false>)
18208 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
18209 string otherwise.
18210
18211 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020018212 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020018213
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018214in_table(<table>)
18215 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18216 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
18217 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018218 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018219 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
18220
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010018221ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010018222 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018223 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010018224 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
18225 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
18226 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
18227 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
18228 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018229
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018230json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018231 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018232 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020018233 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018234 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
18235 of errors:
18236 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
18237 bytes, ...)
18238 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
18239 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
18240
18241 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
18242 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
18243 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
18244 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
18245 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
18246 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018247 - "ascii" : never fails;
18248 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
18249 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018250 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018251 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018252 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
18253 characters corresponding to the other errors.
18254
18255 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018256 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018257
18258 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018259 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020018260 capture request header user-agent len 150
18261 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018262
18263 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
18264 GET / HTTP/1.0
18265 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
18266
18267 Output log:
18268 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
18269
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020018270json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
18271 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
18272 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
18273 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
18274 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
18275
18276 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
18277 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
18278
18279 Example:
18280 # get a integer value from the request body
18281 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
18282 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
18283
18284 # get a key with '.' in the name
18285 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
18286 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
18287
18288 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
18289 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
18290
18291 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
18292 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
18293
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020018294jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
18295 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
18296 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
18297 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
18298 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
18299 json_path and output_type parameters.
18300
18301 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
18302 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18303
18304jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
18305 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
18306 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
18307 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
18308 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
18309 json_path and output_type parameters.
18310
18311 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
18312 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18313
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018314jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
18315 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
18316 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018317 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018318 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
18319 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
18320 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
18321 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018322
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018323 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
Remi Tricot-Le Breton447a38f2023-03-07 17:43:57 +010018324 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). All the
Remi Tricot-Le Bretoncca939e2023-08-10 16:11:27 +020018325 algorithms mentioned in section 3.1 of RFC7518 are managed (HS, ES, RS and PS
18326 with the 256, 384 or 512 key sizes, as well as the special "none" case).
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018327
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018328 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
18329 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
18330 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
18331 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
18332 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
18333 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050018334 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018335 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
18336
18337 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
18338 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
18339 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
18340 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
18341 contents.
18342
18343 The possible return values are the following :
18344
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018345 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
18346 | ID | message |
18347 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018348 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050018349 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018350 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton447a38f2023-03-07 17:43:57 +010018351 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018352 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
18353 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
18354 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018355 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018356
18357 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
18358 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18359
18360 Example:
18361 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
18362 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
18363 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
18364 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
Aurelien DARRAGON4761b0d2023-05-26 14:29:58 +020018365 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) -m str "RS256" }
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018366 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
18367
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018368language(<value>[,<default>])
18369 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
18370 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
18371 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
18372 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
18373 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
18374 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
18375 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
18376 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
18377 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018378 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018379 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
18380 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018381
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018382 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018383
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018384 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
18385 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018386
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018387 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
18388 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
18389 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
18390 use_backend spanish if es
18391 use_backend french if fr
18392 use_backend english if en
18393 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018394
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010018395length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010018396 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
18397 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18398 type. The result is of type integer.
18399
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018400lower
18401 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
18402 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18403 type. The result is of type string.
18404
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018405ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
18406 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18407 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
18408 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
18409 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
18410 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
18411 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
18412
18413 Example :
18414
18415 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018416 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018417 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
18418
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020018419ltrim(<chars>)
18420 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
18421 representation of the input sample.
18422
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018423map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18424map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18425map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18426 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
18427 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
18428 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
18429 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
18430 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
18431 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
18432 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
18433 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018434
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018435 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
18436 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
18437 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018438
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018439 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018440 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018441
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018442 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
18443 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18444 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
18445 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020018446 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
18447 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018448 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
18449 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18450 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
18451 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18452 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
18453 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18454 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
18455 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080018456 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
18457 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18458 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018459 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18460 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
18461 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18462 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
18463 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018464
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010018465 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
18466 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
18467 the corresponding match text.
18468
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018469 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
18470 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
18471 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
18472 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
18473 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018474
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018475 Example :
18476
18477 # this is a comment and is ignored
18478 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
18479 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
18480 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
18481 | | | `---------- value
18482 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
18483 | `---------------------------- key
18484 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
18485
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018486mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018487 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
18488 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018489 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018490 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018491 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018492 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18493 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18494 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18495 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018496 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018497 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018498
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018499mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018500 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
18501 <packettype>.
18502 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
18503 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
18504 from.
18505 Supported string and integers can be found here:
18506 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
18507 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
18508
18509 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
18510 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
18511 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
18512 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
18513
18514 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
18515 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
18516 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
18517 packets only):
18518 17: Session Expiry Interval
18519 33: Receive Maximum
18520 39: Maximum Packet Size
18521 34: Topic Alias Maximum
18522 25: Request Response Information
18523 23: Request Problem Information
18524 21: Authentication Method
18525 22: Authentication Data
18526 18: Will Delay Interval
18527 1: Payload Format Indicator
18528 2: Message Expiry Interval
18529 3: Content Type
18530 8: Response Topic
18531 9: Correlation Data
18532 Not supported yet:
18533 38: User Property
18534
18535 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
18536 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
18537 packets only):
18538 17: Session Expiry Interval
18539 33: Receive Maximum
18540 36: Maximum QoS
18541 37: Retain Available
18542 39: Maximum Packet Size
18543 18: Assigned Client Identifier
18544 34: Topic Alias Maximum
18545 31: Reason String
18546 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
18547 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
18548 42: Shared Subscription Available
18549 19: Server Keep Alive
18550 26: Response Information
18551 28: Server Reference
18552 21: Authentication Method
18553 22: Authentication Data
18554 Not supported yet:
18555 38: User Property
18556
18557 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18558 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18559 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18560 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18561
18562 Example:
18563
18564 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
18565 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18566 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
18567 if data_in_buffer
18568 # do the same as above
18569 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18570 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
18571 if data_in_buffer
18572
18573mqtt_is_valid
18574 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
18575
18576 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18577 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18578 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18579 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18580
Christopher Faulet140a3572022-03-22 09:41:11 +010018581 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
18582
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018583 Example:
18584
18585 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040018586 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018587
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018588mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018589 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020018590 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
18591 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018592 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018593 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018594 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018595 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18596 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18597 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18598 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018599 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018600 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018601
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010018602nbsrv
18603 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
18604 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
18605 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
18606 map lookup.
18607
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018608neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018609 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
18610 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
18611 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
18612 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018613
18614not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018615 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018616 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018617 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018618 absence of a flag).
18619
18620odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018621 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018622 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
18623
18624or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018625 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018626 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018627 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
18628 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018629 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018630 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18631 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18632 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18633 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018634 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018635 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018636
Thayne McCombs02cf4ec2022-12-14 00:19:59 -070018637param(<name>,[<delim>])
18638 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the input string
18639 where parameters are delimited by <delim>, which defaults to "&", and the name
18640 and value of the parameter are separated by a "=". If there is no "=" and
18641 value before the end of the parameter segment, it is treated as equivalent to
18642 a value of an empty string.
18643
18644 This can be useful for extracting parameters from a query string, or possibly
18645 a x-www-form-urlencoded body. In particular, `query,param(<name>)` can be used
18646 as an alternative to `urlp(<name>)` which only uses "&" as a delimiter,
18647 whereas "urlp" also uses "?" and ";".
18648
18649 Note that this converter doesn't do anything special with url encoded
18650 characters. If you want to decode the value, you can use the url_dec converter
18651 on the output. If the name of the parameter in the input might contain encoded
18652 characters, you'll probably want do normalize the input before calling
18653 "param". This can be done using "http-request normalize-uri", in particular
18654 the percent-decode-unreserved and percent-to-uppercase options.
18655
18656 Example :
18657 str(a=b&c=d&a=r),param(a) # b
18658 str(a&b=c),param(a) # ""
18659 str(a=&b&c=a),param(b) # ""
18660 str(a=1;b=2;c=4),param(b,;) # 2
18661 query,param(redirect_uri),urldec()
18662
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020018663port_only
18664 Converts a string which contains a Host header value into an integer by
18665 returning its port.
18666 The input must respect the format of the host header value
18667 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
18668 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
18669
18670 If no port were provided in the input, it will return 0.
18671
18672 See also: "host_only" converter which will return the host.
18673
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018674protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
18675 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
18676 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
18677 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
18678 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
18679 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
18680 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
18681 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
18682 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
18683 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
18684 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
18685 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
18686
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010018687regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018688 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
18689 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
18690 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
18691 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
18692 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
18693 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
18694 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
18695 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
18696 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018697 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
18698 of characters with other ones.
18699
18700 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
18701 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
18702 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
18703 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
18704 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
18705 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018706
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018707 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018708
18709 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
18710 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
18711 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018712 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018713
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018714 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
18715 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
18716
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018717 # capture groups and backreferences
18718 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020018719 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018720 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
18721
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018722capture-req(<id>)
18723 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
18724 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18725
18726 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018727 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18728 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018729
18730capture-res(<id>)
18731 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
18732 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18733
18734 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018735 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18736 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018737
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020018738rtrim(<chars>)
18739 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
18740 of the input sample.
18741
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018742sdbm([<avalanche>])
18743 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
18744 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18745 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18746 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18747 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18748 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18749 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018750 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
18751 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018752
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018753secure_memcmp(<var>)
18754 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
18755 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
18756 match.
18757
18758 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
18759 performed in constant time.
18760
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018761 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018762 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18763
18764 Example :
18765
18766 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
18767 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
18768 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
18769 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
18770
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010018771set-var(<var>[,<cond>...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018772 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018773 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
18774 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
18775 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
18776 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018777 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018778 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18779 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018780 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018781 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18782 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018783 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018784 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018785
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018786 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
18787 possible conditions :
18788 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
18789 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
18790 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
18791 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
18792 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
18793 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
18794 Checks if the input is empty or not.
18795 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
18796 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
18797 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
18798 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
18799 called on the variable.
18800 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
18801 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
18802 configuration parsing.
18803 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
18804 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
18805 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
18806 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
18807 true by default.
18808
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018809sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018810 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018811 sample with length of 20 bytes.
18812
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018813sha2([<bits>])
18814 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
18815 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
18816
18817 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
18818 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
18819
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018820 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018821 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18822
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020018823srv_queue
18824 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
18825 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
18826 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
18827 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
18828 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
18829
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018830strcmp(<var>)
18831 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
18832 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
18833 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
18834 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
18835 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
18836 shorter).
18837
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018838 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
18839 strings in constant time.
18840
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018841 Example :
18842
18843 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
18844 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
18845 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
18846
18847
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018848sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018849 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
18850 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018851 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018852 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
18853 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018854 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018855 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18856 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018857 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018858 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18859 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018860 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018861 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018862
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018863table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
18864 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18865 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18866 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
18867 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
18868 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
18869 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
18870
18871
18872table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
18873 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18874 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18875 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
18876 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
18877 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
18878 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
18879
18880table_conn_cnt(<table>)
18881 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18882 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018883 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018884 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
18885 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18886
18887table_conn_cur(<table>)
18888 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18889 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18890 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
18891 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
18892 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
18893
18894table_conn_rate(<table>)
18895 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18896 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18897 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
18898 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
18899 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
18900
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020018901table_expire(<table>[,<default_value>])
18902 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
18903 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
18904 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
18905 is found the converter returns the key expiration delay associated with the
18906 input sample in the designated table.
18907 See also the table_idle sample fetch keyword.
18908
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018909table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
18910 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18911 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
18912 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
18913 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
18914 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18915 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
18916 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
18917 data-type).
18918 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18919
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018920table_gpt0(<table>)
18921 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18922 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
18923 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
18924 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
18925 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
18926
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018927table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
18928 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18929 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18930 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
18931 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
18932 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
18933 between 0 and 99.
18934 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
18935 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18936 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18937 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
18938
18939table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
18940 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18941 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18942 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
18943 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
18944 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
18945 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18946 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
18947 value 0.
18948 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
18949 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18950 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
18951
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018952table_gpc0(<table>)
18953 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18954 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18955 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
18956 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
18957 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
18958
18959table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
18960 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18961 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18962 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
18963 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
18964 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
18965 sample fetch keyword.
18966
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018967table_gpc1(<table>)
18968 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18969 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18970 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
18971 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
18972 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
18973
18974table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
18975 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18976 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18977 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
18978 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
18979 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
18980 sample fetch keyword.
18981
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018982table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
18983 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18984 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018985 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018986 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
18987 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18988
18989table_http_err_rate(<table>)
18990 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18991 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18992 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
18993 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
18994 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
18995 keyword.
18996
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018997table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
18998 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18999 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19000 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
19001 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
19002 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19003
19004table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
19005 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19006 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19007 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
19008 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
19009 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
19010 keyword.
19011
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019012table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
19013 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19014 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019015 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019016 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
19017 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19018
19019table_http_req_rate(<table>)
19020 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19021 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19022 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
19023 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
19024 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
19025 keyword.
19026
Aurelien DARRAGONfd766dd2022-11-23 14:35:06 +010019027table_idle(<table>[,<default_value>])
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020019028 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
19029 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
19030 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
19031 is found the converter returns the time the key entry associated with the
19032 input sample in the designated table remained idle since the last time it was
19033 updated.
19034 See also the table_expire sample fetch keyword.
19035
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019036table_kbytes_in(<table>)
19037 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19038 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019039 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019040 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
19041 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
19042 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
19043 keyword.
19044
19045table_kbytes_out(<table>)
19046 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19047 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019048 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019049 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
19050 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
19051 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
19052 keyword.
19053
19054table_server_id(<table>)
19055 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19056 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19057 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
19058 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
19059 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
19060 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
19061
19062table_sess_cnt(<table>)
19063 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19064 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019065 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019066 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
19067 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
19068 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
19069 keyword.
19070
19071table_sess_rate(<table>)
19072 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19073 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19074 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
19075 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
19076 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
19077 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
19078 keyword.
19079
19080table_trackers(<table>)
19081 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19082 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19083 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
19084 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
19085 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
19086 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
19087 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
19088 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
19089 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
19090 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
19091
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020019092ub64dec
19093 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
19094 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
19095 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
19096
19097 Example:
19098 # Decoding a JWT payload:
19099 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
19100
19101ub64enc
19102 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
19103
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020019104upper
19105 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
19106 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
19107 type. The result is of type string.
19108
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020019109url_dec([<in_form>])
19110 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
19111 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
19112 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
19113 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
19114 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
19115 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020019116
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010019117url_enc([<enc_type>])
19118 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
19119 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
19120 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
19121 optional argument is here for future changes.
19122
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019123ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019124 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010019125 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
19126 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
19127 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019128 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
19129 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
19130 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
19131 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010019132 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019133 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
19134 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019135
19136 Example:
19137 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
19138 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
19139
19140 message Point {
19141 int32 latitude = 1;
19142 int32 longitude = 2;
19143 }
19144
19145 message PPoint {
19146 Point point = 59;
19147 }
19148
19149 message Rectangle {
19150 // One corner of the rectangle.
19151 PPoint lo = 48;
19152 // The other corner of the rectangle.
19153 PPoint hi = 49;
19154 }
19155
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019156 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
19157 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
19158 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019159
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019160 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
19161 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019162 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019163 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
19164
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019165 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019166
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010019167 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019168
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019169 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
19170 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
19171 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010019172
19173 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
19174 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
19175 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
19176
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019177 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
19178 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
19179 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010019180
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019181
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010019182unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010019183 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
19184 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
19185 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
19186 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19187 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
19188 response),
19189 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19190 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
19191 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
19192 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
19193
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020019194utime(<format>[,<offset>])
19195 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
19196 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
19197 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
19198 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
19199 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
19200 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
19201
19202 Example :
19203
19204 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019205 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020019206 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
19207
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020019208word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
19209 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
19210 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
19211 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010019212 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020019213 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
19214 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
19215
19216 Example :
19217 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
19218 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
19219 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
19220 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
19221 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010019222 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010019223
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019224wt6([<avalanche>])
19225 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
19226 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
19227 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
19228 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
19229 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
19230 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
19231 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010019232 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
19233 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019234
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010019235xor(<value>)
19236 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020019237 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019238 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019239 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019240 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019241 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19242 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019243 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019244 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19245 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019246 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019247 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010019248
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010019249xxh3([<seed>])
19250 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
19251 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
19252 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
19253 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
19254 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
19255 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
19256 considered as cryptographically secure.
19257
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010019258xxh32([<seed>])
19259 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
19260 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
19261 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
19262 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
19263 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
19264 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
19265 as cryptographically secure.
19266
19267xxh64([<seed>])
19268 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
19269 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
19270 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
19271 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
19272 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
19273 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
19274 as cryptographically secure.
19275
William Lallemand9fbc84e2022-11-03 18:56:37 +010019276x509_v_err_str
19277 Convert a numerical value to its corresponding X509_V_ERR constant name. It
19278 is useful in ACL in order to have a configuration which works with multiple
19279 version of OpenSSL since some codes might change when changing version.
19280
William Lallemand117c7fd2023-05-03 15:13:10 +020019281 When the corresponding constant name was not found, outputs the numerical
19282 value as a string.
19283
William Lallemand9fbc84e2022-11-03 18:56:37 +010019284 The list of constant provided by OpenSSL can be found at
19285 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
19286 Be careful to read the page for the right version of OpenSSL.
19287
19288 Example:
19289
19290 bind :443 ssl crt common.pem ca-file ca-auth.crt verify optional crt-ignore-err X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED,X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
19291
19292 acl cert_expired ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
19293 acl cert_revoked ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED
19294 acl cert_ok ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_OK
19295
19296 http-response add-header X-SSL Ok if cert_ok
19297 http-response add-header X-SSL Expired if cert_expired
19298 http-response add-header X-SSL Revoked if cert_revoked
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010019299
William Lallemand117c7fd2023-05-03 15:13:10 +020019300 http-response add-header X-SSL-verify %[ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str]
19301
19302
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200193037.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019304--------------------------------------------
19305
19306A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
19307not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
19308"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
19309The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
19310
19311always_false : boolean
19312 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
19313 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
19314
19315always_true : boolean
19316 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
19317 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
19318
19319avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019320 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019321 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
19322 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
19323 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
19324 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
19325 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
19326 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
19327 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
19328 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
19329 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
19330 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
19331 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
19332 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
19333 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010019334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019335be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019336 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
19337 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
19338 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
19339 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040019340 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
19341
19342be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
19343 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
19344 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
19345 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
19346 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
19347 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040019348 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
19349 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040019350
19351 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
19352 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
19353 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019355be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
19356 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19357 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
19358 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019359 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019360 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
19361 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019362
19363 Example :
19364 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
19365 backend dynamic
19366 mode http
19367 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
19368 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019369
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019370bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019371 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
19372 of the string.
19373
19374bool(<bool>) : bool
19375 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
19376 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
19377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019378connslots([<backend>]) : integer
19379 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019380 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019381 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
19382 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050019383
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019384 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019385 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019386 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
19387
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019388 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
19389 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019390
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019391 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019392 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019393 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019394 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019395 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019396 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019397 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019398
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019399 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
19400 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019401 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019402 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019403
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019404cpu_calls : integer
19405 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
19406 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
19407 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
19408 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
19409 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
19410 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
19411
19412cpu_ns_avg : integer
19413 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
19414 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
19415 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
19416 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
19417 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
19418 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
19419 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
19420 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
19421 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
19422 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
19423 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
19424
19425cpu_ns_tot : integer
19426 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
19427 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
19428 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
19429 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
19430 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
19431 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
19432 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
19433 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
19434 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
19435 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
19436 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
19437 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
19438 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
19439
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010019440date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020019441 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019442
19443 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
19444 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
19445 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020019446 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
19447
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019448 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
19449 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
19450 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
19451 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
19452 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
19453
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020019454 Example :
19455
19456 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
19457 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020019458
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019459 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
19460 # millisecond granularity
19461 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
19462
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010019463date_us : integer
19464 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
19465 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
19466 from the same timeval structure.
19467
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020019468env(<name>) : string
19469 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
19470 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
19471 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
19472 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
19473 certain way.
19474
19475 Examples :
19476 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
19477 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
19478
19479 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019480 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020019481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019482fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
19483 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019484 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
19485 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019486 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
19487 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019488 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019489 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
19490 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019491
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020019492fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
19493 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
19494 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
19495 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
19496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019497fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
19498 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19499 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
19500 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
19501 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
19502 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
19503 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
19504 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
19505 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019506
19507 Example :
19508 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
19509 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
19510 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
19511 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
19512 frontend mail
19513 bind :25
19514 mode tcp
19515 maxconn 100
19516 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
19517 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
19518 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
19519 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019520
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010019521hostname : string
19522 Returns the system hostname.
19523
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020019524int(<integer>) : signed integer
19525 Returns a signed integer.
19526
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019527ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
19528 Returns an ipv4.
19529
19530ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
19531 Returns an ipv6.
19532
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020019533last_rule_file : string
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010019534 This returns the name of the configuration file containing the last final
19535 rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one that
19536 terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
19537 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
19538 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19539 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19540 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19541 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19542 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19543 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19544 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19545 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_line".
19546
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020019547last_rule_line : integer
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010019548 This returns the line number in the configuration file where is located the
19549 last final rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one
19550 that terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
19551 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
19552 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19553 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19554 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19555 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19556 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19557 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19558 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19559 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_file".
19560
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019561lat_ns_avg : integer
19562 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19563 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19564 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19565 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19566 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19567 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19568 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19569 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19570 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019571 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19572 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19573 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19574 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19575 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
19576 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019577
19578lat_ns_tot : integer
19579 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19580 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19581 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19582 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19583 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19584 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19585 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19586 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19587 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019588 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19589 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19590 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19591 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19592 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019593 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
19594 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
19595 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
19596 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
19597 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
19598 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
19599
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019600meth(<method>) : method
19601 Returns a method.
19602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019603nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
19604 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
19605 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
19606 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019607 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
19608 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
19609 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019610
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040019611prio_class : integer
19612 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
19613 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
19614 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
19615
19616prio_offset : integer
19617 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
19618 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
19619 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
19620 set-priority-offset".
19621
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019622proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020019623 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
19624 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019626queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019627 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
19628 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
19629 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019630 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
19631 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
19632 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
19633 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
19634 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
19635
Frédéric Lécaille33d11c42023-01-12 17:55:45 +010019636quic_enabled : boolean
Frédéric Lécaille33d11c42023-01-12 17:55:45 +010019637 Return true when the support for QUIC transport protocol was compiled and
19638 if this procotol was not disabled by "no-quic" global option. See also "no-quic"
19639 global option.
19640
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010019641rand([<range>]) : integer
19642 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
19643 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
19644 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
19645 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
19646 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
19647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019648srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19649 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19650 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
19651 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
19652 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
19653 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040019654 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
19655 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
19656
19657srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19658 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
19659 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
19660 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19661 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
19662 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
19663 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
19664 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
19665
19666 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
19667 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019668
19669srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
19670 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
19671 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
19672 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019673 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019674 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
19675 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
19676 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
19677
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020019678srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19679 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
19680 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19681 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
19682 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
19683 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
19684 fetch methods.
19685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019686srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19687 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19688 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019689 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019690 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
19691 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019692 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019693 overloading servers).
19694
19695 Example :
19696 # Redirect to a separate back
19697 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
19698 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
19699 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
19700
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019701srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019702 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
19703 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
19704 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
19705
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019706srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019707 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
19708 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19709 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
19710
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019711srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019712 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
19713 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19714 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
19715
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019716stopping : boolean
19717 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
19718 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
19719 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
19720
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019721str(<string>) : string
19722 Returns a string.
19723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019724table_avl([<table>]) : integer
19725 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
19726 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
19727
19728table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19729 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
19730 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
19731 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
19732
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010019733thread : integer
19734 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
19735 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
19736 and debugging purposes.
19737
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020019738uuid([<version>]) : string
19739 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
19740 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
19741 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
19742
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019743var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019744 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019745 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
19746 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
19747 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019748 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019749 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19750 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019751 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019752 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19753 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019754 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019755 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019756
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200197577.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019758----------------------------------
19759
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019760The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019761closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
19762methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
19763sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
19764TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019765the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
19766counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020019767"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +010019768used if the global "tune.stick-counters" value does not exceed 3, otherwise the
19769counter number can be specified as the first integer argument when using the
19770"sc_" prefix starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (tune.stick-counters-1).
19771An optional table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the
19772currently tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of
19773the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019774
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019775bc_dst : ip
19776 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
19777 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
19778 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
19779 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19780
19781bc_dst_port : integer
19782 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019783 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019784
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019785bc_err : integer
19786 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
19787 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
19788 and their corresponding error message.
19789
19790bc_err_str : string
19791 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
19792 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
19793 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
19794 corresponding error message.
19795
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010019796bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010019797 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
19798 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
19799 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
19800
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019801bc_src : ip
19802 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019803 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019804 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
19805 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19806
19807bc_src_port : integer
19808 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019809 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019811be_id : integer
19812 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019813 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19814 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019815
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019816be_name : string
19817 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019818 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19819 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019820
Aleksandar Lazic5529c992023-04-28 11:39:12 +020019821bc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
19822 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the backend
19823 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
19824 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
19825 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19826 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19827 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19828
19829bc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
19830 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
19831 backend connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
19832 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
19833 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19834 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19835 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19836
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010019837be_server_timeout : integer
19838 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
19839 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
19840 also the "cur_server_timeout".
19841
19842be_tunnel_timeout : integer
19843 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
19844 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
19845 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
19846
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010019847cur_server_timeout : integer
19848 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
19849 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
19850 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
19851
19852cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
19853 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
19854 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
19855 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
19856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019857dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019858 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
19859 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
19860 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
19861 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
19862 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
19863 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
19864 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
19865 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
19866 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
19867 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
19868 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019869
19870dst_conn : integer
19871 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19872 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
19873 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
19874 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
19875 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
19876 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
19877 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
19878 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019879
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019880dst_is_local : boolean
19881 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
19882 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
19883 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
19884 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019885 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019886 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
19887 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
19888 it only once per connection.
19889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019890dst_port : integer
19891 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
19892 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019893 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
19894 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
19895 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
19896 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019897
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019898fc_dst : ip
19899 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
19900 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
19901 for details.
19902
19903fc_dst_is_local : boolean
19904 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
19905 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
19906 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
19907
19908fc_dst_port : integer
19909 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
19910 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
19911 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
19912
19913fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019914 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
19915 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
19916 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010019917 described in section 8.2.6). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019918 error codes and their corresponding error message.
19919
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019920fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050019921 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019922 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010019923 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.6). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019924 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
19925
19926 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19927 | ID | message |
19928 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19929 | 0 | "Success" |
19930 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
19931 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
19932 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
19933 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
19934 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
19935 | 6 | "General socket error" |
19936 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
19937 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
19938 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
19939 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
19940 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19941 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19942 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19943 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
19944 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
19945 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
19946 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
19947 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
19948 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
19949 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
19950 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
19951 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
19952 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
19953 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
19954 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
19955 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
19956 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
19957 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
19958 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
19959 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
19960 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
19961 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
19962 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
19963 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
19964 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
19965 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
19966 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
19967 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
19968 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
19969 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
19970 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
19971 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020019972 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019973 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19974
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019975fc_fackets : integer
19976 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
19977 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19978 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19979 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19980
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020019981fc_http_major : integer
19982 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
19983 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
19984 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
19985
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019986fc_lost : integer
19987 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
19988 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19989 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19990 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19991
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020019992fc_pp_authority : string
19993 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
19994 if any.
19995
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010019996fc_pp_unique_id : string
19997 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
19998 if any.
19999
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010020000fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
20001 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
20002 header.
20003
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020004fc_reordering : integer
20005 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
20006 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20007 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20008 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20009
20010fc_retrans : integer
20011 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
20012 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20013 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20014 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20015
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020020016fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
20017 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
20018 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
20019 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
20020 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
20021 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
20022 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20023
20024fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
20025 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
20026 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
20027 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
20028 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
20029 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
20030 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20031
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020020032fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070020033 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
20034 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
20035 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
20036 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20037
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020038fc_src : ip
Christopher Faulet18b63f42023-07-17 07:56:55 +020020039 This is the original source IP address of the connection on the client side
20040 Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src" for
20041 details.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020042
20043fc_src_is_local : boolean
20044 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
20045 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
20046 "src_is_local" for details.
20047
20048fc_src_port : integer
20049
20050 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
20051 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
20052 this address. See "src-port" for details.
20053
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070020054
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020055fc_unacked : integer
20056 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
20057 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
20058 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
20059 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070020060
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020020061fe_defbe : string
20062 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
20063 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
20064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020065fe_id : integer
20066 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010020067 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020068 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
20069
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010020070fe_name : string
20071 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
20072 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
20073 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
20074
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010020075fe_client_timeout : integer
20076 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
20077 current frontend.
20078
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020079sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020080sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20081sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20082sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020083 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
20084 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
20085 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
20086
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020087sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020088sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20089sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20090sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020091 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
20092 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
20093 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
20094
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020095sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20096 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20097 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
20098 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
20099 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
20100 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
20101 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
20102 will always return zero.
20103 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20104 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20105
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020106sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020107sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20108sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20109sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020110 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
20111 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020112 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
20113 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
20114 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020115
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020116 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020117 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
20118 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020119 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
20120 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
20121 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020122 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
20123 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20124
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020125sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20126sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20127sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20128sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20129 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
20130 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
20131 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
20132 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
20133 when a first ACL was verified.
20134
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020135sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020136sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20137sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20138sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020139 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020140 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
20141
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020142sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020143sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
20144sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
20145sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020146 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
20147 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
20148 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
20149
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020150sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020151sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20152sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20153sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020154 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
20155 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
20156 See also src_conn_rate.
20157
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020158sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20159 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
20160 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
20161 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
20162 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
20163 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
20164 index, zero is returned.
20165 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20166 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
20167
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020168sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020169sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20170sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20171sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020172 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020173 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020174
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020175sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20176sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20177sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20178sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20179 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
20180 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
20181
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020020182sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20183 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
20184 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
20185 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
20186 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
20187 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
20188 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
20189 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
20190
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020020191sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20192sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20193sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20194sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20195 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
20196 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
20197
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020198sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20199 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
20200 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
20201 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
20202 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
20203 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
20204 between 0 and 2.
20205 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
20206 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
20207 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
20208 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
20209 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
20210
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020211sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020212sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
20213sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
20214sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020215 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
20216 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
20217 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020218 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
20219 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20220 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020221
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020222sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20223sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20224sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20225sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20226 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
20227 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
20228 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
20229 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
20230 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20231 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
20232
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020233sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020234sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20235sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20236sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020237 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020238 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
20239 See also src_http_err_cnt.
20240
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020241sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020242sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20243sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20244sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020245 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
20246 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
20247 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
20248 src_http_err_rate.
20249
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020250sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20251sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20252sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20253sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20254 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
20255 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
20256 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
20257
20258sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20259sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20260sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20261sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20262 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
20263 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
20264 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
20265 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
20266
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020267sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020268sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20269sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20270sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020271 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020272 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
20273 src_http_req_cnt.
20274
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020275sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020276sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20277sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20278sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020279 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
20280 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
20281 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
20282 src_http_req_rate.
20283
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020284sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20285 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20286 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
20287 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
20288 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
20289 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
20290 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
20291 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
20292 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20293 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20294
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020295sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020296sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20297sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20298sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020299 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020300 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
20301 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
20302 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
20303 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020304
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020305 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020306 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
20307 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020308 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20309
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020310sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20311sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20312sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20313sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20314 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
20315 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
20316 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
20317 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
20318 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
20319
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020320sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020321sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
20322sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
20323sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020324 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
20325 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
20326 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020327
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020328sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020329sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
20330sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
20331sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020332 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
20333 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
20334 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020335
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020336sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020337sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20338sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20339sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020340 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020341 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
20342 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
20343 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020344 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020345 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
20346
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020347sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020348sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20349sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20350sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020351 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
20352 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
20353 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
20354 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
20355 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020356 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020357
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020358sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020359sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
20360sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
20361sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020020362 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
20363 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
20364 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
20365
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020366sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020367sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
20368sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
20369sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010020370 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
20371 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020372 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010020373 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
20374 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020375 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
20376 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
20377 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010020378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020379so_id : integer
20380 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
20381 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
20382 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020383
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010020384so_name : string
20385 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
20386 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
20387 strings instead of integers.
20388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020389src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020390 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
20391 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
20392 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
20393 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
20394 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
20395 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
20396 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
20397 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
20398 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
20399 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
20400 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
20401 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
20402 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
20403 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
20404 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020405
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010020406 Example:
20407 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
20408 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
20409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020410src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20411 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
20412 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
20413 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020414 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020416src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20417 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
20418 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020419 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020420 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020421
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020422src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20423 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20424 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20425 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
20426 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20427 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
20428 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20429 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20430 See also sc_clr_gpc.
20431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020432src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20433 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20434 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20435 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
20436 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
20437 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
20438 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020439
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020440 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020441 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
20442 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
20443 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
20444 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020445 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020446 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
20447 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20448
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020449src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20450 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20451 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20452 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
20453 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
20454 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
20455 was verified.
20456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020457src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020458 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020459 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020460 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020461 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020463src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020464 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020465 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20466 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020467 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020469src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20470 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
20471 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20472 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020473 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020474
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020475src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20476 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
20477 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
20478 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
20479 is an integer between 0 and 99.
20480 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
20481 is returned.
20482 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
20483 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20484 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
20485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020486src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020487 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020488 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020489 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020490 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020491
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020492src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20493 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
20494 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
20495 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20496 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
20497
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020020498src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
20499 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
20500 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
20501 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
20502 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20503 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
20504 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
20505
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020020506src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20507 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
20508 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
20509 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20510 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
20511
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020512src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
20513 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
20514 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
20515 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
20516 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
20517 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20518 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
20519 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
20520 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
20521 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
20522 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
20523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020524src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020525 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020526 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020527 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
20528 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020529 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
20530 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20531 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020532
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020533src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20534 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
20535 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20536 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
20537 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
20538 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
20539 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20540 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
20541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020542src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020543 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020544 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020545 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020546 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020547 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020549src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20550 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
20551 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20552 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
20553 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020554 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020555
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020556src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20557 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
20558 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050020559 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020560 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
20561 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20562
20563src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20564 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
20565 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20566 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
20567 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
20568 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
20569 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
20570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020571src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020572 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020573 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20574 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020575 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020577src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20578 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
20579 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20580 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020581 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020582 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020583
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020584src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20585 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
20586 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20587 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
20588 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20589 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
20590 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20591 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20592 See also sc_inc_gpc.
20593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020594src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20595 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20596 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20597 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020598 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020599 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20600 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020601
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020602 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020603 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020604 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020605 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020606
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020607src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20608 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20609 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20610 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
20611 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
20612 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20613 connection when a first ACL was verified.
20614
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020615src_is_local : boolean
20616 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
20617 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
20618 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
20619 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020620 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020621 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
20622 once per connection.
20623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020624src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020625 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
20626 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
20627 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
20628 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
20629 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020631src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020632 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
20633 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20634 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
20635 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
20636 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020638src_port : integer
20639 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020640 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
20641 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
20642 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
20643 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010020644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020645src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020646 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020647 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20648 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
20649 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020650 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020652src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20653 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
20654 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20655 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
20656 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020657 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020659src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20660 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
20661 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
20662 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
20663 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
20664 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
20665 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
20666 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
20667 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020668
20669 Example :
20670 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
20671 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
20672 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
20673 listen ssh
20674 bind :22
20675 mode tcp
20676 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020677 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020678 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020679 server local 127.0.0.1:22
20680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020681srv_id : integer
20682 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
20683 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020684 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020020685
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020686srv_name : string
20687 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
20688 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020689 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020690
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200206917.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020692----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020020693
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020694The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020695closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
20696when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
20697usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020698future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020699
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00002070051d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
20701 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
20702 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
20703 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
20704 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
20705 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
20706
20707 Example :
20708 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
20709 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
20710 # the request.
20711 frontend http-in
20712 bind *:8081
20713 default_backend servers
20714 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
20715 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
20716
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020717ssl_bc : boolean
20718 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
20719 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Mariam John6ff043d2023-05-22 13:11:13 -050020720 to a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020721 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020722
20723ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
20724 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020725 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20726 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020727
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020728ssl_bc_alpn : string
20729 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
20730 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020731 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020732 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
20733 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
20734 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
20735 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
20736 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020737 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
20738 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020739
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020740ssl_bc_cipher : string
20741 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020742 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20743 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020744
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020745ssl_bc_client_random : binary
20746 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20747 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20748 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020749 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020750
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020751ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020752 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020753 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
20754 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
20755 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
20756 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020757 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
20758 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
20759 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
20760
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020761ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020762 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020763 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
20764 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
20765 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020766
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020767ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
20768 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20769 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020770 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20771 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020772
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020773ssl_bc_npn : string
20774 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
20775 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020776 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020777 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
20778 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
20779 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
20780 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020781 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
20782 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020783
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020784ssl_bc_protocol : string
20785 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020786 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20787 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020788
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020789ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020790 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020791 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020792 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
20793 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020794
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020795ssl_bc_server_random : binary
20796 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20797 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20798 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020799 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020800
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020801ssl_bc_session_id : binary
20802 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
20803 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020804 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20805 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020806
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020807ssl_bc_session_key : binary
20808 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
20809 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
20810 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020811 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020812
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020813ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
20814 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020815 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20816 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020818ssl_c_ca_err : integer
20819 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20820 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
20821 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
20822 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
20823 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020825ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
20826 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20827 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
20828 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
20829 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020830
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010020831ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020832 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
20833 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20834 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050020835 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020836 does not support resumed sessions.
20837
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010020838ssl_c_der : binary
20839 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
20840 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20841 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020843ssl_c_err : integer
20844 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20845 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
20846 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
20847 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
20848 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020849
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020850ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020851 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20852 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20853 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20854 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20855 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20856 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20857 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20858 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020859 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20860 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20861 LDAP v3.
20862 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20863 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020865ssl_c_key_alg : string
20866 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20867 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20868 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020870ssl_c_notafter : string
20871 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
20872 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20873 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020020874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020875ssl_c_notbefore : string
20876 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
20877 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20878 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010020879
Abhijeet Rastogidf97f472023-05-13 20:04:45 -070020880ssl_c_r_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
20881 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and is
20882 successfully validated with the configured ca-file, returns the full
20883 distinguished name of the root CA of the certificate presented by the client
20884 when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the first given entry found from
20885 the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative occurrence number is specified
20886 as the optional second argument, it returns the value of the nth given entry
20887 value from the beginning/end of the DN. For instance, "ssl_c_r_dn(OU,2)" the
20888 second organization unit, and "ssl_c_r_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name. The
20889 <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for consumption by
20890 different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for LDAP v3. If you'd like
20891 to modify the format only you can specify an empty string and zero for the
20892 first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_r_dn(,0,rfc2253)
20893
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020894ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020895 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20896 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20897 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20898 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20899 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20900 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20901 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20902 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020903 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20904 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20905 LDAP v3.
20906 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20907 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010020908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020909ssl_c_serial : binary
20910 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
20911 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20912 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020914ssl_c_sha1 : binary
20915 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
20916 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
20917 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020020918 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
20919 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
20920
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020921 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020020922 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020924ssl_c_sig_alg : string
20925 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20926 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20927 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020929ssl_c_used : boolean
20930 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
20931 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020933ssl_c_verify : integer
20934 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
20935 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
20936 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
20937 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020939ssl_c_version : integer
20940 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
20941 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020942
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010020943ssl_f_der : binary
20944 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
20945 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20946 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20947
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020948ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020949 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20950 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20951 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20952 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020953 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020954 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20955 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20956 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020957 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20958 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20959 LDAP v3.
20960 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20961 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020963ssl_f_key_alg : string
20964 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20965 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
20966 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020968ssl_f_notafter : string
20969 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
20970 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20971 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020973ssl_f_notbefore : string
20974 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
20975 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20976 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020977
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020978ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020979 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20980 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20981 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20982 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20983 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20984 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20985 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20986 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020987 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20988 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20989 LDAP v3.
20990 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20991 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020993ssl_f_serial : binary
20994 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
20995 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20996 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020997
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020020998ssl_f_sha1 : binary
20999 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
21000 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
21001 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
21002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021003ssl_f_sig_alg : string
21004 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
21005 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
21006 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020021007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021008ssl_f_version : integer
21009 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
21010 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
21011
21012ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021013 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
21014 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
21015 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
21016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021017 Example :
21018 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
21019 listen http-https
21020 bind :80
21021 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
21022 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
21023
21024ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
21025 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
21026 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
21027
21028ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021029 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021030 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021031 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021032 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
21033 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
21034 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
21035 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
21036 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
21037 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
21038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021039ssl_fc_cipher : string
21040 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
21041 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020021042
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021043ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
21044 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
21045 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021046 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021047 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21048 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
21049 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021050
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021051 Example:
21052 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21053 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21054 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21055 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21056 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21057 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21058 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21059 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21060 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21061
21062ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021063 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021064 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021065 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
21066 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021067 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
21068 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021069
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021070ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021071 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021072 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021073 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021074 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21075 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
21076 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
21077 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
21078 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
21079 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021080
21081ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021082 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021083 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
21084 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021085
21086ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
21087 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
21088 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021089 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021090
21091 Example:
21092 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21093 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21094 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21095 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21096 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21097 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21098 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21099 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21100 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21101
21102ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
21103 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
21104 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021105 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021106 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21107 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
21108 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
21109
21110 Example:
21111 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21112 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21113 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21114 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21115 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21116 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21117 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21118 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21119 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21120
21121ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
21122 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
21123 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021124 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021125 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21126 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
21127 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
21128
21129 Example:
21130 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21131 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21132 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21133 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21134 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21135 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21136 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21137 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21138 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021139
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040021140ssl_fc_client_random : binary
21141 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
21142 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
21143 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
21144
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020021145ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
21146 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21147 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21148 transport layer.
21149 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21150 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21151 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21152 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21153
21154ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
21155 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21156 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21157 transport layer.
21158 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21159 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21160 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21161 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21162
21163ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
21164 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
21165 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21166 transport layer.
21167 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21168 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21169 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21170 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21171
21172ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
21173 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21174 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21175 transport layer.
21176 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21177 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21178 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21179 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21180
21181ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
21182 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21183 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
21184 transport layer.
21185 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21186 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21187 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21188 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21189
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021190ssl_fc_err : integer
21191 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21192 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
21193 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
21194 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
21195 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
21196 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
21197 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
21198 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
21199 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
21200 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
21201 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
21202 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
21203 codes.
21204
21205ssl_fc_err_str : string
21206 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21207 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
21208 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
21209 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
21210 also "ssl_fc_err".
21211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021212ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021213 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
21214 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010021215 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
21216 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
21217 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
21218 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021219
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020021220ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
21221 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
21222 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
21223 wait until the handshake happened.
21224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021225ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
21226 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020021227 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
21228 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021229 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020021230 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020021231
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020021232ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020021233 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010021234 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
21235 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020021236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021237ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021238 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021239 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021240 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
21241 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
21242 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
21243 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
21244 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
21245 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020021246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021247ssl_fc_protocol : string
21248 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
21249 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020021250
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021251ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
21252 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
21253 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021254 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
21255 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021256
21257 Example:
21258 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21259 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21260 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21261 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21262 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21263 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21264 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21265 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21266 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21267
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020021268ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040021269 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020021270 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010021271 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040021272
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020021273ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
21274 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21275 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21276 transport layer.
21277 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21278 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21279 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21280 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21281
21282ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
21283 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
21284 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
21285 transport layer.
21286 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21287 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21288 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21289 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21290
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040021291ssl_fc_server_random : binary
21292 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
21293 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
21294 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
21295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021296ssl_fc_session_id : binary
21297 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
21298 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
21299 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
21300 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020021301
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040021302ssl_fc_session_key : binary
21303 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
21304 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
21305 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
21306 BoringSSL.
21307
21308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021309ssl_fc_sni : string
21310 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
21311 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021312 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021313 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
21314 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
21315
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021316 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021317 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021318 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021319 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020021320 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021321
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010021322 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
21323 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
21324 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
21325 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
21326 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
21327 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
21328 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
21329 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
21330 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
21331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021332 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021333 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
21334 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020021335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021336ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
21337 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
21338 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021339
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021340ssl_s_der : binary
21341 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
21342 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21343 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
21344
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020021345ssl_s_chain_der : binary
21346 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
21347 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21348 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050021349 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020021350 does not support resumed sessions.
21351
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021352ssl_s_key_alg : string
21353 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
21354 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
21355 SSL/TLS transport layer.
21356
21357ssl_s_notafter : string
21358 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
21359 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21360 transport layer.
21361
21362ssl_s_notbefore : string
21363 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
21364 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21365 transport layer.
21366
21367ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
21368 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21369 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
21370 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21371 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21372 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21373 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020021374 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21375 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021376 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21377 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21378 LDAP v3.
21379 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21380 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
21381
21382ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
21383 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21384 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
21385 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21386 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21387 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21388 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020021389 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21390 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021391 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21392 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21393 LDAP v3.
21394 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21395 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
21396
21397ssl_s_serial : binary
21398 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
21399 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21400 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
21401
21402ssl_s_sha1 : binary
21403 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
21404 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
21405 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
21406
21407ssl_s_sig_alg : string
21408 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
21409 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
21410 layer.
21411
21412ssl_s_version : integer
21413 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
21414 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021415
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200214167.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021417------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021419Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
21420sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
21421only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
21422For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
21423be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
21424can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
21425sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
21426for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
21427content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021428
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010021429Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
21430 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021431 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010021432 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
21433 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
21434 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
21435 sample expression). So be careful.
21436
Willy Tarreau3ec14612022-03-10 10:39:58 +010021437distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
21438 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
21439 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
21440 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
21441 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
21442 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
21443 list of supported tokens.
21444
21445distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
21446 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
21447 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
21448 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
21449 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
21450 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
21451 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
21452 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
21453 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
21454 supported tokens.
21455
21456 Example :
21457 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
21458 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
21459 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
21460 # send large files to the big farm
21461 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
21462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021463payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021464 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021465 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
21466 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021468payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
21469 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021470 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021471 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021473req.len : integer
21474req_len : integer (deprecated)
21475 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
21476 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
21477 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
21478 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
21479 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021480 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021481 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
21482 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021484req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
21485 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021486 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
21487 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
21488 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
21489 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021490
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021491 ACL derivatives :
21492 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021494req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
21495 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
21496 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
21497 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
21498 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021499
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021500 ACL derivatives :
21501 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021503 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021505req.proto_http : boolean
21506req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
21507 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
21508 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
21509 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
21510 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
21511 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
21512 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
21513 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021515 Example:
21516 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
21517 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
21518 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020021519 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021521req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
21522rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21523 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
21524 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
21525 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
21526 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
21527 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
21528 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
21529 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021531 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
21532 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
21533 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
21534 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
21535 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
21536 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021538 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021539 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021541 Example :
21542 listen tse-farm
21543 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
21544 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
21545 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
21546 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
21547 # apply RDP cookie persistence
21548 persist rdp-cookie
21549 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
21550 # This is only useful makes sense if
21551 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
21552 stick-table type string size 204800
21553 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
21554 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
21555 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021557 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021558 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021560req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
21561rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
21562 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
21563 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
21564 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
21565 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021567 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021568 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021569
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021570req.ssl_alpn : string
21571 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
21572 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
21573 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
21574 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
21575 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
21576 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021577 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021578
21579 Examples :
21580 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21581 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021582 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021583 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021584 default_backend bk_default
21585
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021586req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
21587 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
21588 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020021589 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
21590 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
21591 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
21592 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
21593 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021595req.ssl_hello_type : integer
21596req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21597 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21598 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
21599 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21600 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21601 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
21602 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21603 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021605req.ssl_sni : string
21606req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
21607 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
21608 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
21609 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
21610 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21611 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020021612 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
21613 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
21614 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
21615 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
21616 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
21617 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
21618 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
21619 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
21620 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021622 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021623 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021625 Examples :
21626 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21627 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021628 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021629 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021630 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021631
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053021632req.ssl_st_ext : integer
21633 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
21634 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
21635 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
21636 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
21637 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
21638 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
21639 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
21640 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
21641 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
21642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021643req.ssl_ver : integer
21644req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
21645 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
21646 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
21647 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
21648 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
21649 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21650 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
21651 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021652 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021653 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021655 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021656 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021657
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021658res.len : integer
21659 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
21660 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
21661 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
21662 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
21663 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021664 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021665 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021666 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021668res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
21669 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021670 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021671 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021672 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021673 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021675res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
21676 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
21677 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
21678 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021679 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
21680 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021682 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021683
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020021684res.ssl_hello_type : integer
21685rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21686 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21687 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
21688 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21689 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21690 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
21691 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21692 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
21693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021694wait_end : boolean
21695 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
21696 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021697 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021698 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
21699 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021700 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021701 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
21702 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021704 Examples :
21705 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
21706 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
21707 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021709 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
21710 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
21711 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
21712 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
21713 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
21714 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
21715 tcp-request content reject
21716
21717
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200217187.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021719--------------------------------------
21720
21721It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
21722This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
21723data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
21724its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
21725HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
21726content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
21727to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
21728more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
21729response are indexed.
21730
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010021731Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
21732 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
21733 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
21734 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
21735 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
21736 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
21737 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
21738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021739base : string
21740 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21741 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
21742 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
21743 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
21744 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
21745 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
21746 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
21747 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
21748
21749 ACL derivatives :
21750 base : exact string match
21751 base_beg : prefix match
21752 base_dir : subdir match
21753 base_dom : domain match
21754 base_end : suffix match
21755 base_len : length match
21756 base_reg : regex match
21757 base_sub : substring match
21758
21759base32 : integer
21760 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
21761 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
21762 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020021763 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
21764 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
21765 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021766
21767base32+src : binary
21768 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
21769 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
21770 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
21771 per-URL counters.
21772
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010021773baseq : string
21774 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21775 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
21776 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
21777 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
21778
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021779capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
21780 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
21781 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21782 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
21783
21784capture.req.method : string
21785 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
21786 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
21787 because it's allocated.
21788
21789capture.req.uri : string
21790 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
21791 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
21792 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
21793 allocated.
21794
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021795capture.req.ver : string
21796 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21797 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
21798 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
21799
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021800capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
21801 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
21802 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21803 The first entry is an index of 0.
21804 See also: "capture response header"
21805
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021806capture.res.ver : string
21807 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21808 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
21809 persistent flag.
21810
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021811req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021812 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
21813 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
21814 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021815
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040021816req.body_param([<name>[,i]]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020021817 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
21818 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
21819 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
21820 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040021821 case-sensitive, unless "i" is added as a second argument. If no name is
21822 given, any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The
21823 result is a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as
21824 presented in the request body (no URL decoding is performed). Note that the
21825 ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will
21826 iteratively report all parameters values if no name is given.
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020021827
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021828req.body_len : integer
21829 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
21830 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021831 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
21832 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021833
21834req.body_size : integer
21835 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021836 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
21837 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021839req.cook([<name>]) : string
21840cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21841 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21842 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
21843 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
21844 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
21845 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
21846 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
21847 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
21848 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
21849
21850 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021851 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
21852 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
21853 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
21854 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
21855 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
21856 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
21857 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
21858 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021860req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21861cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21862 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
21863 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021865req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
21866cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21867 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21868 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
21869 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
21870 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021872cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21873 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21874 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
21875 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
21876 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020021877 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021878 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
21879 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
21880 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
21881 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021883hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
21884 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
21885 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
21886 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
21887 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021888 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021890req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021891 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
21892 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
21893 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
21894 with headers such as User-Agent.
21895
21896 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
21897 found.
21898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021899 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
21900 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
21901 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021902 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021904req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21905 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
21906 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021907 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
21908 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021910req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021911 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
21912 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
21913 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
21914 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
21915 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
21916 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
21917 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
21918
21919 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
21920 found.
21921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021922 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
21923 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
21924 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021925 with -1 being the last one.
21926
21927 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
21928 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021930 ACL derivatives :
21931 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
21932 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
21933 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
21934 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
21935 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
21936 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
21937 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
21938 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
21939
21940req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21941hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
21942 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
21943 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021944 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
21945 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
21946 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
21947
21948 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
21949 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
21950 which contain more than one of certain headers.
21951
21952 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021953
21954req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
21955hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
21956 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
21957 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
21958 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010021959 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
21960 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
21961 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
21962 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
21963 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021964
21965 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
21966
21967 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021968
21969req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
21970hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
21971 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
21972 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
21973 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021974
21975 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
21976
21977 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021978
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010021979req.hdrs : string
21980 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
21981 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
21982 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
21983 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
21984
21985req.hdrs_bin : binary
21986 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
21987 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
21988 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
21989 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
21990 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
21991 names and values (length of 0 for both).
21992
21993 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010021994
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010021995 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
21996 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010021997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021998http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
21999 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
22000 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
22001 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
22002 basic auth is supported.
22003
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020022004http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
22005 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
22006 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
22007 performed on the data sent by the client.
22008 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
22009 Authorization one.
22010
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010022011http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
22012 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
22013 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
22014 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
22015 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022016 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
22017 basic auth is supported.
22018
22019 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010022020 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
22021 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
22022 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
22023 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022024
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022025http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010022026 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
22027 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
22028 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022029
22030http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010022031 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
22032 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
22033 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022034
22035http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010022036 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
22037 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
22038 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022040http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020022041 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
22042 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022043 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
22044 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020022045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022046method : integer + string
22047 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
22048 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
22049 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
22050 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
22051 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
22052 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
22053 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022055 ACL derivatives :
22056 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022058 Example :
22059 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
22060 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
22061 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022063path : string
22064 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
22065 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
22066 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
22067 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
22068 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022069 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +020022070 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods. Please
22071 note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#' after the path) is strictly
22072 forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be rejected. However, if the frontend
22073 receiving the request has "option accept-invalid-http-request", then this
22074 fragment part will be accepted and will also appear in the path.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022076 ACL derivatives :
22077 path : exact string match
22078 path_beg : prefix match
22079 path_dir : subdir match
22080 path_dom : domain match
22081 path_end : suffix match
22082 path_len : length match
22083 path_reg : regex match
22084 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022085
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020022086pathq : string
22087 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
22088 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
22089 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
22090 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
22091 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +020022092 result in both cases. Please note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#'
22093 after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
22094 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
22095 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
22096 will also appear in the path.
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020022097
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010022098query : string
22099 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
22100 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
22101 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
22102 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022103 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010022104 which stops before the question mark.
22105
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010022106req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
22107 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
22108 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
22109 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
22110 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
22111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022112req.ver : string
22113req_ver : string (deprecated)
22114 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
William Lallemandbcb3d602023-09-04 16:49:59 +020022115 be useful for ACL. For logs use the "%HV" log variable. Some predefined ACL
22116 already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
22117
22118 Common values are "1.0", "1.1", "2.0" or "3.0".
22119
22120 In the case of http/2 and http/3, the value is not extracted from the HTTP
22121 version in the request line but is determined by the negociated protocol
22122 version.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022124 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022125 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020022126
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022127res.body : binary
22128 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
22129 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022130 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
22131
22132 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022133
22134res.body_len : integer
22135 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
22136 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022137 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
22138
22139 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022140
22141res.body_size : integer
22142 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
22143 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
22144 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
22145 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022146 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
22147
22148 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022149
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010022150res.cache_hit : boolean
22151 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
22152 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
22153
22154res.cache_name : string
22155 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
22156 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
22157 empty string.
22158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022159res.comp : boolean
22160 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
22161 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
22162 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022164res.comp_algo : string
22165 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
22166 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
22167 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022169res.cook([<name>]) : string
22170scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
22171 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
22172 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022173 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
22174
22175 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020022176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022177 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022178 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020022179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022180res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22181scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
22182 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
22183 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022184 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
22185
22186 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022188res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
22189scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
22190 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
22191 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022192 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
22193
22194 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022196res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022197 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
22198 on the headers within an HTTP response.
22199
22200 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
22201 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
22202
22203 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
22204
22205 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022207res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022208 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
22209 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22210
22211 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
22212 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
22213
22214 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022216res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
22217shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022218 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
22219 on the headers within an HTTP response.
22220
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050022221 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022222 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
22223
22224 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022226 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022227 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
22228 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
22229 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
22230 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
22231 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
22232 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
22233 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
22234 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022235
22236res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22237shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022238 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
22239 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22240
22241 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050022242 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022243
22244 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022246res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
22247shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022248 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
22249 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22250
22251 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
22252
22253 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022254
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010022255res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
22256 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
22257 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
22258 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022259 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
22260
22261 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010022262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022263res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
22264shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022265 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
22266 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22267
22268 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
22269
22270 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022271
22272res.hdrs : string
22273 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
22274 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
22275 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022276 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
22277
22278 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022279
22280res.hdrs_bin : binary
22281 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
22282 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
22283 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
22284 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
22285 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
22286 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
22287 (length of 0 for both).
22288
22289 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
22290
22291 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
22292 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010022293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022294res.ver : string
22295resp_ver : string (deprecated)
22296 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022297 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
22298
22299 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020022300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022301 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022302 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010022303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022304set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
22305 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
22306 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020022307 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022308 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022310 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
22311 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022313status : integer
22314 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
22315 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022316 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
22317
22318 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022319
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020022320unique-id : string
22321 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
22322 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
22323 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
22324 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
22325 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
22326 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
22327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022328url : string
22329 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
22330 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
22331 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
22332 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
22333 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
22334 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +020022335 also "path" and "base". Please note that any fragment reference in the URI
22336 ('#' after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
22337 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
22338 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
22339 will also appear in the url.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022341 ACL derivatives :
22342 url : exact string match
22343 url_beg : prefix match
22344 url_dir : subdir match
22345 url_dom : domain match
22346 url_end : suffix match
22347 url_len : length match
22348 url_reg : regex match
22349 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022351url_ip : ip
22352 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
22353 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
22354 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
22355 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020022356 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
22357 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022359url_port : integer
22360 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020022361 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022362
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022363urlp([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : string
22364url_param([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022365 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
22366 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022367 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive, unless"i" is added as a
22368 third argument. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
22369 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
22370 parameter <name> as presented in the request (no URL decoding is performed).
22371 This can be used for session stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an
22372 application cookie passed as a URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks.
22373 Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and
22374 will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022376 ACL derivatives :
22377 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
22378 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
22379 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
22380 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
22381 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
22382 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
22383 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
22384 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022385
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022387 Example :
22388 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
22389 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
22390 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
22391 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022392
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022393urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022394 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
22395 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
22396 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020022397
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020022398url32 : integer
22399 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
22400 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
22401 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
22402 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
22403 is an unsigned integer.
22404
22405url32+src : binary
22406 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
22407 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
22408 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
22409
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020022410
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200224117.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022412---------------------------------------
22413
22414This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
22415used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
22416purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
22417There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
22418or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
22419any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
22420for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
22421
22422internal.htx.data : integer
22423 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
22424 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22425
22426internal.htx.free : integer
22427 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
22428 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22429
22430internal.htx.free_data : integer
22431 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
22432 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22433
22434internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010022435 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
22436 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
22437 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022438
22439internal.htx.nbblks : integer
22440 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
22441 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22442
22443internal.htx.size : integer
22444 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
22445 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22446
22447internal.htx.used : integer
22448 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
22449 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22450 direction.
22451
22452internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
22453 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22454 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
22455 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
22456 of the special value :
22457 * head : The oldest inserted block
22458 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022459 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022460
22461internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
22462 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22463 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
22464 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
22465 integer or one of the special value :
22466 * head : The oldest inserted block
22467 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022468 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022469
22470internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
22471 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22472 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
22473 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22474 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22475
22476 * head : The oldest inserted block
22477 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022478 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022479
22480internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
22481 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
22482 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
22483 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22484 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22485
22486 * head : The oldest inserted block
22487 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022488 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022489
22490internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
22491 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
22492 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
22493 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22494 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22495
22496 * head : The oldest inserted block
22497 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022498 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022499
22500internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
22501 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
22502 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
22503 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22504 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22505
22506 * head : The oldest inserted block
22507 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022508 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022509
22510internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
22511 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
22512 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
22513 it returns false.
22514
22515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200225167.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022517---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022518
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022519Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
22520every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020022521order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022523ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022524---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
22525FALSE always_false never match
22526HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
22527HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
22528HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010022529HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022530HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
22531HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
22532HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
22533HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020022534LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022535METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
22536METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
22537METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
22538METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
22539METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
22540METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
22541METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
22542METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
22543RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
22544REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
22545TRUE always_true always match
22546WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
22547---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022548
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010022549
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225508. Logging
22551----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022552
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022553One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
22554provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
22555very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
22556provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
22557state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022558to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022559headers.
22560
22561In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
22562about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
22563send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
22564
22565 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
22566 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
22567 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
22568 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
22569 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022570 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060022571 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022572
22573The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
22574allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
22575as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
22576while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
22577real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
22578delay.
22579
22580
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225818.1. Log levels
22582---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022583
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022584TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022585source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022586HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
22587in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
22588track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
22589syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
22590about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022591
22592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225938.2. Log formats
22594----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022595
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022596HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022597and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
22598slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
22599options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022600
22601 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
22602 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
22603 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
22604 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
22605 extents.
22606
22607 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
22608 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
22609 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
22610 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
22611 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
22612
22613 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
22614 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
22615 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
22616 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
22617 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
22618
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020022619 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
22620 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
22621 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
22622 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
22623
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022624 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
22625
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022626Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
22627specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
22628field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
22629servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
22630always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
22631identifier.
22632
22633Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
22634 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
22635 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
22636 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
22637 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
22638
22639
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226408.2.1. Default log format
22641-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022642
22643This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
22644as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
22645format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
22646
22647 Example :
22648 listen www
22649 mode http
22650 log global
22651 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22652
22653 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
22654 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
22655 (www/HTTP)
22656
22657 Field Format Extract from the example above
22658 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
22659 2 'Connect from' Connect from
22660 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
22661 4 'to' to
22662 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
22663 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
22664
22665Detailed fields description :
22666 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
22667 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
22668 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
22669 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
22670 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22671 and processed the connection.
22672 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
22673
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022674In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
22675"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
22676connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
22677
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022678It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
22679will eventually disappear.
22680
22681
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226828.2.2. TCP log format
22683---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022684
22685The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
22686is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
22687information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
22688counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
22689emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
22690environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
22691the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
22692sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022693specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022694not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
22695
22696The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22697exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022698if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable can be used instead.
22699Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022700
22701 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
22702 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
22703 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022704 # or using the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable
22705 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022706
22707A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
22708are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022709
22710 Example :
22711 frontend fnt
22712 mode tcp
22713 option tcplog
22714 log global
22715 default_backend bck
22716
22717 backend bck
22718 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22719
22720 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
22721 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
22722 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
22723
22724 Field Format Extract from the example above
22725 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
22726 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
22727 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
22728 4 frontend_name fnt
22729 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
22730 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
22731 7 bytes_read* 212
22732 8 termination_state --
22733 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
22734 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22735
22736Detailed fields description :
22737 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022738 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022739 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22740 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022741 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022742 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022743 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022744
22745 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022746 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22747 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22748 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022749
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022750 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022751 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
22752 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022753 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
22754 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
22755 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
22756 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022757
22758 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22759 and processed the connection.
22760
22761 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
22762 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
22763 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
22764 applications.
22765
22766 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
22767 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
22768 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
22769 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
22770 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
22771
22772 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
22773 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
22774 See "Timers" below for more details.
22775
22776 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
22777 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
22778 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
22779 "Timers" below for more details.
22780
22781 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022782 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022783 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
22784 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
22785 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
22786 details.
22787
22788 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
22789 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
22790 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
22791 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
22792 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
22793
22794 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
22795 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
22796 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
22797 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
22798 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
22799 for more details.
22800
22801 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022802 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022803 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
22804 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
22805 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022806 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022807
22808 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
22809 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
22810 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
22811 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
22812 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
22813 caused by a denial of service attack.
22814
22815 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
22816 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
22817 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
22818 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
22819 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
22820 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
22821 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
22822 denial of service attack.
22823
22824 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
22825 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
22826 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
22827 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
22828 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
22829 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
22830 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
22831 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
22832 be processed than on other servers.
22833
22834 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
22835 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
22836 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
22837 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022838 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022839 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
22840 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
22841 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
22842 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
22843 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
22844 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
22845 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
22846 should not be attributed to the logged server.
22847
22848 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22849 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
22850 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
22851 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
22852 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
22853 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022854 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022855 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
22856
22857 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22858 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
22859 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
22860 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
22861 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
22862 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022863 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022864 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
22865 occurs.
22866
22867
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228688.2.3. HTTP log format
22869----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022870
22871The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
22872is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
22873the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
22874are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
22875emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
22876generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
22877"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
22878which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022879frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
22880is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022881
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022882The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22883exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022884if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable can be used
22885instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022886
22887 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
22888 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
22889 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
22890
22891And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
22892this exact string:
22893
22894 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
22895 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
22896 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
22897 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022898 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable
22899 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022900
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022901Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
22902slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
22903with a star ('*') after the field name below.
22904
22905 Example :
22906 frontend http-in
22907 mode http
22908 option httplog
22909 log global
22910 default_backend bck
22911
22912 backend static
22913 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22914
22915 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
22916 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
22917 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022918 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022919
22920 Field Format Extract from the example above
22921 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
22922 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022923 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022924 4 frontend_name http-in
22925 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022926 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022927 7 status_code 200
22928 8 bytes_read* 2750
22929 9 captured_request_cookie -
22930 10 captured_response_cookie -
22931 11 termination_state ----
22932 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
22933 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22934 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
22935 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
22936 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022937
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022938Detailed fields description :
22939 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022940 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022941 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22942 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022943 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022944 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022945 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022946
22947 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022948 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22949 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22950 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022951
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022952 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022953 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022954
22955 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22956 and processed the connection.
22957
22958 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
22959 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
22960 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
22961
22962 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
22963 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
22964 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
22965 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
22966 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
22967 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
22968
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022969 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
22970 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
22971 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022972 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022973 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
22974 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022975 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022976 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022977
22978 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
22979 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022980 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022981
22982 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
22983 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022984 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
22985 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022986
22987 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
22988 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
22989 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
22990 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
22991 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022992 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
22993 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022994
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022995 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022996 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
22997 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
22998 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
22999 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
23000 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
23001 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023002 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023003
23004 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023005 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
23006 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023007
23008 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
23009 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050023010 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023011 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
23012 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
23013 overflowing.
23014
23015 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
23016 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
23017 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
23018 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
23019 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
23020 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
23021 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
23022 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
23023
23024 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
23025 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
23026 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
23027 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
23028 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
23029 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
23030 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
23031 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
23032
23033 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
23034 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
23035 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
23036 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
23037 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
23038 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
23039 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
23040
23041 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023042 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023043 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
23044 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
23045 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023046 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023047 system.
23048
23049 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
23050 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
23051 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
23052 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
23053 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
23054 caused by a denial of service attack.
23055
23056 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
23057 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
23058 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
23059 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
23060 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
23061 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
23062 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
23063 denial of service attack.
23064
23065 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
23066 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
23067 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
23068 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
23069 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
23070 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
23071 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
23072 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
23073 processed than on other servers.
23074
23075 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
23076 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
23077 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
23078 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023079 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023080 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
23081 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
23082 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
23083 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
23084 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
23085 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
23086 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
23087 should not be attributed to the logged server.
23088
23089 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
23090 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
23091 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
23092 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
23093 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
23094 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023095 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023096 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
23097
23098 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
23099 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
23100 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
23101 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
23102 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
23103 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023104 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023105 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
23106 occurs.
23107
23108 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
23109 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
23110 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
23111 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
23112 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
23113 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
23114 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
23115 cookies" below for more details.
23116
23117 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
23118 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
23119 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
23120 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
23121 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
23122 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
23123 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
23124 and cookies" below for more details.
23125
23126 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
23127 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
23128 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
23129 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
23130 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
23131 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
23132 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
23133 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
23134
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023135
231368.2.4. HTTPS log format
23137----------------------
23138
23139The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
23140extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
23141information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
23142frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
23143end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
23144matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
23145sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
23146dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
23147"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
23148
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023149The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
23150exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010023151if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable can be used
23152instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023153
23154 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
23155 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
23156 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
23157 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023158 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010023159 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable
23160 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023161
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023162This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
23163appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
23164HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023165
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023166 Example :
23167 frontend https-in
23168 mode http
23169 option httpslog
23170 log global
23171 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
23172 default_backend bck
23173
23174 backend static
23175 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
23176
23177 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
23178 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
23179 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023180 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
23181 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023182
23183 Field Format Extract from the example above
23184 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
23185 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
23186 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
23187 4 frontend_name https-in
23188 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
23189 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
23190 7 status_code 200
23191 8 bytes_read* 2750
23192 9 captured_request_cookie -
23193 10 captured_response_cookie -
23194 11 termination_state ----
23195 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
23196 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
23197 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
23198 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
23199 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010023200 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020023201 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023202 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
23203 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023204
23205Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010023206 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
23207 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
23208 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023209
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020023210 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
23211 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
23212 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050023213 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020023214 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023215
23216 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
23217 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
23218 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
23219 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
23220
23221 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
23222 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
23223 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
23224 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
23225
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020023226 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
23227 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
23228 can be shared by multiple requests.
23229
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023230 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
23231 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
23232 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
23233 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
23234 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
23235
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023236 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
23237
23238 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
23239
23240
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100232418.2.5. Error log format
23242-----------------------
23243
23244When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
23245protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
23246unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
23247line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
23248"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
23249will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
23250logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
23251
23252The default format looks like this :
23253
23254 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
23255 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
23256 Connection error during SSL handshake
23257
23258 Field Format Extract from the example above
23259 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
23260 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
23261 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
23262 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
23263 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
23264
23265These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
23266failures.
23267
23268By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
23269above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
23270defined format.
23271
23272An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
23273source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
23274number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
23275internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
23276error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
23277the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
23278certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
23279indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
23280indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
23281ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
23282are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
23283would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
23284regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
23285
23286 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010023287 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010023288 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
23289 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
23290
23291
232928.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023293------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023294
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023295When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
23296ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
23297a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
23298formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
23299looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
23300and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023301
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023302HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023303Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
23304separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
23305prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
23306
23307Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
23308variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023309("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023310
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010023311If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020023312as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010023313less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
23314the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
23315
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020023316Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
23317"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
23318delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
23319preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023320
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023321Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
23322'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
23323https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
23324such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
23325
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023326Flags are :
23327 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023328 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023329 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
23330 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023331
23332 Example:
23333
23334 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
23335 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
23336
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023337 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
23338
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023339Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
23340
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023341 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023342 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023343 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
23344 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
23345 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023346 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
23347 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
23348 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023349 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000023350 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000023351 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000023352 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000023353 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000023354 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
23355 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010023356 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020023357 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023358 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010023359 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023360 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020023361 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080023362 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023363 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
23364 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
23365 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
23366 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
23367 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023368 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023369 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023370 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023371 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023372 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023373 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
23374 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023375 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
23376 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
23377 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023378 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023379 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
23380 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023381 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023382 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
23383 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
23384 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020023385 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020023386 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020023387 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
23388 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
23389 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
23390 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020023391 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023392 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023393 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023394 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010023395 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023396 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023397 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
23398 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
23399 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023400 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023401 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
23402 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023403 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023404 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
23405 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020023406 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023407 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023408 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023409 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023410
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023411 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023412
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010023413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200234148.3. Advanced logging options
23415-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023416
23417Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
23418just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
23419options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
23420for more information about their usage.
23421
23422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200234238.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
23424------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023425
23426It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023427HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023428commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
23429monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
23430ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
23431
23432 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
23433 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
23434 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
23435 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
23436
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020023437 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
23438 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023439
23440 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
23441 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
23442 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
23443
23444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200234458.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
23446----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023447
23448The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
23449what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
23450or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023451"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023452just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
23453log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
23454after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
23455is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
23456with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
23457with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
23458
23459
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200234608.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
23461------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023462
23463Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
23464for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
23465"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
23466retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
23467raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
23468a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
23469file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
23470you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
23471"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
23472
23473
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200234748.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
23475--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023476
23477Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
23478multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
23479them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
23480"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
23481logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
23482error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
23483and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
23484too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
23485useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
23486alternative.
23487
23488
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200234898.4. Timing events
23490------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023491
23492Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
23493reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
23494the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
23495frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023496mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
23497addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
23498
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010023499Timings events in HTTP mode:
23500
23501 first request 2nd request
23502 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
23503 t tr t tr ...
23504 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
23505 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
23506 :<---- Tq ---->: :
23507 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023508 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010023509 :<--------- Ta --------->:
23510
23511Timings events in TCP mode:
23512
23513 TCP session
23514 |<----------------->|
23515 t t
23516 ---|----|----|----|----|---
23517 | Th Tw Tc Td |
23518 |<------ Tt ------->|
23519
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023520 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023521 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023522 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
23523 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
23524 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023525 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023526 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
23527 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
23528 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
23529 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023530
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023531 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
23532 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
23533 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023534 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
23535 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
23536 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
23537 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
23538 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
23539 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023540
23541 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
23542 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
23543 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
23544 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
23545 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
23546 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
23547 request typed by hand during a test.
23548
23549 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
23550 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023551 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023552 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
23553 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
23554 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
23555 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023556
23557 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
23558 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
23559 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
23560 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
23561 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
23562
23563 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
23564 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
23565 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
23566 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
23567 connection never established.
23568
23569 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
23570 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
23571 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
23572 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
23573 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
23574 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
23575 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
23576 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
23577 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
23578 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
23579 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
23580
William Lallemand14894192023-07-25 09:06:51 +020023581 - Td: this is the total transfer time of the response payload till the last
23582 byte sent to the client. In HTTP it starts after the last response header
23583 (after Tr).
23584
23585 The data sent are not guaranteed to be received by the client, they can be
23586 stuck in either the kernel or the network.
23587
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023588 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
23589 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
23590 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
23591 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
23592 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
23593 by subtracting other timers when valid :
23594
23595 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
23596
23597 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
23598 "Ta" can never be negative.
23599
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023600 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
23601 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023602 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
23603 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023604 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023605
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023606 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023607
23608 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023609 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
23610 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023611
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023612 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
23613 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
23614 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
23615 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
23616 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
23617 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
23618 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
23619 prefixed with a '+' sign.
23620
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023621These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
23622protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
23623that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023624due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
23625"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
23626that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023627
23628Most common cases :
23629
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023630 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
23631 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
23632 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
23633 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
23634 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023635 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023636 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
23637 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
23638 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
23639 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
23640 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020023641 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023642
23643 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
23644 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
23645 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
23646 of ms on remote networks.
23647
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020023648 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
23649 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
23650 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023651
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023652 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
23653 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023654 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023655 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
23656 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
23657 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
23658 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
23659 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
23660 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023661
23662Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
23663
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023664 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023665 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023666 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023667
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023668 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023669 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
23670 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
23671
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023672 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023673 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
23674 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
23675 flags.
23676
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023677 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
23678 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023679 Check the session termination flags, then check the
23680 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
23681 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
23682 the client connection was maintained open.
23683
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023684 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023685 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023686 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023687 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
23688
23689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236908.5. Session state at disconnection
23691-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023692
23693TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
23694"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
236952-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
23696each of which has a special meaning :
23697
23698 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
23699 session to terminate :
23700
23701 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
23702
23703 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
23704 server explicitly refused it.
23705
23706 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
23707 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
23708 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
23709 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023710 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023711
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023712 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023713 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023714
23715 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
23716 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
23717 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
23718 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
23719 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
23720
23721 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
23722 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
23723 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
23724 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
23725 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
23726
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023727 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090023728 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
23729
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023730 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070023731 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
23732 backup connections when going up.
23733
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023734 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020023735
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023736 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
23737 send or receive data.
23738
23739 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
23740 send or receive data.
23741
23742 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
23743 with nothing left in the buffers.
23744
23745 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
23746
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010023747 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023748 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
23749
23750 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
23751 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
23752 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
23753 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
23754 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
23755
23756 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
23757 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
23758
23759 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
23760 server (HTTP only).
23761
23762 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
23763
23764 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
23765 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
23766 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
23767
23768 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
23769 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
23770 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
23771
23772 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
23773
23774 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
23775 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
23776
23777 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
23778 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
23779 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
23780
23781 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
23782 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020023783 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
23784 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023785
23786 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
23787 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
23788 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
23789 another server.
23790
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023791 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023792 server.
23793
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023794 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
23795 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
23796 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
23797 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23798
23799 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
23800 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
23801 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
23802 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23803
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020023804 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
23805 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
23806 "use-server" rule).
23807
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023808 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
23809
23810 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
23811 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
23812
23813 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
23814
23815 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
23816 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
23817 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
23818
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023819 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
23820 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023821 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023822 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
23823 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
23824
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023825 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
23826
23827 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
23828 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
23829
23830 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
23831
23832 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
23833
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023834The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
23835was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023836helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
23837starvation, attacks, etc...
23838
23839The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
23840alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
23841easier finding and understanding.
23842
23843 Flags Reason
23844
23845 -- Normal termination.
23846
23847 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023848 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
23849 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023850 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
23851
23852 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
23853 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023854 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
23855 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023856 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
23857 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023858
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023859 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
23860 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023861 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023862
23863 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
23864 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
23865 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
23866
23867 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
23868 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
23869 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
23870 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
23871 the server takes too long to respond.
23872
23873 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
23874 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
23875 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
23876 long a time to respond.
23877
23878 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
23879 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
23880 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023881 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023882 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
23883 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023884
23885 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
23886 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
23887 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
23888 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
23889 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020023890 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023891 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
23892 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
23893 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
23894 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
23895 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
23896 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
23897 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
23898 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023899 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023900 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
23901 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
23902 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023903
23904 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
23905 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020023906 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
23907 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
23908 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
23909 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023910
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023911 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023912 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
23913
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023914 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023915 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
23916 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023917 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023918 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
23919 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
23920
23921 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
23922 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
23923 503 or 504 here.
23924
23925 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023926 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023927 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
23928 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
23929 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
23930
23931 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
23932 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023933 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023934 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023935 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023936
23937 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
23938 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
23939 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
23940 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
23941 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
23942 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023943 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023944
23945 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
23946 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
23947 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
23948 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
23949 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
23950 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
23951 solution is to fix the application.
23952
23953 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
23954 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
23955 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
23956 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
23957 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
23958 external attacks.
23959
23960 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070023961 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023962 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023963 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
23964 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
23965
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023966 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
23967 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
23968 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023969 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020023970 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023971
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023972 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
23973 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
23974 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
23975 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023976 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
23977 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
23978 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
23979 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020023980 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
23981 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
23982 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
23983 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023984
23985 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
23986 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
23987 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020023988 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
23989 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
23990 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
23991 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023992
23993 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
23994 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
23995 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
23996 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
23997
23998 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
23999 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
24000 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
24001 only be solved by proper system tuning.
24002
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024003The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024004persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024005important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
24006re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
24007
24008 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
24009
24010 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
24011 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
24012 set on a GET request.
24013
24014 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
24015 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040024016 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024017 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
24018
24019 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
24020 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
24021 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
24022
24023 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
24024 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
24025 already got a cookie.
24026
24027 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
24028 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
24029 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
24030 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
24031 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
24032
24033 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
24034 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
24035 new cookie was inserted in the response.
24036
24037 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
24038 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
24039 new cookie was inserted in the response.
24040
24041 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
24042 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
24043
24044 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
24045 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
24046 then advertised in the response.
24047
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200240498.6. Non-printable characters
24050-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024051
24052In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
24053consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
24054converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
24055prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
24056being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
24057escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
24058is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
24059'}' when logging headers.
24060
24061Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
24062issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
24063containing spaces is "User-Agent".
24064
24065Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
24066the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
24067performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
24068
24069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200240708.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
24071---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024072
24073Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
24074achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024075section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024076cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
24077the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
24078the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024079locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024080not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
24081user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
24082a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
24083wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
24084
24085 Examples :
24086 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
24087 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
24088
24089 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
24090 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
24091
24092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200240938.8. Capturing HTTP headers
24094---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024095
24096Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
24097proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
24098the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
24099server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
24100
24101Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
24102response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024103section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024104
24105It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010024106time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
24107appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024108are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
24109and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
24110follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
24111request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
24112in the logs.
24113
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020024114As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
24115frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
24116an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
24117
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024118 Example :
24119 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
24120 listen proxy-out
24121 mode http
24122 option httplog
24123 option logasap
24124 log global
24125 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
24126
24127 # log the name of the virtual server
24128 capture request header Host len 20
24129
24130 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
24131 capture request header Content-Length len 10
24132
24133 # log the beginning of the referrer
24134 capture request header Referer len 20
24135
24136 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
24137 capture response header Server len 20
24138
24139 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
24140 capture response header Content-Length len 10
24141
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024142 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024143 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
24144
24145 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
24146 capture response header Via len 20
24147
24148 # log the URL location during a redirection
24149 capture response header Location len 20
24150
24151 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
24152 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
24153 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
24154 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
24155 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
24156
24157 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
24158 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
24159 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
24160 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024161 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024162
24163 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
24164 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
24165 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
24166 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
24167 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024168 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024169
24170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200241718.9. Examples of logs
24172---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024173
24174These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
24175them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
24176reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
24177
24178 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
24179 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
24180 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
24181
24182 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
24183 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
24184
24185 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
24186 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
24187 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
24188
24189 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
24190 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
24191
24192 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
24193 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
24194 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
24195
24196 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010024197 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024198 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
24199 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
24200
24201 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
24202 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
24203 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
24204
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020024205 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
24206 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
24207 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
24208 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024209 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020024210 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024211
24212 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024213 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024214
24215 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
24216 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
24217 Nothing was sent to any server.
24218
24219 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
24220 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
24221
24222 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
24223 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024224 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024225 send a 408 return code to the client.
24226
24227 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
24228 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
24229
24230 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
24231 5 seconds ("c----").
24232
24233 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
24234 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024235 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024236
24237 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024238 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024239 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
24240 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
24241 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
24242 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
24243 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010024244
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020024245
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200242469. Supported filters
24247--------------------
24248
24249Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
24250accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
24251unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
24252
24253See also : "filter"
24254
242559.1. Trace
24256----------
24257
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010024258filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024259
24260 Arguments:
24261 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
24262 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
24263
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010024264 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024265
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024266 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024267 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
24268 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
24269 amount of the parsed data.
24270
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024271 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010024272
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024273This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
24274callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
24275information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
24276filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
24277
24278Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
24279tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
24280a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
24281
24282
242839.2. HTTP compression
24284---------------------
24285
24286filter compression
24287
24288The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
24289keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024290when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
24291fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
24292done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
24293explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
24294filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
24295listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
24296order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024297
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024298See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
24299 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024300
24301
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200243029.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
24303--------------------------------------------
24304
24305filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
24306
24307 Arguments :
24308
24309 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
24310 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
24311 parsed.
24312
24313 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
24314 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
24315 part must be placed in its own scope.
24316
24317The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
24318external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024319streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020024320exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
24321also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
24322
24323SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
24324the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
24325
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010024326For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020024327"doc/SPOE.txt".
24328
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100243299.4. Cache
24330----------
24331
24332filter cache <name>
24333
24334 Arguments :
24335
24336 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
24337
24338The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
24339"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050024340cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024341other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
24342case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
24343is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
24344filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010024345listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
24346order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010024347
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024348See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
24349 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
24350
24351
243529.5. Fcgi-app
24353-------------
24354
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040024355filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024356
24357 Arguments :
24358
24359 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
24360
24361The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
24362request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
24363reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
24364used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
24365implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
24366used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
24367fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
24368used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
24369order.
24370
24371See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
24372 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
24373
24374
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100243759.6. OpenTracing
24376----------------
24377
24378The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
24379HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
24380of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
24381Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
24382
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024383This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024384
24385The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
24386HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
24387participates in the work of HAProxy.
24388
24389filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
24390
24391 Arguments :
24392
24393 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
24394 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
24395 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
24396 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
24397 OpenTracing filters.
24398
24399 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
24400 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
24401 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
24402 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
24403 filter must have its own scope defined.
24404
24405More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020024406of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024407
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +0200244089.7. Bandwidth limitation
24409--------------------------
24410
24411filter bwlim-in <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
24412filter bwlim-out <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
24413filter bwlim-in <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
24414filter bwlim-out <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
24415
24416 Arguments :
24417
24418 <name> is the filter name that will be used by 'set-bandwidth-limit'
24419 actions to reference a specific bandwidth limitation filter.
24420
24421 <size> is max number of bytes that can be forwarded over the period.
24422 The value must be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
24423 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
24424 expressed in bytes.
24425
24426 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
24427 describes what elements will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
24428 and used to select which table entry to update the counters. It
24429 must be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
24430
24431 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
24432 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. It can
24433 be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
24434
24435 <time> is the default time period used to evaluate the bandwidth
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050024436 limitation rate. It can be specified for per-stream bandwidth
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024437 limitation filters only. It follows the HAProxy time format and
24438 is expressed in milliseconds.
24439
24440 <min-size> is the optional minimum number of bytes forwarded at a time by
24441 a stream excluding the last packet that may be smaller. This
24442 value can be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
24443 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
24444 expressed in bytes.
24445
24446Bandwidth limitation filters should be used to restrict the data forwarding
24447speed at the stream level. By extension, such filters limit the network
24448bandwidth consumed by a resource. Several bandwidth limitation filters can be
24449used. For instance, it is possible to define a limit per source address to be
24450sure a client will never consume all the network bandwidth, thereby penalizing
24451other clients, and another one per stream to be able to fairly handle several
24452connections for a given client.
24453
24454The definition order of these filters is important. If several bandwidth
24455filters are enabled on a stream, the filtering will be applied in their
24456definition order. It is also important to understand the definition order of
24457the other filters have an influence. For instance, depending on the HTTP
24458compression filter is defined before or after a bandwidth limitation filter,
24459the limit will be applied on the compressed payload or not. The same is true
24460for the cache filter.
24461
24462There are two kinds of bandwidth limitation filters. The first one enforces a
24463default limit and is applied per stream. The second one uses a stickiness table
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050024464to enforce a limit equally divided between all streams sharing the same entry in
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024465the table.
24466
24467In addition, for a given filter, depending on the filter keyword used, the
24468limitation can be applied on incoming data, received from the client and
24469forwarded to a server, or on outgoing data, received from a server and sent to
24470the client. To apply a limit on incoming data, "bwlim-in" keyword must be
24471used. To apply it on outgoing data, "bwlim-out" keyword must be used. In both
24472cases, the bandwidth limitation is applied on forwarded data, at the stream
24473level.
24474
24475The bandwidth limitation is applied at the stream level and not at the
24476connection level. For multiplexed protocols (H2, H3 and FastCGI), the streams
24477of the same connection may have different limits.
24478
24479For a per-stream bandwidth limitation filter, default period and limit must be
24480defined. As their names suggest, they are the default values used to setup the
24481bandwidth limitation rate for a stream. However, for this kind of filter and
24482only this one, it is possible to redefine these values using sample expressions
24483when the filter is enabled with a TCP/HTTP "set-bandwidth-limit" action.
24484
24485For a shared bandwidth limitation filter, depending on whether it is applied on
24486incoming or outgoing data, the stickiness table used must store the
24487corresponding bytes rate information. "bytes_in_rate(<period>)" counter must be
24488stored to limit incoming data and "bytes_out_rate(<period>)" counter must be
24489used to limit outgoing data.
24490
24491Finally, it is possible to set the minimum number of bytes that a bandwidth
24492limitation filter can forward at a time for a given stream. It should be used
24493to not forward too small amount of data, to reduce the CPU usage. It must
24494carefully be defined. Too small, a value can increase the CPU usage. Too high,
24495it can increase the latency. It is also highly linked to the defined bandwidth
24496limit. If it is too close to the bandwidth limit, some pauses may be
24497experienced to not exceed the limit because too many bytes will be consumed at
24498a time. It is highly dependent on the filter configuration. A good idea is to
24499start with something around 2 TCP MSS, typically 2896 bytes, and tune it after
24500some experimentations.
24501
24502 Example:
24503 frontend http
24504 bind *:80
24505 mode http
24506
24507 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will share the download limit
24508 # of 10m/s with all other streams with the same source address.
24509 filter bwlim-out limit-by-src key src table limit-by-src limit 10m
24510
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050024511 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will be limited to download at 1m/s,
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024512 # independently of all other streams.
24513 filter bwlim-out limit-by-strm default-limit 1m default-period 1s
24514
24515 # Limit all streams to 1m/s (the default limit) and those accessing the
24516 # internal API to 100k/s. Limit each source address to 10m/s. The shared
24517 # limit is applied first. Both are limiting the download rate.
24518 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm
24519 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm limit 100k if { path_beg /internal }
24520 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-src
24521 ...
24522
24523 backend limit-by-src
24524 # The stickiness table used by <limit-by-src> filter
24525 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 3600s store bytes_out_rate(1s)
24526
24527See also : "tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit",
24528 "tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit",
24529 "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" and
24530 "http-response set-bandwidth-limit".
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024531
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002453210. FastCGI applications
24533-------------------------
24534
24535HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
24536feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
24537the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
24538FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
24539servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
24540FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
24541backend.
24542
24543HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
24544application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
24545connection.
24546
2454710.1. Setup
24548-----------
24549
2455010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
24551--------------------------
24552
24553fcgi-app <name>
24554 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
24555 document root must be defined.
24556
24557acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
24558 Declare or complete an access list.
24559
24560 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
24561 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
24562 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
24563 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
24564 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
24565
24566docroot <path>
24567 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
24568 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
24569 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
24570
24571index <script-name>
24572 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
24573 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
24574 is an optional setting.
24575
24576 Example :
24577 index index.php
24578
24579log-stderr global
24580log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010024581 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024582 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
24583
24584 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
24585 default STDERR messages are ignored.
24586
24587pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24588 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
24589 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
24590 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24591
24592 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
24593 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
24594 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
24595 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
24596
24597 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
24598 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
24599
24600path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024601 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024602 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
24603 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
24604 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
24605 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
24606 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
24607 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
24608 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024609
24610 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024611 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024612 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
24613 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
24614 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
24615 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024616
24617 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024618 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
24619 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024620
24621option get-values
24622no option get-values
24623 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
24624
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040024625 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024626 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
24627
24628 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
24629 application will accept.
24630
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020024631 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
24632 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024633
24634 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050024635 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024636 option is disabled.
24637
24638 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
24639 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
24640 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
24641 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
24642 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
24643 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
24644
24645option keep-conn
24646no option keep-conn
24647 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
24648 sending a response.
24649
24650 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
24651 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
24652
24653option max-reqs <reqs>
24654 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
24655 accept.
24656
24657 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
24658 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
24659 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
24660 to 1.
24661
24662option mpxs-conns
24663no option mpxs-conns
24664 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
24665
24666 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
24667 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
24668
24669set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24670 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
24671 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
24672 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
24673 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24674
24675 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
24676 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
24677 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
24678
24679 Example :
24680 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
24681 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
24682
24683 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
24684
24685
2468610.1.2. Proxy section
24687---------------------
24688
24689use-fcgi-app <name>
24690 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
24691
24692 Arguments :
24693 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
24694
24695 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
24696 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
24697 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
24698 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
24699 application may be defined at a time per backend.
24700
24701 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
24702 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
24703 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
24704 application are evaluated.
24705
24706
2470710.1.3. Example
24708---------------
24709
24710 frontend front-http
24711 mode http
24712 bind *:80
24713 bind *:
24714
24715 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
24716 default_backend back-static
24717
24718 backend back-static
24719 mode http
24720 server www A.B.C.D:80
24721
24722 backend back-dynamic
24723 mode http
24724 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
24725 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
24726
24727 fcgi-app php-fpm
24728 log-stderr global
24729 option keep-conn
24730
24731 docroot /var/www/my-app
24732 index index.php
24733 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
24734
24735
2473610.2. Default parameters
24737------------------------
24738
24739A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
24740the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024741script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024742applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
24743
24744 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24745 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
24746 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
24747 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
24748 | | |
24749 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24750 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
24751 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
24752 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
24753 | | application. |
24754 | | |
24755 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24756 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
24757 | | the request. It may not be set. |
24758 | | |
24759 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24760 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
24761 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
24762 | | the application's configuration. |
24763 | | |
24764 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24765 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
24766 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
24767 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
24768 | | |
24769 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24770 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
24771 | | following the part that identifies the script |
24772 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
24773 | | be defined. |
24774 | | |
24775 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24776 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
24777 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
24778 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
24779 | | is not set too. |
24780 | | |
24781 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24782 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
24783 | | set. |
24784 | | |
24785 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24786 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
24787 | | the request. |
24788 | | |
24789 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24790 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
24791 | | client as part of user authentication. |
24792 | | |
24793 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24794 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
24795 | | script to process the request. |
24796 | | |
24797 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24798 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
24799 | | |
24800 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24801 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
24802 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
24803 | | |
24804 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24805 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
24806 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
24807 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
24808 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
24809 | | |
24810 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24811 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
24812 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
24813 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
24814 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
24815 | | side. |
24816 | | |
24817 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24818 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
24819 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
24820 | | connected to. |
24821 | | |
24822 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24823 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
24824 | | |
24825 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020024826 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
24827 | | current HAProxy version. |
24828 | | |
24829 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024830 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
24831 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
24832 | | |
24833 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24834
24835
2483610.3. Limitations
24837------------------
24838
24839The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
24840way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
24841during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
24842establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
24843application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
24844or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
24845message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
24846these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
24847and HTTP servers under the same backend.
24848
24849Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
24850request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
24851requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
24852
24853About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
24854into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
24855fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
24856"http-request" ones.
24857
24858Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
24859FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
24860processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
24861must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
24862here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010024863
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024864
2486511. Address formats
24866-------------------
24867
24868Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
24869address.
24870
24871This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
24872The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
24873of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
24874equivalent is '::'.
24875
24876Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
24877is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
24878
24879This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
24880family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
24881
24882Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
24883configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
24884use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
24885'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
24886
24887Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
24888socket type and the transport method.
24889
24890
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002489111.1. Address family prefixes
24892-----------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024893
24894'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
24895
24896'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
24897 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
24898 listening.
24899
24900'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
24901 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
24902 on the statement using this address, a port or
24903 a port range may or must be specified.
24904
24905'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24906 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
24907 using this address, a port or a port range
24908 may or must be specified.
24909
24910'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24911 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
24912 using this address, a port or a port range
24913 may or must be specified.
24914
24915'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
24916 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
24917 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
24918 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
24919 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
24920 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
24921
24922'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
24923 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
24924 start by slash '/'.
24925
24926
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002492711.2. Socket type prefixes
24928--------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024929
24930Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
24931type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
24932this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
24933This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
24934but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
24935
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024936Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should instead use
24937use aliases of the next section "11.3 Protocol prefixes". However these can
24938sometimes be convenient, for example in combination with inherited sockets
24939known by their file descriptor number, in which case the address family is "fd"
24940and the socket type must be declared.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024941
24942If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
24943they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
24944report this to the maintainers.
24945
24946'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
24947 to "stream"
24948
24949'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
24950 to "datagram".
24951
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024952'quic+<family>@<address>' forces socket type to "datagram" and transport
24953 method to "stream".
24954
24955
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024956
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002495711.3. Protocol prefixes
24958-----------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024959
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010024960'quic4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24961 an IPv4 address but socket type is forced to
24962 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
24963 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
24964 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024965 must be specified. It is equivalent to
24966 "quic+ipv4@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010024967
24968'quic6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24969 an IPv6 address but socket type is forced to
24970 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
24971 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
24972 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024973 must be specified. It is equivalent to
24974 "quic+ipv6@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010024975
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024976'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
24977 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
24978 socket type and transport method is forced to
24979 "stream". Depending on the statement using
24980 this address, a port or a port range can or
24981 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
24982 of 'stream+ip@'.
24983
24984'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24985 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
24986 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
24987 statement using this address, a port or port
24988 range can or must be specified.
24989 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
24990
24991'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24992 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
24993 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
24994 statement using this address, a port or port
24995 range can or must be specified.
24996 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
24997
24998'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
24999 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
25000 socket type and transport method is forced to
25001 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
25002 this address, a port or a port range can or
25003 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
25004 of 'dgram+ip@'.
25005
25006'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25007 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
25008 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
25009 the statement using this address, a port or
25010 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010025011 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025012
25013'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25014 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
25015 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
25016 the statement using this address, a port or
25017 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010025018 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025019
25020'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
25021 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
25022 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
25023
25024'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
25025 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
25026 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
25027
25028In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
25029QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
25030
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010025031/*
25032 * Local variables:
25033 * fill-column: 79
25034 * End:
25035 */